Yaskawa L1000A Technical Manual
Yaskawa L1000A Technical Manual
Yaskawa L1000A Technical Manual
To properly use the product, read this manual thoroughly and retain
for easy reference, inspection, and maintenance. Ensure the end user
receives this manual.
Receiving 1
Mechanical Installation 2
Electrical Installation 3
Start-Up Programming &
Operation 4
Parameter Details 5
Troubleshooting 6
Periodic Inspection &
Maintenance 7
Peripheral Devices &
Options 8
Specifications A
Parameter List B
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications
C
Standards Compliance D
2 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
◆ Quick Reference
Drive a Synchronous PM Motor
L1000A can operate synchronous PM motors. Refer to Flowchart C: Auto-Tuning for PM Motors on page 102.
Perform Auto-Tuning
Automatic tuning sets motor parameters. Refer to Types of Auto-Tuning on page 104.
Standards Compliance
Refer to European Standards on page 414 and Refer to UL and CSA Standards on page 419.
CSA B44.1 /
ASME A17.5
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 3
4 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Table of Contents
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3
1. RECEIVING .......................................................................................................... 25
1.1 Section Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26
1.2 General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
L1000A Model Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
Control Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
1.3 Model Number and Nameplate Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29
Nameplate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29
1.4 Component Names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
IP00 Enclosure with Top Protective Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
IP00 Enclosure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Front Views . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
3. ELECTRICAL INSTALLATION............................................................................ 47
3.1 Section Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
3.2 Standard Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
3.3 Main Circuit Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 5
3.4 Terminal Block Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
3.5 Terminal Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
Removing/Reattaching the Terminal Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
3.6 Digital Operator and Front Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
Removing/Reattaching the Digital Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
Removing/Reattaching the Front Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Main Circuit Terminal Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Wire Gauges and Tightening Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Main Circuit Terminal and Motor Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
3.8 Control Circuit Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Control Circuit Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Control Circuit Terminal Block Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Terminal Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
Wiring the Control Circuit Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Switches and Jumpers on the Terminal Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
3.9 Control I/O Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Setting Sink/Source with Input Terminals SN and SP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Sinking/Sourcing Mode Selection for Safe Disable Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
3.10 Connect to a PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
3.11 MEMOBUS/Modbus Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
3.12 Wiring Checklist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
6 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Auto-Tuning Interruption and Fault Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Auto-Tuning Operation Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Parameter Settings during Induction Motor Auto-Tuning: T1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Parameter Settings during PM Motor Auto-Tuning: T2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Up and Down Commands and Speed Reference Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Speed Selection Using Digital Inputs (b1-01 = 0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Multi-Function Terminal Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Accel/Decel Ramp and Jerk Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Inspection Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Brake Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Adjustments for Elevator Ride Comfort . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Rescue Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
4.7 Setup Troubleshooting and Possible Solutions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Cannot Change Parameter Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Motor Does Not Rotate Properly after Pressing RUN Button or after Entering
External Up/Down Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Motor is Too Hot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Drive Does Not Allow Selection the Desired Auto-Tuning Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Electrical Noise From Drive or Output Lines When the Drive is Operating . . . . . . . . 136
Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter (ELCB/GFCI) Trips During Run . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Riding Comfort Related Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
4.8 Verifying Parameter Settings and Backing Up Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Backing Up Parameter Values: o2-03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Parameter Access Level: A1-01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Password Settings: A1-04, A1-05 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Copy Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 7
E2: Motor Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
E3: V/f Pattern for Motor 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
E4: Motor 2 Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
E5: PM Motor Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
5.6 F: Option Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
F1: Encoder/PG Feedback Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
F3: Digital Input Card Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .180
F4: Analog Monitor Card Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .180
F5: Digital Output Card Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181
F6: Communication Option Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
CANopen Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
5.7 H: Terminal Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184
H1: Multi-Function Digital Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184
H2: Multi-Function Digital Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
H3: Multi-Function Analog Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .197
H4: Multi-Function Analog Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200
H5: MEMOBUS/Modbus Serial Communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201
5.8 L: Protection Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
L1: Motor Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
L2: Undervoltage Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
L3: Stall Prevention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
L4: Speed Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
L5: Automatic Fault Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
L6: Torque Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
L7: Torque Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
L8: Drive Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
5.9 n: Special Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
n2: Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
n5: Inertia Compensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
n6: Online Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
n8: PM Motor Control Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
n9: Current Detection Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
o1: Digital Operator Display Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
o2: Digital Operator Keypad Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
o3: Copy Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
o4: Maintenance Monitor Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
S1: Brake Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
S2: Slip Compensation for Elevators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
S3: Start/Stop Optimization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
S4: Rescue Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
S5: Short Floor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
S6: Faults for Elevator Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
T: Motor Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246
5.12 U: Monitor Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247
U1: Operation Status Monitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247
U2: Fault Trace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247
U3: Fault History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247
U4: Maintenance Monitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247
U6: Control Monitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247
8 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6. TROUBLESHOOTING ....................................................................................... 249
6.1 Section Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
6.2 Drive Alarms, Faults, and Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Types of Alarms, Faults, and Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Alarm and Error Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
6.3 Fault Detection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Fault Displays, Causes, and Possible Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
6.4 Alarm Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Alarm Codes, Causes, and Possible Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
6.5 Operator Programming Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
oPE Codes, Causes, and Possible Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
6.6 Auto-Tuning Fault Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Auto-Tuning Codes, Causes, and Possible Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
6.7 Copy Function Related Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
Tasks, Errors, and Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
6.8 Diagnosing and Resetting Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Fault Occurs Simultaneously with Power Loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
If the Drive Still has Power After a Fault Occurs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Viewing Fault Trace Data After Fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Fault Reset Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 9
Installing a Magnetic Contactor at the Power Supply Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
Connecting an AC Reactor or a DC Link Choke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Connecting a Surge Absorber . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .322
Connecting a Noise Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .322
Fuse/Fuse Holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
Attachment for External Heatsink Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .325
EMC Filter Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .325
Installing a Motor Thermal Overload (oL) Relay on the Drive Output . . . . . . . . . . . . .325
10 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.5 Drive Operations by MEMOBUS/Modbus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391
Observing the Drive Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391
Controlling the Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391
C.6 Communications Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392
Command Messages from Master to Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392
Response Messages from Drive to Master . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392
C.7 Message Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
Message Content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
Slave Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
Function Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
Error Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
C.8 Message Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
Reading Drive MEMOBUS/Modbus Register Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
Loopback Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
Writing to Multiple Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397
Command Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397
Monitor Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
Broadcast Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405
Fault Trace Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406
Alarm Register Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 407
C.10 Enter Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
Enter Command Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
Parameter H5-11 and the Enter Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
C.11 Communication Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
MEMOBUS/Modbus Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
Slave Not Responding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
C.12 Self-Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 11
Multi-Function Digital Inputs (SC Common) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .433
Analog Inputs (AC Common) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .433
Multi-Function Relay Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .433
Multi-Function Photocoupler Outputs (P1-C1, P2-C2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .433
Monitor Outputs (AC Common) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .433
E.3 User Setting Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .434
Index .............................................................................................................................438
12 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
i
Preface & General Safety
This section provides safety messages pertinent to this product that, if not heeded, may result in
fatality, personal injury, or equipment damage. Yaskawa is not responsible for the
consequences of ignoring these instructions.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 13
i.1 Preface
i.1 Preface
Yaskawa manufactures products used as components in a wide variety of industrial systems and equipment. The selection
and application of Yaskawa products remain the responsibility of the equipment manufacturer or end user. Yaskawa
accepts no responsibility for the way its products are incorporated into the final system design. Under no circumstances
should any Yaskawa product be incorporated into any product or design as the exclusive or sole safety control. Without
exception, all controls should be designed to detect faults dynamically and fail safely under all circumstances. All systems
or equipment designed to incorporate a product manufactured by Yaskawa must be supplied to the end user with
appropriate warnings and instructions as to the safe use and operation of that part. Any warnings provided by Yaskawa
must be promptly provided to the end user. Yaskawa offers an express warranty only as to the quality of its products in
conforming to standards and specifications published in the Yaskawa manual. NO OTHER WARRANTY, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, IS OFFERED. Yaskawa assumes no liability for any personal injury, property damage, losses, or claims
arising from misapplication of its products.
This manual is designed to ensure correct and suitable application of L1000A-Series Drives. Read this manual before
attempting to install, operate, maintain, or inspect a drive and keep it in a safe, convenient location for future reference.
Be sure you understand all precautions and safety information before attempting application.
◆ Applicable Documentation
The following manuals are available for L1000A series drives:
Read this manual first. This guide is packaged together with the product. It contains basic information required to install and wire
F1 F2
the drive, in addition to an overview of fault diagnostics, maintenance, and parameter settings. Use the information in this book to
ESC
RESET
LO
RE
ENTER
prepare the drive for a trial run with the application and for basic operation.
RUN STOP
YEA_
between the drive and motor, entre le driver et le moteur, veuillez
please wait 5 minutes before patienter 5 minutes avain d’effectuer
inspecting, performing une opération de montage ou de
maintenance or wiring the drive. câblage du variateur.
Hot surfaces Surfaces Chaudes
Top and Side surfaces may Dessus et cotés du boitier Peuvent
become hot. Do not touch. devenir chaud. Ne Pas toucher.
This manual provides detailed information on parameter settings, drive functions, and MEMOBUS/Modbus specifications. Use
5
400V
common this manual to expand drive functionality and to take advantage of higher performance features.
◆ Symbols
Note: Indicates a supplement or precaution that does not cause drive damage.
14 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
i.1 Preface
◆ Trademarks
• EnDat is a trademark of Heidenhain Corporation.
• HIPERFACE is a trademark of Sick Stegmann, Inc.
• CANopen is a trademark of CAN in Automation (CiA).
• Other companies and product names mentioned in this manual are trademarks of those companies.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 15
i.2 General Safety
WARNING
Read and understand this manual before installing, operating or servicing this drive. The drive must be installed
according to this manual and local codes.
The following conventions are used to indicate safety messages in this manual. Failure to heed these messages could
result in serious or fatal injury or damage to the products or to related equipment and systems.
DANGER
Indicates a hazardous situation, which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.
WARNING
Indicates a hazardous situation, which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.
WARNING! may also be indicated by a bold key word embedded in the text followed by an italicized safety message.
CAUTION
Indicates a hazardous situation, which, if not avoided, could result in minor or moderate injury.
CAUTION! may also be indicated by a bold key word embedded in the text followed by an italicized safety message.
NOTICE
Indicates a property damage message.
NOTICE: may also be indicated by a bold key word embedded in the text followed by an italicized safety message.
16 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
i.2 General Safety
◆ Safety Messages
DANGER
Heed the safety messages in this manual.
Failure to comply will result in death or serious injury.
The operating company is responsible for any injuries or equipment damage resulting from failure to heed the warnings
in this manual.
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not connect or disconnect wiring or service the drive while the power is on.
Failure to comply will result in death or serious injury.
Before servicing, disconnect all power to the equipment. The internal capacitor remains charged even after the power
supply is turned off. After shutting off the power, wait for at least the amount of time specified on the drive before
touching any components.
WARNING
Sudden Movement Hazard
The drive system or elevator may start unexpectedly upon application of power, resulting in death or serious
injury.
• Clear all personnel from the drive, motor, and machine area before applying power.
• Secure covers, couplings, shaft keys, and machine loads before applying power to the drive.
Ensure there are no short circuits between the main circuit terminals (R/L1, S/L2, and T/L3) or between the
ground and main circuit terminals before restarting the drive.
Failure to comply may result in serious injury or death and will cause damage to equipment.
System may start unexpectedly upon application of power when the Auto-restart function is enabled resulting in
death or serious injury.
Use care when enabling Auto-restart as this function may cause unintended start of the elevator.
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not attempt to modify or alter the drive in any way not explained in this manual.
Yaskawa is not responsible for damage caused by modification of the product made by the user. Failure to comply
could result in death or serious injury from operation of damaged equipment.
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may show drives without covers or safety shields to show details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 17
i.2 General Safety
WARNING
When a drive is running a PM motor, voltage continues to be generated at the motor terminals after the drive is
shut off while the motor coasts to stop. Take the precautions described below to prevent shock and injury:
• In applications where the machine can still rotate even though the drive has fully stopped a load, install a switch to
the drive output side to disconnect the motor and the drive.
• Do not allow an external force to rotate the motor beyond the maximum allowable speed or to rotate the motor when
the drive has been shut off.
• Wait for at least the time specified on the warning label after opening the load switch on the output side before
inspecting the drive or performing any maintenance.
• Do not open and close the load switch while the motor is running, as this can damage the drive.
If the motor is coasting, make sure the power to the drive is turned on and the drive output has completely stopped
before closing the load switch.
Do not connect or disconnect wiring to the drive or motor while the power is on.
Failure to comply will result in death or serious injury. Before servicing, disconnect all power to the equipment. The
internal capacitor remains charged even after the power supply is turned off. The charge indicator LED will extinguish
when the DC bus voltage is below 50 Vdc. To prevent electric shock, wait at least five minutes after all indicators are
OFF and measure the DC bus voltage level to confirm safe level.
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may show drives without covers or safety shields to show details. Be sure to
reinstallcovers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this
manual.
Do not perform work on the drive while wearing loose clothing, jewelry or without eye protection.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Remove all metal objects such as watches and rings, secure loose clothing, and wear eye protection before beginning
work on the drive.
Do not change wiring, remove covers, connectors or options cards, or attempt to service the drive with power
applied to the drive.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all power to the drive and check for unsafe
voltages before servicing.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use the equipment.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Maintenance, inspection, and replacement of parts must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar with
installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives.
Fire Hazard
Applications using a braking option should wire a thermal relay so that the output contactor opens when the
thermal relay trips.
Inadequate braking circuit protection could result in death or serious injury by fire from overheating resistors.
Do not use improper combustible materials.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire.
Attach the drive to metal or other noncombustible material.
18 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
i.2 General Safety
CAUTION
Always turn off the RUN command before changing the setting of parameters d1-18 (Speed Reference Selection
Mode), b1-01 (Speed Reference Selection), or H1- (Multi-Function Digital Inputs).
If the RUN command is on when changing any of these settings, the motor may unexpectedly start running, and could
result in injury.
NOTICE
Equipment Hazard
Do not modify the drive circuitry.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive and will void warranty.
Yaskawa is not responsible for any modification of the product made by the user. This product must not be modified.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive or braking circuit.
Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive, circuit boards, and option
cards.
Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Do not operate damaged equipment.
Failure to comply could result in further damage to the equipment.
Do not connect or operate any equipment with visible damage or missing parts.
Do not lift the drive up while the cover is removed.
This can damage the terminal board and other components.
Do not expose the drive to halogen group disinfectants.
Failure to comply may cause damage to the electrical components in the drive.
Do not pack the drive in wooden materials that have been fumigated or sterilized.
Do not sterilize the entire package after the product is packed.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 19
i.2 General Safety
■ Settings
DC Injection Braking
NOTICE: Excessive current during DC Injection Braking and excessive duration of DC Injection Braking can cause motor overheat.
Acceleration/Deceleration Ramp
Acceleration and deceleration times are affected by the amount of torque generated by the motor, the load torque, and the
inertia moment. Set a longer accel/decel time when Stall Prevention is enabled. The accel/decel times are lengthened for
20 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
i.2 General Safety
as long as the Stall Prevention function is in operation. Install one of the available braking options or increase the capacity
of the drive for faster acceleration and deceleration.
■ General Handling
Selecting a Molded Case Circuit Breaker or Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter (GFCI)
Select an appropriate GFCI. This drive can cause a residual current with a DC component in the protective earthing
conductor. Where a residual current operated protective or monitoring device is used for protection in case of direct or
indirect contact, always use an GFCI of type B according to IEC 60755.
Select a MCCB (Molded Case Circuit Breaker) with a rated current that is 1.5 to 2 times higher than the rated current of
the drive in order to avoid nuisance trips caused by harmonics in the drive input current. Also refer to Installing a Molded
Case Circuit Breaker (MCCB) on page 320.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Install a properly controlled contactor on the input-side of the drive for applications where
power should be removed from the drive during a fault condition. Improper equipment sequencing could result in death or serious
injury.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Shut off the drive with a magnetic contactor (MC) when a fault occurs in any external equipment such as
braking resistors. Refer to Installing a Magnetic Contactor at the Power Supply Side on page 320. Failure to comply may cause
resistor overheating, fire, and injury to personnel.
NOTICE: To get the full performance life out of the electrolytic capacitors and circuit relays, refrain from switching the drive power
supply off and on more than once every 30 minutes. Frequent use can damage the drive. Use the drive to stop and start the motor.
CAUTION! Burn Hazard. Because the heatsink can get very hot during operation, take proper precautions to prevent burns. When
replacing the cooling fan, shut off the power and wait at least 15 minutes to be sure that the heatsink has cooled down. Failure to
comply may cause burn injury to personnel.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. When a drive is running a PM motor, voltage continues to be generated at the motor terminals
after the drive is shut off while the motor coasts to stop. Take the precautions described below to prevent shock and injury:
• In applications where the machine can still rotate after the drive has fully stopped a load, install a switch to the drive
output side to disconnect the motor and the drive.
• Do not allow an external force to rotate the motor beyond the maximum allowable speed or to rotate the motor when the
drive has been powered off.
• Wait for at least the time specified on the warning label after opening the load switch on the output side before
inspecting the drive or performing any maintenance.
• Do not open and close the load switch while the motor is running.
• If the motor is coasting, make sure the power to the drive is turned on and the drive output has completely stopped
before closing the load switch.
Wiring
Yaskawa recommends using ring terminals on all drive models for UL/cUL compliance. Use only the tools recommended
by the terminal manufacturer for crimping.
Transporting the Drive
NOTICE: Never steam clean the drive. During transport, keep the drive from coming into contact with salts, fluorine, bromine,
phethalate ester, and other such harmful chemicals.
NOTICE: Consider motor voltage tolerance levels and motor insulation in applications with an input voltage of over 440 V or particularly
long wiring distances.
NOTICE: Ensure that the motor is suitable for inverter duty and/or the motor service factor is adequate to accommodate theadditional
heating with the intended operating conditions. A motor connected to a PWM drive may operate at a highertemperature than a utility-
fed motor and the operating speed range may reduce motor cooling capacity.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 21
i.2 General Safety
NOTICE: Ensure that the motor is suitable for inverter duty and/or the motor service factor is adequate to accommodate the additional
heating with the intended operating conditions. A motor connected to a PWM drive may operate at a higher temperature than a utility-
fed motor and the operating speed range may reduce motor cooling capacity.
High-Speed Operation
NOTICE: Mechanical problems may occur with the motor bearings and dynamic balance of the machine when operating a motor
beyond its rated speed. Contact the motor or machine manufacturer.
Low-Speed Range
The cooling fan of a standard motor should sufficiently cool the motor at the rated speed. As the self-cooling capability of
such a motor reduces with the speed, applying full torque at low speed will possibly damage the motor. Reduce the load
torque as the motor slows to prevent motor damage from overheat. Use a motor designed specifically for operation with a
drive when 100% continuous torque is needed at low speeds.
Torque Characteristics
Torque characteristics differ compared to operating the motor directly from line power. The user should have a full
understanding of the load torque characteristics for the application.
Vibration and Shock
The drive allows selection of high carrier PWM control and low carrier PWM control. Selecting high carrier PWM can
help reduce motor oscillation.
If resonance occurs, install shock-absorbing rubber around the base of the motor and enable the Jump frequency selection
to prevent continuous operation in the resonant frequency range.
Audible Noise
Noise created during run varies by the carrier frequency setting. When using a high carrier frequency, audible noise from
the motor is comparable to the motor noise generated when running from line power. Operating above the rated r/min,
however, can create unpleasant motor noise.
■ Precautions for PM Motors
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Improper sequencing of output motor circuits could result in damage to the drive. Do not connect
electromagnetic switches or magnetic contactors to the output motor circuits without proper sequencing. Do not open the main circuit
between the drive and the motor while the PM motor is rotating.
• Contact Yaskawa or your Yaskawa agent if you plan to use any PM motor not endorsed by Yaskawa.
• When using a holding brake, release the brake prior to starting the motor. Failure to set the proper timing can result in
speed loss.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Use the Initial Pole Search Status Signal (H2-= 61) to interlock the brake to ensure the
brake is not released before the Initial Magnetic Pole Search is completed. Failure to comply may cause inadvertent elevator
movement resulting in serious injury.
This safety message is applicable under these conditions:
• When applying a PM motor, with an external brake sequence, and the PG-F3 option is not being used.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. The motor must be at a complete stop before performing any maintenance, inspection, or wiring.
• With a PM motor, drive output must be fully interrupted when the power is shut off and the motor is still rotating.
Failure to comply can result in personal injury from electrical shock.
22 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
i.2 General Safety
WARNING
Risk of electric shock.
Read manual before installing.
Wait 5 minutes for capacitor
discharge after disconnecting
power supply.
To conform to requirements,
make sure to ground the supply
neutral for 400V class.
After opening the manual switch
between the drive and motor,
please wait 5 minutes before
inspecting, performing
maintenance or wiring the drive.
Hot surfaces
Top and Side surfaces may
become hot. Do not touch.
Figure i.1 Warning Information
Figure i.2
YEA_comm
DIGITAL OPERATOR JVOP-180 ALM
F1 F2
on
LO
ESC
RE
RESET ENTER
RUN STOP
CIMR
200V 3Phase 5.5kW/3.7kW
S/N:
Warning Label
maintenance or wiring the drive. câblage du variateur.
Hot surfaces Surfaces Chaudes
Top and Side surfaces may Dessus et cotés du boitier Peuvent
become hot. Do not touch. devenir chaud. Ne Pas toucher.
400V
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 23
i.2 General Safety
◆ Warranty Information
■ Restrictions
The drive is not designed or manufactured for use in devices or systems that may directly affect or threaten human lives or
health.
Customers who intend to use the product described in this manual for devices or systems relating to transportation, health
care, space aviation, atomic power, electric power, or in underwater applications must first contact their Yaskawa
representatives or the nearest Yaskawa sales office.
WARNING! Injury to Personnel. This product has been manufactured under strict quality-control guidelines. However, if this product is
to be installed in any location where failure of this product could involve or result in a life-and-death situation or loss of human life or in
a facility where failure may cause a serious accident or physical injury, safety devices must be installed to minimize the likelihood of any
accident.
■ Warranty Period
This drive is warranted for 12 months from the date of delivery to the customer or 18 months from the date of shipment
from the Yaskawa factory, whichever comes first.
■ Scope of Warranty
Inspections
Customers are responsible for periodic inspections of the drive. Upon request, a Yaskawa representative will inspect the
drive for a fee. If the Yaskawa representative finds the drive to be defective due to Yaskawa workmanship or materials
and the defect occurs during the warranty period, this inspection fee will be waived and the problem remedied free of
charge.
Yaskawa manufactures products used as components in a wide variety of industrial systems and equipment. The selection
and application of Yaskawa products remain the responsibility of the equipment manufacturer or end user. Yaskawa
accepts no responsibility for the way its products are incorporated into the final system design. Under no circumstances
should any Yaskawa product be incorporated into any product or design as the exclusive or sole safety control. Without
exception, all controls should be designed to detect faults dynamically and fail safely under all circumstances. All systems
or equipment designed to incorporate a product manufactured by Yaskawa must be supplied to the end user with
appropriate warnings and instructions as to the safe use and operation of that part. Any warnings provided by Yaskawa
must be promptly provided to the end user. Yaskawa offers an express warranty only as to the quality of its products in
conforming to standards and specifications published in the Yaskawa manual. NO OTHER WARRANTY, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, IS OFFERED. Yaskawa assumes no liability for any personal injury, property damage, losses, or claims
arising from misapplication of its products.
24 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
1
Receiving
This chapter explains how to inspect the drive upon receipt, and gives and overview of the
different enclosure types and components.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 25
1.1 Section Safety
NOTICE
Equipment Hazard
Do not connect electromagnetic switches or magnetic contactors to the output motor circuits without proper
sequencing.
Improper sequencing of output motor circuits could result in damage to the drive.
Do not open the main circuit between the drive and the motor while the PM motor is rotating.
Improper sequencing of output motor circuits could result in damage to the drive.
Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive and circuit boards.
Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
A motor connected to a PWM drive may operate at a higher temperature than a utility-fed motor and the
operating speed range may reduce motor cooling capacity.
Ensure that the motor is suitable for drive duty and/or the motor service factor is adequate to accommodate the
additional heating with the intended operating conditions.
26 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
1.2 General Description
<1> These values assume the carrier frequency is not set higher than 8 kHz.
<2> These values assume the carrier frequency is not set higher than 5 kHz.
Note: The drive automatically decreases the rated output current when setting higher carrier frequency.
Receiving
1
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 27
1.2 General Description
28 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
1.3 Model Number and Nameplate Check
Quantity 1 1 1
Nameplate
Figure 1.1
YEA_common
Receiving
AC drive model MODEL : CIMR-LU2A0018DAA REV: A
C/C : CIMR-LU2A0018DAA
Input specifications
Output specifications
INPUT
OUTPUT
: AC3PH 200-240V 50/60Hz 18.9A
: AC3PH 0-240V 0-120Hz 17.5A
IND.CONT.EQ.
7J48 B
1
MASS : 3.5 kg PRG : 1010 Software version
Lot number O/N :
Serial number S/N :
CIMR - L U 2 A 0018 D A A
Drive L1000A Customized No. Enclosure Type Design
No.
Series Specifications Revision
A IP00 Order
Region A Standard model
No. IP00 with top
Code D protective cover
U U.S.A.
Environmental
No.
Specification <1>
A Standard
<1> Drives with these specifications do not guarantee complete protection for the environmental conditions indicated.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 29
1.3 Model Number and Nameplate Check
■ Model Code
Table 1.2 Model Code
Three-Phase 200 V Three-Phase 400 V
Max. Motor Capacity Rated Output Max. Motor Capacity Rated Output
No. No.
kW(HP) Current A kW(HP) Current A
0018 3.7 (5) 17.5 0009 3.7 (5) 9.2
0025 5.5 (7-1/2) 25 0015 5.5 (7-1/2) 14.8
0033 7.5 (10) 33 0018 7.5 (10) 18
0047 11 (15) 47 0024 11 (15) 24
0060 15 (20) 60 0031 15 (20) 31
0075 18.5 (25) 75 0039 18.5 (25) 39
0085 22 (30) 85 0045 22 (30) 45
0115 30 (40) 115 0060 30 (40) 60
0145 37 (50) 145 0075 37 (50) 75
0180 45 (60) 180 0091 45 (60) 91
0215 55 (75) 215 0112 55 (75) 112
0283 75 (100) 283 0150 75 (100) 150
0346 90 (125) 346 0180 90 (125) 180
0415 110 (150) 415 0216 110 (150) 216
– – – 0260 132 (200) 260
30 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
1.4 Component Names
B I
D J
K
E
F
M
Receiving
G N
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 31
1.4 Component Names
H
E
I K
L
F
J M
G
32 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
1.4 Component Names
F
B
G
C
H
I
D M
J L
K
N
Receiving
G – Cooling fan N – Terminal cover
Figure 1.4 Exploded view of IP00 Enclosure Drive with
Top Protective Cover (CIMR-L4A0150D)
1
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 33
1.4 Component Names
◆ IP00 Enclosure
■ Three-Phase AC200 V CIMR-L 2A0215A to 2A0415A
Three-Phase AC400 V CIMR-L 4A0180A to 4A0260A
Figure 1.8
E
A
B G
C
H I
J K
D
M
L
34 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
1.4 Component Names
◆ Front Views
Figure 1.9
CIMR-L2A0018D CIMR-L2A0145D
I
I
A A
J
J
B B
C C
D
D
E
E
F
YEA_TMonly
Receiving
B – DIP switch S2 (Refer to MEMOBUS/ G – Protecting cover to prevent miswiring
Modbus Termination on page 78)
C – Jumper S3 (Refer to Sinking/Sourcing H – Option card connector (CN5-C)
Mode Selection for Safe Disable
Inputs on page 76) 1
D – Ground terminal I – Option card connector (CN5-B)
E – Terminal board (Refer to Control J – Option card connector (CN5-A)
Circuit Wiring on page 69)
Figure 1.6 Front View of Drives
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 35
1.4 Component Names
36 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
2
Mechanical Installation
This chapter explains how to properly mount and install the drive.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 37
2.1 Section Safety
CAUTION
Crush Hazard
Do not carry the drive by the front cover or the terminal cover.
Failure to comply may result in minor or moderate injury from the main body of the drive falling.
NOTICE
Equipment Hazard
Prevent foreign matter such as metal shavings or wire clippings from falling into the drive during drive
installation and project construction.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive.
Place a temporary cover over the top during installation. Be sure to remove the temporary cover before start-up, as the
cover will reduce ventilation and cause the unit to overheat.
Observe proper electrostatic discharge (ESD) procedures when handling the drive.
Failure to comply could result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Operating the motor in the low-speed range diminishes the cooling effects, increases motor temperature, and
may lead to motor damage by overheating.
Reduce the motor torque in the low-speed range whenever using a standard blower cooled motor. If 100% torque is
required continuously at low speed, consider using a special drive or vector-control motor.
The speed range for continuous operation differs according to the lubrication method and motor manufacturer.
If the motor is to be operated at a speed higher than the rated speed, consult with the manufacturer.
Continuously operating an oil-lubricated motor in the low-speed range may result in motor failure.
When the input voltage is 440 V or higher or the wiring distance is greater than 100 meters, pay special
attention to the motor insulation voltage or use a drive-rated motor with reinforced insulation.
Failure to comply could lead to motor winding failure.
Motor vibration may increase when operating a machine in variable-speed mode, if that machine previously
operated at a constant speed.
Install vibration-proof rubber on the motor base.
The motor may require more acceleration torque with drive operation than with a commercial power supply.
Set a proper V/f pattern by checking the load torque characteristics of the machine to be used with the motor.
Never lift the drive up while the cover is removed.
This can damage the terminal board and other components.
Improper application of peripheral devices could result in malfunction of drive due to electrical interference.
Follow manufacturers recommendations when installing electrical devices near the drive and take precautions to shield
the drive from electrical interference.
38 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
2.2 Mechanical Installation
◆ Installation Environment
Install the drive in an environment matching the specifications below to help prolong the optimum performance life of the
drive.
Table 2.1 Installation Environment
Environment Conditions
Installation Area Indoors
-10 °C to +40 °C (IP00 with top protective cover: Enclosure type D)
-10 °C to +50 °C (IP00 without top protective cover: Enclosure type A)
Drive reliability improves in environments without wide temperature fluctuations.
Ambient Temperature
When using the drive in an enclosure panel, install a cooling fan or air conditioner in the area to ensure that the air temperature inside the enclosure
does not exceed the specified levels.
Do not allow ice to develop on the drive.
Humidity 95% RH or less and free of condensation
Storage Temperature -20 to 60 °C
Install the drive in an area free from:
• oil mist and dust
• metal shavings, oil, water or other foreign materials
• radioactive materials
Surrounding Area • combustible materials (e.g., wood)
• harmful gases and liquids
• excessive vibration
• chlorides
• direct sunlight
Mechanical Installation
Altitude 1000 m or lower, up to 3000 m with derating (Refer to Drive Derating Data on page 332)
10 to 20 Hz at 9.8 m/s2
Vibration
20 to 55 Hz at 5.9 m/s2 (2A0018 to 2A0180, 4A0009 to 4A0150) or 2.0 m/s2 (2A0215 to 2A0415, 4A0180 to 4A0260)
Orientation Install the drive vertically to maintain maximum cooling effects.
NOTICE: Avoid placing drive peripheral devices, transformers, or other electronics near the drive as the noise created can lead to
erroneous operation. If such devices must be used in close proximity to the drive, take proper steps to shield the drive from noise.
NOTICE: Prevent foreign matter such as metal shavings and wire clippings from falling into the drive during installation. Failure to
comply could result in damage to the drive. Place a temporary cover over the top of the drive during installation. Remove the temporary
cover before startup, as the cover will reduce ventilation and cause the drive to overheat.
2
■ Installation Orientation
Install the drive upright as illustrated in Figure 2.1 to maintain proper cooling. Refer to Mechanical Installation on
page 39 for details on installing the drive.
Figure 2.1
OK Not OK Not OK
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 39
2.2 Mechanical Installation
■ Installation Spacing
Figure 2.2 shows the installation distance required to maintain sufficient space for airflow and wiring.
Figure 2.2
A C
YEA_common
B B
C
D D
A
YEA_TMonly
YEA_TMonly
40 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
2.2 Mechanical Installation
Drive Operator
Comm Port
S / N : J007XE273710001
common_
TMonly
Communication Cable Connector
Mechanical Installation
12.2 1.6 Installation holes (2-M3 screws, depth 5)
YEA_TMonly
S / N : J007XE273710001
2
90
78
15
7.9 44
60
Minimum
50 Unit: mm
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 41
2.2 Mechanical Installation
NOTICE: revent foreign matter such as metal shavings or wire clippings from falling into the drive during installation and project
construction. Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive. Place a temporary cover over the top of the drive during installation.
Remove the temporary cover before drive start-up, as the cover will reduce ventilation and cause the drive to overheat.
External/Face-Mount
1. Cut an opening in the enclosure panel for the digital operator as shown in Figure 2.8.
2. Position the digital operator so the display faces outwards, and mount it to the enclosure panel as shown in
Figure 2.7.
Figure 2.6
Digital Operator M3 × 6
Phillips recessed
pan head machine screw × 2
Enclosure panel
common_TMonly
Unit: mm
Figure 2.7 External/Face-Mount Installation
Figure 2.7
22
common_TMonly
78
26
22
2
22
14
Unit: mm
Figure 2.8 Panel Cut-Out Dimensions (External/Face-Mount Installation)
42 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
2.2 Mechanical Installation
Internal/Flush-Mount
An internal flush-mount requires an installation support set that must be purchased separately. Contact a Yaskawa
representative to order an installation support set and mounting hardware. Figure 2.9 illustrates how to attach the
Installation Support Set A.
1. Cut an opening in the enclosure panel for the digital operator as shown in Figure 2.10.
2. Mount the digital operator to the installation support.
3. Mount the installation support set and digital operator to the enclosure panel.
Figure 2.8
Enclosure panel
Digital Operator
common_TMonly
Unit: mm
Mechanical Installation
89 +0.5
0
120
45
common_TMonly
59 +0.5
0
Unit : mm
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 43
2.2 Mechanical Installation
0.06
W1
W1 4-d
t2
H1
H1
H
H
t1
D1
H2
t1
D
H2
44 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
2.2 Mechanical Installation
H1
H
t1
H2
D1
max 0.31 W max 0.31 D
Figure 1
Mechanical Installation
Table 2.6 Dimensions: 400 V Class
Drive Model Dimensions (in) Weight
CIMR-L Figure (lbs)
W H D W1 H1 H2 D1 t1 t2 d
4A0180 17.7 27.8 13.0 12.8 26.8 0.5 5.1 0.1 0.1 M10 174.2
4A0216 1 19.7 31.5 13.8 14.6 30.4 0.5 5.1 0.2 0.2 M12 211.6
4A0260 19.7 31.5 13.8 14.6 30.4 0.5 5.1 0.2 0.2 M12 224.9
2
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 45
2.2 Mechanical Installation
46 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3
Electrical Installation
This chapter explains proper procedures for wiring the control circuit terminals, motor, and
power supply.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 47
3.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Sudden Movement Hazard
Operating a drive with untested emergency circuits could result in death or serious injury.
Verify all emergency stop wiring and circuits before operating the drive.
Ensure start/stop, I/O and safety circuits are wired properly and in the correct state before energizing or
running the drive.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury from moving equipment.
If holding brake circuits are not configured properly, load equipment may fall or drop during power loss or
drive fault, which could result in death or serious injury.
• Provide a separate holding brake if necessary.
• Always construct the external sequence to confirm that the holding brake is activated in the event of an emergency, a
power failure, or an abnormality in the drive.
• If using the drive with an elevator, provide safety measures on the elevator to prevent the elevator from dropping.
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may show drives without covers or safety shields to show details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
Always ground the motor-side grounding terminal.
Improper equipment grounding could result in death or serious injury by contacting the motor case.
Do not perform work on the drive while wearing loose clothing, jewelry or without eye protection.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Remove all metal objects such as watches and rings, secure loose clothing, and wear eye protection before beginning
work on the drive.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use the equipment.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Maintenance, inspection, and replacement of parts must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar with
installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives.
48 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Make sure the protective earthing conductor complies with technical standards and local safety regulations.
When an EMC filter is installed, the leakage current exceeds 3.5 mA. Therefore according to IEC61800-5, an
automatic power supply interruption in case of a broken earthing conductor must be provided. Alternatively a
protective earthing conductor with a cross section of at least 10 mm2 (Cu) or 16 mm2 (Al) must be used.
Use a GFCI of type B according to IEC 60755 when a leakage current protective or monitoring device is required for
protection in case of direct or indirect contact. Failure to comply may result in injury due to electrical shock.
Improper equipment grounding may cause dangerous electrical potentials on equipment chassis, which could
result in death or serious injury.
Always use a ground wire that complies with technical standards on electrical equipment and minimize the length of
the ground wire.
Improper equipment grounding could result in death or serious injury by contacting ungrounded electrical
equipment.
Always ground the ground terminal. (200 V Class: Ground to 100 Ω or less, 400 V Class: Ground to 10 Ω or less).
Sudden Movement Hazard
Comply with proper wiring practices.
The motor may run in reverse if the phase order is backward, causing incorrect elevator direction movement and injury
to personnel.
Connect motor input terminals U, V and W to drive output terminals U/T1,V/T2, and W/T3. The phase order for the
drive and motor should match.
Do not connect the AC power line to the output motor terminals of the drive.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line voltage
application to output terminals.
Install a properly controlled contactor on the input-side of the drive for applications where power should be
Electrical Installation
removed from the drive during a fault condition.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in death or serious injury.
Do not connect the AC power line to the output motor terminals of the drive. Failure to comply could result in
death or serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line voltage application to output terminals.
• Do not connect AC line power to output terminals U, V, and W.
• Make sure that the power supply lines are connected to main circuit input terminals R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 (or R/L1 and S/ 3
L2 for single-phase power).
Install a properly controlled contactor on the input-side of the drive for applications where power should be
removed from the drive during a fault condition.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in death or serious injury.
Fire Hazard
Install adequate branch circuit short circuit protection per applicable codes.
The drive is suitable for circuits capable of delivering not more than 100,000 RMS symmetrical amperes, 240 Vac
maximum (200 V Class) and 480 Vac maximum (400 V Class). Inadequate branch short circuit protection could result
in damage to the drive.
Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque.
Loose electrical connections could result in death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical connections.
Improperly tightened terminal screws can also cause erroneous equipment operation.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 49
3.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Do not use improper combustible materials in drive installation.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire.
Attach the drive or braking resistors to metal or other noncombustible material.
Do not use an improper voltage source.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire. Verify that the rated voltage of the drive matches the
voltage of the incoming power supply before applying power.
The braking resistor connection terminals are B1 and B2. Do not connect a braking resistor directly to any other
terminals.
Improper wiring connections could result in death or serious injury by fire.
CAUTION
Crush Hazard
Carrying the drive by the front cover may cause the main body of the drive to fall, resulting in minor or
moderate injury.
Always hold the case when carrying the drive.
NOTICE
Equipment Hazard
Do not carelessly connect parts or devices to the drives braking transistor terminals.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive or braking circuit. Carefully review instruction manual
TOBPC72060000 when connecting a braking option to the drive.
Do not share the ground wire with other devices such as welding machines or large-current electrical
equipment.
Improper equipment grounding could result in drive or equipment malfunction due to electrical interference.
Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive and circuit boards.
Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Never connect or disconnect the motor from the drive while the drive is outputting voltage.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in damage to the drive.
Do not use unshielded cable for control wiring.
Failure to comply may cause electrical interference resulting in poor system performance. Use shielded, twisted-pair
wires and ground the shield to the ground terminal of the drive.
Use care when connecting parts or devices to the drives braking transistor terminals.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive or braking circuit.
Carefully review instruction manual TOBPC72060000 when connecting a braking option to the drive.
Do not modify the drive circuitry.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive and will void warranty.
Yaskawa is not responsible for any modification of the product made by the user. This product must not be modified.
Check all the wiring to ensure that all connections are correct after installing the drive and connecting any other
devices.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive.
50 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.1 Section Safety
NOTICE
Connect braking circuits to the drive as shown in the I/O wiring examples.
Improperly wiring braking circuits could result in damage to the drive or equipment.
Install adequate branch circuit short circuit protection per applicable codes.
The drive is suitable for circuits capable of delivering not more than 100,000 RMS symmetrical amperes, 240 Vac
maximum (200 V Class) and 480 Vac maximum (400 V Class). Inadequate branch short circuit protection damage or
serious injury by fire.
Do not check or test control circuit signals while the drive is running.
Improper use of test equipment could result in damage to the drive circuitry by short circuit.
Fire Hazard
When the input voltage is 480 V or higher or the wiring distance is greater than 100 meters, pay special
attention to the motor insulation voltage or use a drive-rated motor.
Failure to comply could lead to motor winding failure.
Do not connect control circuit ground terminals to the drive enclosure.
Improper drive grounding can cause control circuit malfunction.
Do not use the negative DC bus terminal "-" as a ground terminal. This terminal is at high DC voltage potential.
Improper wiring connections could damage the drive.
Before applying power to the drive, use power-off resistance checks to check for short-circuits between (R/L1, S/
L2, and T/L3) or between main circuit terminals and ground.
Failure to comply may result in damage to the drive from short-circuit.
Prevent foreign matter such as metal shavings or wire clippings from falling into the drive during drive
installation and project construction.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive. Place a temporary cover over the top during installation. Be sure
Electrical Installation
to remove the temporary cover before start-up, as the cover will reduce ventilation and cause the unit to overheat.
Improper application of devices on drive output circuits can damage the drive.
Do not connect unapproved LC or RC interference suppression filters, capacitors, ground fault circuits, or overvoltage
protection devices to the output of the drive.
Insulate shields with heat shrink tubing or tape to prevent contact with other signal lines and equipment.
Improper wiring practices could result in drive or equipment damage due to short circuit. 3
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 51
3.2 Standard Connection Diagram
NOTICE: When the input voltage is 440 V or higher or the wiring distance is greater than 100 meters (328 ft.), pay special attention to
the motor insulation voltage or use a drive rated motor. Failure to comply could lead to motor insulation breakdown.
Note: Do not connect AC control circuit ground to drive enclosure. Improper drive grounding can cause control circuit malfunction.
NOTICE: The minimum load for the multi-function relay output MA-MB-MC is 10 mA. If a circuit requires less than 10 mA (reference
value), connect it to a photocoupler output (P1-C1, P2-C2). Improper application of peripheral devices could result in damage to the
photocoupler output of the drive.
52 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.2 Standard Connection Diagram
Figure 3.1
<4>
FU
r1
Terminals -, +1, +2, B1, B2 are
for connecting options. Never
DC link choke <1>
(option) Thermal relay
(option)
s1
FV
M YEA_common
connect power supply lines to U X <2><3>
FW
these terminals
t1 Cooling fan
Jumper Braking resistor
(option)
+2 +1 B1 B2 <2> U/T1
Wiring sequence should shut off
U/T1
Main Circuit
power to the drive when a fault V/T2 V/T2
output is triggered. 2MCCB M
<14> W/T3
r1
s1 W/T3
t1
ELCB (MCCB) MC Fuse
Three-phase R
R/L1
power supply S S/L2
Ground
200 to 240 VT T/L3
50/60 Hz PGX3 TB1
If running from a 400 V power
supply, a step-down transformer
is needed to reduce the voltage
Drive <6> A+
A
to 200 V.
MC MB 2MCCB THRX OFF ON MC Control Circuit <5> B+ PG
SA
B
MC Up command / Stop S1 Z+
Braking resistor unit
Thermal relay trip contact THRX Z
1
Down command / Stop S2
2
SA NC SD
TRX Nominal Speed S3 FE
SA
CN3
MC MA Inspection Operation S4 IP12 TB2
TRX
IP5 IP
Intermediate Speed 1 S5 IG
Fault relay IG
contact Multi-function SG
digtial inputs Leveling Speed S6
(default setting) a+
a- A pulse monitor signal
Not Used S7 b+
b- B pulse monitor signal
Not Used S8 z+
Option card z- Z pulse monitor signal
connector CN5-C
SN
CN5-B MA Fault relay output <13> <14>
Sink / Source mode SC 250 Vac, max. 1 A
MB
selection wire jumper 30 Vdc, max 1 A
(default: Sink) <7> SP CN5-A MC (min. 5 Vdc, 10 mA)
+24 V
M1 Multi-function relay output (Brake Release Command)
250 Vac, max. 1 A
Shield ground terminal
M2 30 Vdc, max 1 A
(min. 5 Vdc, 10 mA)
<8>
M3 Multi-function relay output (Motor Contactor Close Command)
+V Power supply +10.5 Vdc, max. 20 mA 250 Vac, max. 1 A
2 kΩ M4
Electrical Installation
30 Vdc, max 1 A
A1 Analog Input 1 (Speed Bias) (min. 5 Vdc, 10 mA)
Multi-function -10 to +10 Vdc (20 kΩ)
analog inputs M5 Multi-function relay output (Drive Ready) <15>
A2 Analog Input 2 (Not used) 250 Vac, max. 1 A
M6 30 Vdc, max 1 A
-10 to +10 Vdc (20 kΩ)
(min. 5 Vdc, 10 mA)
AC
0V P1
−V Power supply, -10.5 Vdc, max. 20 mA Photo Coupler 1
<8> C1 (During Frequency Output) Digital output
Termination resistor 5 to 48 Vdc
(120 Ω, 1/2 W) P2 2 to 50 mA
Photo Coupler 2 (default setting)
DIP C2 (not used)
Switch S2
R+
R <9>
3
MEMOBUS/Modbus S+ FM
comm. RS485/422 Multi-function analog output 1
+ (Output Speed)
max. 115.2 kBps S FM -10 to +10 Vdc (2mA) <12>
IG
AM
Multi-function analog output 2
AC + (Output Current)
AM
H1 -10 to +10 Vdc (2mA)
<10> 0V
H2
E (G)
<1> Remove the jumper when installing a DC link choke. Models CIMR-L2A0085 through 2A0415 and 4A0045 through 4A0260 come with a
built-in DC link choke.
<2> Set L8-55 to 0 to disable the protection function of the built-in braking transistor of the drive when using an optional regenerative converter
or dynamic braking option.
<3> Set up a thermal relay sequence to disconnect drive main power in the event of an overheat condition on the dynamic braking option.
<4> Self-cooling motors do not require the same wiring necessary for motors with separate cooling fans.
<5> Supplying power to the control circuit separately from the main circuit requires a 24 V power supply (option).
<6> For control modes that do not use a motor speed feedback signal, PG option card wiring is not necessary.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 53
3.2 Standard Connection Diagram
<7> This figure illustrates an example of a sequence input to S1 through S8 using a non-powered relay or an NPN transistor. Install the wire link
between terminals SC-SP for Sink mode, between SC-SN for Source mode, or leave the link out for external power supply. Never short
terminals SP and SN, as it will damage the drive.
<8> The maximum output current capacity for the +V and -V terminals on the control circuit is 20 mA. Never short terminals +V, -V, and AC, as
it can cause erroneous operation or damage the drive.
<11> Disconnect the wire jumper between H1 - HC and H2 - HC when utilizing the Safe Disable input.
<12> Monitor outputs work with devices such as analog frequency meters, ammeters, voltmeters, and wattmeters. They are not intended for use as
a feedback-type of signal.
<13> When the drive is set to trigger a fault output upon activation of the fault reset function (L5-02 = 1), a sequence to interrupt power when a
fault occurs will shut off the power to the drive when the drive attempts a reset. The default setting for L5-02 is 0 (fault output not active
during reset attempt).
<14> Wire fault contact outputs MA, MB, and MC. Wire so that a fault will open the safety circuit and interrupt drive output.
<15> When using the Programming Mode to edit parameter settings, L1000A will not accept an Up/Down command. If the drive still will not run
when an Up/Down command has been entered and no fault is present, then use the "Drive ready" signal (the default setting for terminal M5-
M6) to interlock components.
Note: Although no fault may be present, the drive cannot be started under certain conditions such as when the Digital Operator is left in
the Programming Mode. Use the “Drive Ready” output (default set to terminals M5-M6) to interlock operation in such situations.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Ensure start/stop and safety circuits are wired properly and in the correct state before
energizing the drive. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury from moving equipment.
NOTICE: When using the automatic fault reset function with wiring designed to shut off the power supply upon drive fault, make sure
the drive does not trigger a fault output during fault reset (L5-02 = 0, default). Failure to comply will prevent the automatic fault reset
function from working properly.
54 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.3 Main Circuit Connection Diagram
B1 B2 B1 B2
+1 +1
+2 Relay Relay
Current DC link Current
sensor choke sensor
R/L1 U/T1 R/L1 U/T1
S/L2 + +
V/T2 S/L2 V/T2
T/L3 W/T3 T/L3 W/T3
– –
Jumper YEA_co
mmon
Control Operator Control
Gate board board Gate board Operator
board
+3 +3
Electrical Installation
+1 +1
Relay Relay
DC link Current DC link Current
choke sensor choke sensor
R/L1 U/T1 R/L1 U/T1
+ +
S/L2 V/T2 S/L2 V/T2
T/L3 W/T3 T/L3 W/T3
3
–
YEA_co –
YEA_co
mmon mmon
Control 24 V Control
Gate board Operator Power Gate board Operator
board Supply board
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 55
3.4 Terminal Block Configuration
B1 B2
– B1 B2
+1 +2
B1 B2
CIMR-L4A0075, 0091
YEA_TMonly
R/L1 S/L2 T/L3 – +1 +3 U/T1 V/T2 W/T3
– +1 +3
56 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.5 Terminal Cover
YEA_common
Figure 3.3 Removing the Terminal Cover
2. Push in on the tab located on the bottom of the terminal cover and gently pull forward to remove the terminal
cover.
Figure 3.8
Electrical Installation
YEA_common
Note: The shape of the terminal covers and the numbers of screws differ depending on the drive models. Refer to Component Names
on page 31 for details.
Figure 3.9
YEA_common
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 57
3.5 Terminal Cover
YEA_common
YEA_common
Connect ground wiring first,
followed by the main circuit,
and then wire the control circuit.
58 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.6 Digital Operator and Front Cover
YEA_common
Electrical Installation
YEA_common
YEA_common
Figure 3.11 Remove the Front Cover (Models CIMR-L2A0018 to 2A0075 and 4A0009 to 4A0039)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 59
3.6 Digital Operator and Front Cover
Hook Hook
Figure 3.12 Remove the Front Cover (Models CIMR-L2A0085 to 2A0415 and 4A0045 to 4A0260)
4. Unhook the left side of the front cover then swing the left side towards you as shown in Figure 3.13 until the
cover comes off.
Figure 3.17
Figure 3.13 Remove the Front Cover (Models CIMR-L2A0085 to 2A0415 and 4A0045 to 4A0260)
60 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.6 Digital Operator and Front Cover
Figure 3.14 Reattach the Front Cover (CIMR-L2A0085 to 2A0415 and 4A0045 to 4A0260)
2. After connecting the hooks to the drive, press firmly on the cover to lock it into place.
Electrical Installation
3
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 61
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Comply with proper wiring practices. The motor may run in reverse if the phase order is backward,
causing incorrect elevator direction movement. Connect motor input terminals U, V and W to drive output terminals U/T1,V/T2, and W/
T3. The phase order for the drive and motor should match.
Note: Do not solder the ends of wire connections to the drive. Soldered wiring connections can loosen over time. Improper wiring
practices could result in drive malfunction due to loose terminal connections.
NOTICE: Do not switch the drive input to start or stop the motor. Frequently switching the drive on and off shortens the life of the DC
bus charge circuit and the DC bus capacitors, and can cause premature drive failures. For the full performance life, refrain from
switching the drive on and off more than once every 30 minutes.
62 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring
Yaskawa recommends using closed-loop crimp terminals on all drive models. UL/cUL approval requires the use of
closed-loop crimp terminals when wiring the drive main circuit terminals on models CIMR-L2A0085 to 2A0415 and
4A0045 to 4A0260. Use only the tools recommended by the terminal manufacturer for crimping. Refer to Closed-Loop
Crimp Terminal Size on page 423 for closed-loop crimp terminal recommendations.
The wire gauges listed in the following tables are Yaskawa recommendations. Refer to local codes for proper wire gauge
selections.
■ Three-Phase 200 V Class
Table 3.3 Wire Gauge and Torque Specifications (Three-Phase 200 V Class)
Model Terminal Recomm. Gauge Wire Range Screw Tightening Torque
CIMR-L AWG, kcmil AWG, kcmil Size Nxm (lb.in.)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 10 18 to 10
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 10 18 to 10
–, +1, +2 – 12 to 10 1.2 to 1.5
2A0018 M4
(10.6 to 13.3)
B1, B2 – 14 to 10
10 12 to 10
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 8 12 to 6
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 8 12 to 6 1.2 to 1.5
M4
–, +1, +2 – 10 to 6 (10.6 to 13.3)
2A0025
B1, B2 – 12 to 10
2 to 2.5
8 10 to 8 M5
(17.7 to 22.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 6 12 to 6
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 8 12 to 6 1.2 to 1.5
M4
–, +1, +2 – 6 (10.6 to 13.3)
2A0033
B1, B2 – 12 to 10
2 to 2.5
8 10 to 8 M5
(17.7 to 22.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 4 6 to 4
4 to 6
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 4 6 to 4 M6
(35.4 to 53.1)
Electrical Installation
–, +1, +2 – 6 to 4
2A0047 2 to 2.5
B1, B2 – 10 to 6 M5
(17.7 to 22.1)
4 to 6
6 8 to 6 M6
(35.4 to 53.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 3 10 to 2
9 to11
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 3 10 to 2 M8
(79.7 to 97.4)
–, +1, +2 – 4 to 3
2A0060
B1, B2 – 8 to 6 M5
2 to 2.5
(17.7 to 22.1)
3
4 to 6
6 6 to 4 M6
(35.4 to 53.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 2 10 to 2
9 to11
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 2 10 to 2 M8
(79.7 to 97.4)
–, +1, +2 – 3 to 2
2A0075 2 to 2.5
B1, B2 – 6 M5
(17.7 to 22.1)
4 to 6
6 6 to 4 M6
(35.4 to 53.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 1/0 10 to 1/0
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 1/0 10 to 1/0
–, +1 – 2 to 1/0 9 to 11
2A0085 <1> M8
(79.7 to 97.4)
B1, B2 – 6 to 1/0
6 6 to 4
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 2/0 10 to 3/0
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 2/0 10 to 3/0 18 to 23
M10
–, +1 – 1/0 to 3/0 (159 to 204)
2A0115 <1>
B1, B2 – 4 to 2/0
9 to 11
4 4 M8
(79.7 to 97.4)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 63
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring
64 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring
Electrical Installation
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 3 10 to 3/0
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 3 10 to 3/0
–, +1 – 4 to 1 9 to 11
4A0060 <1> M8
(79.7 to 97.4)
B1, B2 – 6 to 3
6 6
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 2 6 to 250
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 2 6 to 250
–, +1 – 3 to 1/0 9 to 11
4A0075 <1> M8
+3 – 6 to 1/0
(79.7 to 97.4) 3
4 6 to 4
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 1/0 6 to 250
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 1 6 to 250
–, +1 – 3 to 1/0 9 to 11
4A0091 <1> M8
(79.7 to 97.4)
+3 – 4 to 1/0
4 6 to 4
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 3/0 1/0 to 4/0
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 2/0 1/0 to 4/0
–, +1 – 1/0 to 4/0 18 to 23
4A0112 <1> M10
(159 to 204)
+3 – 3 to 4/0
4 4
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 4/0 1/0 to 4/0
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 4/0 1/0 to 4/0
18 to 23
4A0150 <1> –, +1 – 1 to 4/0 M10
(159 to 204)
+3 – 1/0 to 4/0
4 4 to 2
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 65
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Verify motor wiring bare wire ends do not contact the drive chassis or enclosure when wiring drive
terminals U/T1, V/T2, W/T3. Failure to comply may result in serious injury or death due to electrical shock.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Improper equipment grounding could result in death or serious injury by contacting the motor
case. Always properly ground the motor-side grounding terminal.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque. Loose electrical connections could result in
death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical connections. Improperly tightened terminal screws can also cause
erroneous equipment operation.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Do not use an improper voltage source. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire. Verify
that the rated voltage of the drive matches the voltage of the incoming power supply before applying power.
WARNING! Do not connect the AC power line to the output motor terminals of the drive. Failure to comply could result in death or
serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line voltage application to output terminals.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Comply with proper wiring practices. The motor may run in reverse if the phase order is backward,
causing incorrect elevator direction movement and injury to personnel. Connect motor input terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3 to drive
output terminals U/T1,V/T2, and W/T3. The phase order for the drive and motor should match.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Improper equipment sequencing could shorten useful life of the electrolytic capacitors and circuit relays
of the drive. Refrain from switching an input contactor more often than once every 30 minutes. Normally the drive I/O should be used to
stop and start the motor.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. When the input voltage is 480 V or higher or the wiring distance is greater than 100 meters (328 ft.), pay
special attention to the motor insulation voltage or use a drive-rated motor. Failure to comply could lead to motor winding failure.
NOTICE: Do not use the negative DC bus terminal "-" as a ground terminal. This terminal is at high DC voltage potential. Improper
wiring connections could damage the drive.
NOTICE: Improper application of devices on drive output circuits can damage the drive. Do not connect unapproved LC or RC
interference suppression filters, capacitors, ground fault circuits, or overvoltage protection devices to the output of the drive.
NOTICE: Do not connect phase-advancing capacitors or LC/RC noise filters to the output circuits. Failure to comply could result in
damage to the drive, phase-advancing capacitors, LC/RC noise filters or ground fault circuit interrupters.
66 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring
NOTICE: Properly integrate auxiliary contacts into the control logic circuit to avoid unnecessary fault displays caused by contactors or
output switches placed between drive and motor. Improper installation of input and output contactors could result in damage to the
drive.
NOTICE: Before applying power to the drive, use power-off resistance checks to check for short-circuits between (R/L1, S/L2, and
T/L3) or between main circuit terminals and ground. Failure to comply may result in damage to the drive.
Note: When setting carrier frequency for drives running multiple motors, calculate cable length as the total wiring distance to all
connected motors.
■ Ground Wiring
Follow the precautions to wire the ground for one drive or a series of drives.
WARNING! When using an EMC filter, the leakage current exceeds 3.5 mA. Therefore, according to IEC61800-5-1, at least one of the
conditions below must be satisfied:
a) The cross-section of the protective earthing conductor must be at least 10 mm2 (Cu) or 16 mm2 (Al).
b) The power supply must be disconnected automatically in case of discontinuity of the protective earthing conductor.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Always use a ground wire that complies with technical standards on electrical equipment and
local installation regulations. Minimize the length of the ground wire. Improper equipment grounding may cause dangerous electrical
Electrical Installation
potentials on equipment chassis, which could result in death or serious injury.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Be sure to ground the drive ground terminal (200 V class: Ground to 100 Ω or less, 400 V class:
Ground to 10 Ω or less). Improper equipment grounding could result in death or serious injury by contacting ungrounded electrical
equipment.
NOTICE: Do not share the ground wire with other devices such as welding machines or large-current electrical equipment. Improper
equipment grounding could result in drive or equipment malfunction due to electrical interference.
NOTICE: When using more than one drive, ground multiple drives according to instructions. Improper equipment grounding could
result in abnormal operation of drive or equipment.
3
Refer to Figure 3.15 when using multiple drives. Do not loop the ground wire.
Figure 3.19
OK OK Not OK
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 67
3.7 Main Circuit Wiring
A – Protecting Cover
Figure 3.16 Protecting Cover to Prevent Miswiring (CIMR-L2A0047)
68 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.8 Control Circuit Wiring
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Always check the operation and wiring of control circuits after being wired. Operating a drive
with untested control circuits could result in death or serious injury.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Confirm the drive I/O signals and external sequence before starting test run. Failure to comply
may result in death or serious injury.
NOTICE: Frequently switching the drive power supply to stop and start the motor can damage the drive.
NOTICE: To get the full performance life out of the electrolytic capacitors and circuit relays, refrain from switching the drive power
supply off and on more than once every 30 minutes. Frequent use can damage the drive. Use the drive to stop and start the motor.
Note: Do not solder the ends of wire connections to the drive. Soldered wiring connections can loosen over time. Improper wiring
practices could result in drive malfunction due to loose terminal connections.
■ Input Terminals
Electrical Installation
Table 3.6 lists the input terminals on the drive. Text in parenthesis indicates the default setting for each multi-function
input.
Table 3.6 Control Circuit Input Terminals
Type No. Terminal Name (Function) Function (Signal Level) Default Setting Page
S1 Up Command (Closed: Up, Open: Stop)
S2 Down Command (Closed: Down, Open: Stop)
S3 Multi-function input 1 (Nominal Speed) 3
Photocoupler
S4 Multi-function input 2 (Inspection Operation) 24 Vdc, 8 mA
Digital Inputs 352
S5 Multi-function input 3 (Intermediate Speed 1) Use the wire link between terminals SC and SN or between SC and SP to select
sinking or sourcing, and to select the power supply.
S6 Multi-function input 4 (Leveling Speed)
S7 Multi-function input 5 (Not used)
S8 Multi-function input 6 (Not used)
SC Multi-function input common
24 Vdc, 150 mA (only when DI-A3 is not used)
Digital Input
SN 0V Use the wire jumper between terminals SC and SN or between SC and SP to select 75
Power Supply
sinking or sourcing, and to select the power supply.
SP +24 Vdc
H1 Safe Disable input 1 24 Vdc, 8 mA
One or both open: Drive output disabled
Both closed: Normal operation
Safe Disable Internal impedance: 3.3 kΩ
H2 Safe Disable input 2 427
Inputs <1> Off time of at least 1 ms
Set the S3 jumper to select sinking or sourcing, and to select the power supply.
HC Safe Disable function common Common for the Safe Disable function
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 69
3.8 Control Circuit Wiring
Type No. Terminal Name (Function) Function (Signal Level) Default Setting Page
+V Power supply for analog inputs 10.5 Vdc (max allowable current 20 mA) 148
-V Power supply for analog inputs -10.5 Vdc (max allowable current 20 mA) –
148
A1 Multi-function analog input 1 (Speed reference bias) -10 to 10 Vdc, 0 to 10 Vdc (input impedance: 20 kΩ)
197
Analog Inputs
148
A2 Multi-function analog input 2 (Not used) -10 to 10 Vdc, 0 to 10 Vdc (input impedance: 20 kΩ)
198
AC Analog input common 0V 148
E (G) Ground for shielded lines and option cards – –
<1> Setting jumper S3 for an external power supply makes the wire jumper between terminals H1, H2, and HC ineffective. Remove the wire jumper
and connect an external power supply that can supply terminals H1, H2, and HC continuously.
■ Output Terminals
Table 3.7 lists the output terminals on the drive. Text in parenthesis indicates the default setting for each multi-function
output.
Note: Multi-function relay output terminals are rated at a minimum of 10 mA. If less than 10 mA is required, use the photocoupler
outputs (P1-C1, P2-C2). Using the wrong current output level may cause undesirable effects when the terminal is activated.
Table 3.7 Control Circuit Output Terminals
Type No. Terminal Name (Function) Function (Signal Level) Default Setting Page
MA N.O.
30 Vdc, 10 mA to 1 A; 250 Vac, 10 mA to 1 A
Fault Relay MB N.C. output 188
Minimum load: 5 Vdc, 10 mA
MC Fault output common
M1
Multi-function relay output 1 (Brake release command)
M2
Contact relay output
Multi-Function M3 30 Vdc, 10 mA to 1 A
Relay Output Multi-function relay output 2 (Output contactor close command) 188
M4 250 Vac, 10 mA to 1 A
<1>
Minimum load: 5 Vdc, 10 mA
M5
Multi-function relay output 3 (Drive ready)
M6
P1 –
Photocoupler output 1 (During Frequency output)
Multi-Function C1 –
Photocoupler 48 Vdc, 2 to 50 mA <2>
Output P2 –
Photocoupler output 2 (Not Used/Through Mode)
C2 –
FM Analog monitor output 1 (Output speed)
-10 to +10 Vdc or 0 to +10 Vdc 200
Monitor Output AM Analog monitor output 2 (Output current)
AC Monitor common 0V –
Safety Monitor DM+ Safety monitor output Outputs status of Safe Disable function. Closed when both Safe Disable
–
Output DM- Safety monitor output common channels are closed. Up to +48 Vdc 50 mA
<1> Refrain from assigning functions to terminals M1 thru M6 that involve frequent switching, as doing so may shorten relay performance life.
Switching life is estimated at 200,000 times (assumes 1 A, resistive load).
<2> Connect a suppression diode as shown in Figure 3.17 when driving a reactive load such as a relay coil. Make sure the diode rating is greater
than the circuit voltage.
Figure 3.21
C
A D
YEA_common
70 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.8 Control Circuit Wiring
<1> Enable the termination resistor in the last drive in a MEMOBUS network by setting DIP switch S2 to the ON position. For more information on
the termination resistor, refer to Control I/O Configuration on page 75.
◆ Terminal Configuration
Control circuit terminals are arranged as shown in Figure 3.18.
Figure 3.22
YEA_common
Electrical Installation
E(G) HC H1 H2 DM+ DM- IG R+ R- S+ S- M3 M4 M6
V+ AC V- A1 A2 FM AM AC P1 C1 P2 C2 M1 M2 M5
S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 S8 SN SC SP MA MB MC
Select appropriate wire type and gauges from Table 3.9. For simpler and more reliable wiring, use crimp ferrules on the
wire ends. Refer to Table 3.10 for ferrule terminal types and sizes.
Table 3.9 Wire Gauges and Torque Specifications
Tightening Bare Wire Terminal Ferrule-Type Terminal
Terminal Terminal Size Torque Applicable wire size Recomm. mm2 Applicable wire size Recomm. mm2
Block Nxm mm2 mm2 Wire Type
(lb.in.) (AWG) (AWG)
(AWG) (AWG)
FM, AC, AM, P1, P2,
Standard wire:
PC, SC, A1, A2, A3,
0.25 to 1.0
TB1, TB2, +V, -V, S1-S8, MA,
0.22 to 0.25 (24 to 17) 0.75 0.25 to 0.5 0.5
TB4, TB5, MB, MC, M1, M2, HC, M2 Shielded wire, etc.
(1.9 to 2.2) Solid wire: (18) (24 to 20) (20)
TB6 H1, H2, DM+, DM-, IG,
0.25 to 1.5
R+, R-, S+, S-, RP, MP,
(24 to 16)
E (G)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 71
3.8 Control Circuit Wiring
d1
6 mm
YEA_common
L
d2
WARNING! Fire hazard. Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque. Loose electrical connections could result in
death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical connections.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not remove covers or touch the circuit boards while the power is on. Failure to comply could
result in death or serious injury.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Before servicing, disconnect all power to the equipment and lock out the power source. Failure to
comply may result in injury from electrical shock. Wait at least five minutes after all indicators are OFF and measure the DC bus voltage
level and main circuit terminals to confirm the circuit is safe before wiring.
WARNING! Sudden Movement and Hazard. Install additional emergency stop circuits separately from the drive emergency circuits.
Failure to comply may result in personal injury.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Do not connect control circuit ground terminals to the drive enclosure. Improper drive grounding can
cause control circuit malfunction.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Insulate shields with heat shrink tubing or tape to prevent contact with other signal lines and equipment.
Improper wiring practices could result in drive or equipment malfunction due to short circuit.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Use twisted-pair or shielded twisted-pair cables for control circuits. Improper wiring practices could result
in drive or equipment malfunction or nuisance trips.
NOTICE: Connect the shield of shielded cable to the appropriate ground terminal. Improper equipment grounding could result in drive
or equipment malfunction or nuisance trips.
NOTICE: Separate wiring for digital output terminals MA, MB, MC and M1 to M6 from wiring to other control circuit lines. Improper
wiring practices could result in drive or equipment malfunction or nuisance trips.
NOTICE: Separate control circuit wiring from main circuit wiring (terminals R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, B1, B2, U/T1, V/T2, W/T3, -, +1, +2) and
other high-power lines. Improper wiring practices could result in drive malfunction due to electrical interference.
NOTICE: Use a class 2 power supply (UL standard) when connecting to the control terminals. Improper application of peripheral
devices could result in drive performance degradation due to improper power supply.
NOTICE: Do not exceed 50 meters (164 feet ) for the control line between the drive and the operator when using an analog signal from
a remote source to supply the frequency reference. Failure to comply could result in poor system performance.
NOTICE: Do not use unshielded cable for control wiring. Failure to comply may cause electrical interference resulting in poor system
performance. Use shielded, twisted-pair wires, and ground the shield to the ground terminal of the drive.
72 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.8 Control Circuit Wiring
NOTICE: Insulate shields with tape or shrink tubing to prevent contact with other signal lines and equipment. Improper wiring practices
could result in drive or equipment malfunction due to short circuit.
Wire the control circuit only after terminals have been properly grounded and main circuit wiring is complete. Refer to
Figure 3.20 for details. Prepare the ends of the control circuit wiring as shown in Figure 3.21. Refer to Wire Size and
Torque Specifications on page 71.
WARNING! Do not tighten screws beyond the specified tightening torque. Failure to comply may result in erroneous operation, damage
the terminal block, or cause injury due to fire from overheating of loose electrical connections.
NOTICE: Use shielded twisted-pair cables as indicated to prevent operating faults. Improper wiring practices could result in drive or
equipment malfunction due to electrical interference.
A
YEA_common
Preparing wire D
terminal ends
C
Electrical Installation
A – Loosen screw to insert wire C – Avoid fraying wire strands when stripping
insulation from wire. Strip length 5.5 mm.
B – Single wire or stranded wire D – Blade depth of 0.4 mm or less
Blade width of 2.5 mm or less
Figure 3.20 Terminal Board Wiring Guide
When connecting control wires to the terminals, use shielded twisted-pair wires (treating wire ends as shown in
Figure 3.21 and connect the shield to the ground terminal of the drive. 3
Figure 3.25
F C
A D
B E
NOTICE: Do not exceed 50 meters (164 ft.) for the control line between the drive and the operator when using an analog signal from a
remote source to supply the frequency reference. Failure to comply could result in poor system performance.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 73
3.8 Control Circuit Wiring
YEA_c
ommon
Jumper S3
Terminal H1/H2
Sink/Source Sel.
DIP Switch S2
RS-422/485 Termination
Resistor
Off On
74 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.9 Control I/O Configuration
Table 3.11 Digital Input Sink / Source / External Power Supply Selection
Drive Internal Power Supply (Terminal SN and SP) External 24 Vdc Power Supply
S7 S7
S8 S8
SC SC
24 Vdc 24 Vdc
SP External SP
24 Vdc
S7 S7
S8 S8
Electrical Installation
SC SC
24 Vdc 24 Vdc
External
SP SP
24 Vdc
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 75
3.9 Control I/O Configuration
Jumper S3 Jumper S3
24 Vdc 24 Vdc
HC HC
External
24 Vdc
Sinking Mode
H1 H1
H2 H2
Jumper S3 Jumper S3
24 Vdc 24 Vdc
HC HC
External
24 Vdc
Sourcing Mode
H1 H1
H2 H2
76 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.10 Connect to a PC
3.10 Connect to a PC
This drive is equipped with a USB port (type-B).
The drive can connect to a USB port on a PC using a USB 2.0, AB-type cable (sold separately). After connecting the
drive to a PC, Yaskawa DriveWizard Plus software can be used to monitor drive performance and manage parameter
settings. Contact Yaskawa for more information on DriveWizard Plus.
Download and install the USB driver before connecting L1000A to a PC with the USB cable.
To obtain the driver and software of USB Copy Unit, CopyUnitManager and DriveWizardPlus, access these sites:
China: http://www.yaskawa.com.cn
Japan: http://www.e-mechatronics.com
Europe: http://www.yaskawa.eu.com
U.S.A: http://www.yaskawa.com
Other areas: contact a Yaskawa representative.
Figure 3.27
USB Cable
(Type-AB)
(Type-B) (Type-A)
PC
YEA
Figure 3.23 Connecting to a PC (USB)
Electrical Installation
3
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 77
3.11 MEMOBUS/Modbus Termination
Figure 3.28
YEA_TMonly
DIP Switch S2
OFF ON
(OFF:default)
78 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
3.12 Wiring Checklist
2 Make sure you have the correct braking resistors, DC link choke, noise filters, and other peripheral devices. 313
9 Properly wire the power supply to drive terminals R/L1, S/L2, and T/L3. 55
Properly wire the drive and motor together.
10 The motor lines and drive output terminals R/T1, V/T2, and W/T3 should match in order to produce the desired phase order. If the phase order 66
is incorrect, the drive will rotate in the opposite direction.
11 Use 600 Vac vinyl-sheathed wire for the power supply and motor lines. 62
Use the correct wire gauges for the main circuit. Refer to Wire Gauges and Tightening Torque on page 62. 62
• Consider the amount of voltage drop when selecting wire gauges. Increase the wire gauge when the voltage drop is greater than 2% of 62
12 motor rated voltage. Ensure the wire gauge is suitable for the terminal block. Use the following formula to calculate the amount of voltage 67
drop:
Line drop voltage (V) = 3 × wire resistance (Ω/km) × wire length (m) × current (A) × 10-3
• If the cable between the drive and motor exceeds 50 m (164 feet), adjust the carrier frequency set to C6-02 accordingly.
Electrical Installation
13 Properly ground the drive. Review page 67. 67
Tightly fasten all terminal screws (control circuit terminals, grounding terminals).
14 62
Refer to Wire Gauges and Tightening Torque on page 62.
Install a magnetic contactor when using a dynamic braking option. Properly install the resistor and ensure that overload protection shuts off the
15 318
power supply using the magnetic contactor.
16 Verify phase advancing capacitors, input noise filters, or ground fault circuit interrupters are NOT installed on the output side of the drive. –
Control circuit wiring
17 Use twisted-pair line for all drive control circuit wiring. 69 3
18 Connect the shields of shielded wiring to the GND terminal. 72
23 Ensure that no frayed wires on the terminal block are touching other terminals or connections. –
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 79
3.12 Wiring Checklist
80 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4
Start-Up Programming & Operation
This chapter explains the functions of the digital operator and provides programming
instructions for initial drive operation.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 81
4.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Sudden movement Hazard
Do not perform elevator test operations or drive setup when the elevator is occupied.
The elevator car may not stop properly during test operation resulting in serious injury to personnel. Additionally,
ensure these parameters are set correctly and tested before operating an occupied elevator:
• parameter o1-20 (Traction Sheave Diameter)
• parameter S5-11 (Deceleration Distance), or
• parameter S5-12 (Stop Distance)
Use the Initial Pole Search Status Signal (H2- = 61) to interlock the brake to ensure the brake is not released
before the Initial Magnetic Pole Search is completed.
Failure to comply may cause inadvertent elevator movement resulting in serious injury.
This safety message is applicable under these conditions:
-When applying a PM motor, with an external brake sequence, and the PG-F3 option is not being used.
Ensure all personnel are clear of the motor and elevator before Auto-Tuning.
The motor or equipment may suddenly rotate during the Auto-Tuning process, which may result in serious personal
injury or death.
Electrical Shock Hazard
When a drive is running a PM motor, voltage continues to be generated at the motor terminals after the drive is
shut off while the motor coasts to stop.
Take the precautions described below to prevent shock and injury:
• In applications where the machine can still rotate even though the drive has fully stopped a load, install a switch to
the drive output side to disconnect the motor and the drive.
• Do not allow an external force to rotate the motor beyond the maximum allowable speed or to rotate the motor when
the drive has been shut off.
• Wait for at least the time specified on the warning label after opening the load switch on the output side before
inspecting the drive or performing any maintenance.
• Do not open and close the load switch while the motor is running, as this can damage the drive.
• If the motor is coasting, make sure the power to the drive is turned on and the drive output has completely stopped
before closing the load switch.
82 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Sudden Movement Hazard
Ensure all personnel are clear of the motor and elevator before Auto-Tuning.
The motor or equipment may suddenly rotate during the Auto-Tuning process, which may result in serious personal
injury or death.
The drive is capable of running the motor at high speed.Verify the maximum drive output frequency before
starting the drive.
Failure to comply may cause injury or death due to inadvertent high speed operation.
Verify drive parameter b1-03 Stopping Method is set to 0:Ramp to Stop before starting the drive.
Failure to comply may cause the elevator to free-fall when the Up/Down command is removed.
System may start unexpectedly upon application of power when the Auto-Reset function is enabled resulting in
death or serious injury.
Use care when enabling Auto-Reset as this function may cause unintended start of the elevator.
If holding brake circuits are not configured properly, load equipment may fall or drop during power loss or
drive fault, which could result in death or serious injury.
• Provide a separate holding brake if necessary.
• Always construct the external sequence to confirm that the holding brake is activated in the event of an emergency, a
power failure, or an abnormality in the drive.
• If using the drive with an elevator, provide safety measures on the elevator to prevent the elevator from dropping.
Install additional emergency stop circuits separately from the drive emergency circuits.
Failure to comply may result in personal injury.
Remove the Up/Down Command before resetting alarms and faults.
Failure to comply can result in death or serious injury.
Electrical Shock Hazard
Operation
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
Do not remove covers or touch circuit boards while the power is on.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. 4
CAUTION
Preventing Injury
Clear personnel, secure equipment and check sequence and safety circuitry before starting the drive.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury from moving equipment.
Clear all personnel from the drive, motor, and machine area.
• Secure covers, couplings, shaft keys, and machine loads.
• Ensure start/stop and safety circuits are wired properly and in the correct state.
Burn Hazard
Do not touch a hot drive heatsink.
Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury. Shut off the power to the drive when replacing the cooling
fan. To prevent burns, wait at least 15 minutes and make sure heatsink has cooled down.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 83
4.1 Section Safety
NOTICE
Sudden Movement Hazard
The drive and motor may start unexpectedly during Auto-Tuning, which could result in death or serious injury.
• Remove main power from the drive before servicing the drive or motor.
• Do not touch the motor during Auto-Tuning.
• Ensure the area surrounding the drive motor and load are clear before proceeding with autotuning.
Equipment Hazard
Only perform Rotational Auto-Tuning with the motor disconnected from the load (ropes removed from traction
sheave).
Failure to comply will cause the drive will be unable to automatically set motor parameters correctly. This will result in
erroneous operation.
Do not check or test control circuit signals while the drive is running.
Improper use of test equipment could result in damage to the drive circuitry by short circuit.
Do not use the Rescue Operation feature for extended periods.
Failure to comply may result in drive heat sink overtemperature alarms (oH).
Set parameter E1-01 to match the input voltage of the drive. The drive input voltage (not motor voltage) must
be set in E1-01 for the protective features to function properly.
Failure to set the correct drive input voltage may result in improper drive operation.
Use the the drives Torque Detection function to notify the PLC of potential overcurrent or overload situations at
the load prior to a drive overload fault.
Failure to comply may cause the drive to fault leaving the motor coasting, potentially damaging equipment.
Correctly set parameter o2-04 when replacing the control terminal board.
Failure to comply may result in drive damage due to lack of protective functions and poor drive performance.
84 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.2 Using the Digital Operator
1
F1 F2
11 YEA_common
2 ESC
LO
RE
9
3 RESET ENTER
8
10 RUN STOP
4 5 6 7
Figure 4.1 Keys and Displays on the Digital Operator
F1
Function Key The functions assigned to F1 and F2 vary depending on the currently displayed menu. The name of each func-
1
(F1, F2) tion appears in the lower half of the display window.
F2
Operation
Down command was active during power up.
5 Up Arrow Key Scrolls up to display the next item, select parameter numbers, and increment setting values.
6 Down Arrow Key Scrolls down to display the next item, select parameter numbers, and increment setting values.
4
7 STOP STOP Key <1> Stops drive operation.
Switches drive control between the operator (LOCAL) and the control circuit terminals (REMOTE) for the
9 LO LO/RE Selection Key <2> Run command and speed reference. The LED is on when the drive is in the LOCAL mode (operation from
RE keypad).
10 RUN Light Lit while the drive is operating the motor. Refer to page 88 for details.
RUN
11 LO LO/RE Light Lit while the operator is selected to run the drive (LOCAL mode). Refer to page 88 for details.
RE
12 ALM LED Light Refer to ALARM (ALM) LED Displays on page 87.
<1> The STOP key has highest priority. Pressing the STOP key will always cause the drive to stop the motor, even if an Up/Down command is
active at any external Up/Down command source. To disable the STOP key priority, set parameter o2-02 to 0.
<2> The LO/RE key can only switch between LOCAL and REMOTE when the drive is stopped. By default settings the LO/RE key function is
disabled. To allow using the LO/RE key for switching between LOCAL and REMOTE, set parameter o2-01 to 1.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 85
4.2 Using the Digital Operator
◆ LCD Display
Figure 4.2
1 2 3
9 8 7
Figure 4.2 LCD Display
Table 4.1 Display and Contents
No. Name Display Content
MODE Displayed when in Mode Selection.
MONITR Displayed when in Monitor Mode.
VERIFY Indicates the Verify Menu.
1 Operation Mode Menus
PRMSET Displayed when in Parameter Setting Mode.
A.TUNE Displayed during Auto-Tuning.
SETUP Displayed when in Setup Mode.
DRV Displayed when in Drive Mode.
2 Mode Display Area
PRG Displayed when in Programming Mode.
3 Ready Rdy Indicates the drive is ready to run.
4 Data Display – Displays specific data and operation data.
OPR Displayed when the speed reference source is assigned to the LCD Operator.
Speed Reference Source
5 COM Displayed when the speed reference source is assigned to MEMOBUS/Modbus Communication.
Assignment <1>
OP Displayed when the speed reference is assigned to an option card.
RSEQ Displayed when the Up/Down command is supplied from a remote source.
LO/RE LSEQ Displayed when the Up/Down command is supplied from the operator keypad.
6
Display <2> RREF Displayed when the speed reference is supplied from a remote source.
LREF Displayed when the speed reference is supplied from the operator keypad.
FWD/REV Pressing F1 switches between Up and Down when the Up/Down command is set from the digital operator.
86 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.2 Using the Digital Operator
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Operating a drive with untested emergency circuits could result in death or serious injury.
Always check the operation of any fast stop circuits after they are wired. Fast stop circuits are required to provide safe and quick
shutdown of the drive.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Ensure start/stop and safety circuits are wired properly and in the correct state before
energizing the drive. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury from moving equipment.
■ Status Display
When the power supply to the drive is turned on, the digital operator lights will appear as follows:
Operation
- MODE - DRV YEA_ Data displayed varies by the type of fault. Refer to Fault Displays, Causes, and Possible Solutions on page 257
Fault EF3
Ext Fault S3 common for more information and possible solutions. ALM LED is lit and DRV displayed.
FWD RESET
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 87
4.2 Using the Digital Operator
Examples
<1> Refer to Figure 4.3 for the difference between “flashing” and “flashing quickly”.
Figure 4.3
1s
ON ON
Flashing
common_TM
only
Flashing ON ON ON ON
quickly
88 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.2 Using the Digital Operator
- MODE - PRG
Programming Mode <2>
Quick Setting
Initial Display <5>
L1000A
HELP FWD DATA XXXVX.X/X.XkW
L1000A XX.XX/XX.XXA
YASKAWA <XXXXXXXXX>
<6>
- MODE - PRG
Programming
AUTO
YEA_common
Operation
Figure 4.5 Digital Operator Menu and Screen Structure
<1> Pressing RUN will start the motor. 4
<2> Drive cannot operate the motor.
<3> Flashing characters are shown as 0 .
<4> An "X" character is used as a placeholder for illustration purposes in this manual. The LCD Operator will display the actual setting
values.
<5> The Speed Reference appears after the initial display which shows the product name.
<6> The information that appears on the display will vary depending on the drive.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 89
4.3 The Drive and Programming Modes
- MODE - PRG
Modified Consts
Verify Menu Modified YEA_common Lists all parameters that have been edited or changed from default settings. Refer to Verifying Parameter
X Parameters Changes: Verify Menu on page 93.
HELP FWD DATA
- MODE - PRG
Quick Setting
Programming A select list of parameters necessary to get the drive operating quickly. Refer to Using the Setup Group on
Mode Setup Group
YEA_common page 94.
- MODE - PRG
Programming
Parameter Setting
Mode Allows the user to access and edit all parameter settings. Refer to Parameter Table on page 338.
YEA_common
90 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.3 The Drive and Programming Modes
- MODE - PRG
Auto-Tuning
Auto-Tuning Mode YEA_common Motor parameters are calculated and set automatically. Refer to Auto-Tuning on page 104.
Programming AUTO
Mode
HELP FWD DATA
Speed reference
display at power up
F1 F2
- MODE - DRV Rdy -MONITR- DRV Rdy
Speed Ref (OPR) Spd Ref 1(d1-01) left right
U1-01= 0.00%
U1-01= 000.00%
U1-02= 0.00% RSEQ 㧔0.00㨪100.00㧕
U1-03= 0.00A LREF ̌0.00%̍
Press until the frequency
FWD
φ FWD
ψ reference changes to 010.00%
Operation
Figure 4.6 Setting the Speed Reference while in the Drive Mode
Note: The drive will not accept a change to the speed reference until the ENTER key is pressed after the speed reference is entered. This
feature prevents accidental setting of the speed reference. To have the drive accept changes to the speed reference as soon as
changes are made without requiring the ENTER key, set o2-05 to 1. 4
■ Programming Mode Details
The following actions are possible in the Programming Mode:
• Parameter Setting Mode: Access and edit all parameter settings.
• Verify Menu: Check a list of parameters that have been changed from their original default values.
• Setup Group: Access a list of commonly used parameters to simplify setup (refer to Simplified Setup Using the Setup
Group on page 94)
• Auto-Tuning Mode: Automatically calculate and set motor parameters to optimize drive performance.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 91
4.3 The Drive and Programming Modes
Step Display/Result
- MODE - PRG
Programming
2.
Press or until the Parameter Setting Mode screen appears.
HELP FWD DATA
-PRMSET- PRG
Initialization
3. A1-00=0
Press to enter the parameter menu tree. Select Language
FWD
-PRMSET- PRG
Basic Setup
4. C1-01 = 1.50 sec
Press or to select the C parameter group. Accel Ramp 1
φ FWD
ψ
-PRMSET- PRG -PRMSET- PRG
Accel/Decel Accel Ramp 1
5. C1-01= 1.50 sec C1-01= 1.50 sec
Press two times. Accel Ramp 1 (0.0~600.00)
“1.50 sec”
φ FWD
ψ φ FWD
ψ
-PRMSET- PRG
Decel Ramp 1
C1-02= 1.50 sec
6. (0.0~600.00)
Press or to select the parameter C1-02.
“1.50 sec”
φ FWD
ψ
-PRMSET- PRG
Decel Ramp 1
7. C1-02= 001.50 sec
Press to view the current setting value (1.5 s). The left most digit flashes. (0.0~600.00)
“1.50 sec”
φ FWD
ψ
-PRMSET- PRG
Decel Ramp 1
8. Press F1 , F2 or until the desired number is selected. “1” flashes. C1-02=001.50 sec
(0.0~600.00)
left right “1.50 sec”
φ FWD
ψ
-PRMSET- PRG
Decel Ramp 1
9. C1-02=002.50 sec
Press and enter 0020.0. (0.0~600.00)
“1.50 sec”
φ FWD
ψ
10.
Press to confirm the change. Entry Accepted
92 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.3 The Drive and Programming Modes
Step Display/Result
-PRMSET- PRG
Decel Ramp 1
11. The display automatically returns to the screen shown in Step 4. C1-02= 2.50 sec
(0.0~600.00)
“1.50 sec”
φ FWD
ψ
- MODE - DRV Rdy
Speed Ref (OPR)
U1-01= 0.00%
12.
Press as many times as necessary to return to the initial display. U1-02= 0.00% RSEQ
U1-03= 0.00A LREF
FWD
The following example is a continuation of the steps above. Here, parameter C1-02 is accessed using the Verify Menu,
and is changed again from 1.50 s to 2.50 s.
The steps below are an example of how to check the list of edited parameters:
Step Display/Result
- MODE - PRG
Modified Consts
2. Modified
Operation
Press or until the display shows the top of the Verify Menu.
X Parameters
HELP FWD DATA
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 93
4.3 The Drive and Programming Modes
Speed reference
appears when
powered up
- SETUP - PRG Rdy
<1> Control Method
A1-02= 2 ∗2∗
Open Loop Vector
<1> Use the up and down arrow keys to scroll through the Setup Group. Press the ENTER key to view or change parameter settings.
<2> To return to the previous menu without saving changes, press the ESC key.
94 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.3 The Drive and Programming Modes
Note: Parameter availability depends on the control mode set in A1-02; some parameters listed above may not be accessible in all
control modes.
Step Display/Result
Operation
Speed Ref(A1/A2)
U1-01= 0.00%
1. Turn on the power to the drive. The initial display appears.
YEA_c U1-02= 0.00% RSEQ
U1-03= 0.00A RREF
ommon FWD
YEA_ F1
FWD
F2
2.
Press . The LO/RE light will light up. The drive is now in LOCAL. com- ESC
LO
RE
mon RESET
RUN
ENTER
STOP
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 95
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
96 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
START
Operation
Set the Speed Reference Selection mode
Analog Input parameter d1-18
Fine-tuning
• Adjust settings for the brake sequence (S1-) .
• Adjust speed control loop (C5-) etc.
FINISH
Figure 4.8 Installation, Wiring, Basic Setup for Motor and Elevator
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 97
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
◆ Power On
Take the following precautions before applying main power to the drive:
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Ensure start/stop, I/O and safety circuits are wired properly and in the correct state before
energizing or running the drive. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury from moving equipment.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Do not use an improper voltage source. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire. Verify
that the rated voltage of the drive matches the voltage of the incoming power supply before applying power.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Loose electrical connections could result in death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical
connections. Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Do not connect the AC power line to the output motor terminals of the drive. Failure to comply could result in
death or serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line voltage application to output terminals.
• Do not connect AC line power to output terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3.
• Make sure that the power supply lines are connected to main circuit input terminals R/L1, S/L2, and T/L3
(or R/L1 and S/L2 for single-phase power).
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Clear personnel, secure equipment and check sequence and safety circuitry before starting
the drive. Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury from moving equipment.
• Clear all personnel from the drive, motor, and machine area.
• Secure covers, couplings, shaft keys, and machine loads.
• Ensure start/stop and safety circuits are wired properly and in the correct state.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Operating a drive with untested emergency circuits could result in death or serious injury.
Always check the operation of any fast circuits after they are wired. Fast circuits are required to provide safe and quick shutdown of the
drive.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Comply with proper wiring practices. The motor may run in reverse if the phase order is backward.
Connect motor input terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3 to drive output terminals U/T1,V/T2, and W/T3. The phase order for the drive and
motor should match.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Check all the wiring including the PG encoder wiring and PG option jumper settings, to ensure that all
connections are correct after installing the drive and connecting any other devices. Failure to comply could result in damage to the
drive.
After applying the power, the drive mode display should appear and no fault or alarm should be displayed. In the event of
a drive fault or error code, refer to Drive Alarms, Faults, and Errors on page 252.
98 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
Note: Always perform motor rotation direction setup prior to setting the encoder rotation direction.
◆ PG Encoder Setup
■ PG Encoder Resolution Setup
Set the encoder resolution (incremental signal in the case of absolute encoders with Sin/Cos channels) in parameter F1-
01.
■ PG Encoder Rotation Direction Setup
Perform the following steps to make sure the PG encoder rotation direction is set up correctly in the drive:
If information about the signal sequence of the PG encoder is available:
1. Check the sequence of PG encoder phases A and B when the motor drives the elevator in up direction.
Operation
2. If the value in U1-05 is positive, the set PG encoder direction is correct.
3. If the value in U1-05 is negative, alter the setting of parameter F1-05.
Note: Always set the motor rotation direction prior to the encoder rotation direction. Refer to Motor Rotation Direction Setup on
page 99. 4
◆ Digital Operator Display Unit Selection
The drive can display different types of engineering units for speed related parameters and monitors, acceleration and
deceleration ramp, and jerk settings. Select the speed units using parameter o1-03 as shown below.
Display Unit
o1-03 Setting Speed Setting/Monitors Accel/Decel Ramp Jerk Settings
(d1-, U1-02, U1-02,...) (C1-) (C2-)
0 0.01 Hz
1 (default) 0.01% 0.01 s 0.01 s
Set as the time in required to accelerate from zero Set as the time used to change the accel/decel ramp
2 1 rpm
to the rated speed, and to decelerate from rated from zero to the accel/decel ramp setting of C1-
3 User defined speed to zero. and vice versa.
4 0.01 m/s
5 0.01 m/s 0.01 m/s2 (Set as accel/decel ramp) 0.01 m/s3 (set as jerk value)
6 0.1 ft/min 0.01 ft/s2 (Set as accel/decel ramp) 0.01 ft/s3 (set as jerk value)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 99
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
Certain mechanical data must be programmed to the drive prior to setting o1-03 to 4, 5, or 6. Perform the following steps
when using one of those settings:
1. Make sure motor data are set up correctly. Verify the setting of the maximum output frequency in parameter E1-04 and
the setting for the number of motor poles in parameter E2-04 or E5-04.
2. Set the traction sheave diameter in units of mm to parameter o1-20.
3. Set the correct roping to parameter o1-21.
4. If a mechanical gear is used, set the gear ratio (nMotor/nTraction Sheave) to parameter o1-22. If a gearbox is not used, make
sure o1-22 is set to 1.0.
5. Change parameter o1-03 to setting 4 or 5. The unit and setting values of related parameters will be changed
automatically.
100 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
START
YEA_common
No
Yes
A1-02=2 or 3
(Ropes removed)
Is the Control Mode Can the motor
V/f Control ? rotate freely?
Yes
A1-02=0 No
Refer to Enter the data in to T1- parameters as indicated on the Enter the data in to T1- parameters as
Auto-Tuning Fault Detection display. indicated on the display.
on page 276 Press the Up key until “Tuning Ready” is displayed. <1> Press the Up key until “Tuning Ready” is
Remove the source of Fault/Alarm displayed. <1>
and repeat Auto Tuning.
Release the Brake.
Operation
Tuning
No Successful?
(Alarm or Fault code
displayed Yes
(“Entry Accepted”
displayed) <2> 4
Apply the brake if it was released during Auto-tuning.
Open the motor contactor(s).
Open terminals H1-HC and H2-HC if used during the normal sequence.
Open the Baseblock input (H1-=8/9) if used.
FINISH
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 101
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
START
Set terminals H1-HC and H2-HC if Safe Disable function is used. YEA_common
Set the Baseblock input (H1-=8/9) if used.
No
Is the motor data
sheet available?
Yes
No
(Alarm or Fault code
Tuning displayed
Successful?
Yes
(“Entry Accepted”
displayed <2>
FINISH
102 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.4 Start-Up Flowcharts
START
Yes
YEA_comm
on
Set terminals H1-HC and H2-HC if Safe Disable function is used
Set the Baseblock input (H1-=8/9) if used
Close the motor contactor(s)
Yes
(Stationary PG Encoder Offset Absolute PG No
Auto-Tuning possible)
encoder used? (PG-X3, Incremental
Yes PG encoder used)
(EnDat, ...)
Operation
and wait until Auto-Tuning is finished.
No Refer to
Tuning Auto-Tuning Fault Detection
Successful? on page 276
Remove the Fault/Alarm source
Yes and repeat Auto Tuning.
FINISH
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 103
4.5 Auto-Tuning
4.5 Auto-Tuning
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. The drive and motor may start unexpectedly during Auto-Tuning, which could result in death or
serious injury. Ensure the area surrounding the drive motor and load are clear before proceeding with Auto-Tuning. Remove main
power from the drive before servicing the drive or motor. Do not touch the motor during Auto-Tuning.
Note: When using a PM motor for the first time, or when replacing the drive or PM motor, always make sure that motor parameters are
set properly and the speed detection functions accurately prior to operation. Using a PM motor requires that the encoder offset be
set correctly in addition to entering motor data to corresponding parameters. If the motor, encoder, or drive are ever replaced, be
sure to perform Encoder Offset Auto-Tuning.
Insufficient torque can cause the elevator car to move in the direction of the load, or cause the motor to behave erratically
(reverse operation, stand still, sudden accelerations, etc.).
For more information, refer to the instruction manual included with the motor.
◆ Types of Auto-Tuning
The drive offers different types of Auto-Tuning for induction motors and permanent magnet motors. The type of Auto-
Tuning used differs further based on the control mode and other operating conditions. Refer to the tables below to select
the type of Auto-Tuning that bests suits the application. Directions for performing Auto-Tuning are listed in Start-Up
Flowcharts on page 96.
Note: The drive will only show Auto-Tuning parameters that are valid for the control mode that has been set in A1-02. If the control
mode is for an induction motor, the Auto-Tuning parameters for PM motors will not be available. If the control mode is for a PM
motor, the Auto-Tuning parameters for induction motors will not be available. Inertia Tuning and ASR Gain Tuning parameters
and setting options will be visible only when the drive is set for operation with CLV or CLV/PM.
This feature automatically sets the V/f pattern and motor parameters E1- and E2- for an induction motor.
Additionally, the feature also sets some F1- parameters for speed feedback detection in Closed Loop Vector.
Table 4.5 Types of Auto-Tuning for Induction Motors
Control Mode (A1-02)
Type Setting Requirements and Benefits
V/f (0) OLV (2) CLV (3)
• Rotational Auto-Tuning gives the most accurate results, and is recommended if possible.
Rotational Auto-Tuning T1-01 = 0 No Yes Yes
• Motor must run freely or with light load (<30%), i.e. ropes have to be removed.
• A motor test report listing motor data is not available.
Stationary Auto-Tuning 1 T1-01 = 1 • Automatically calculates motor parameters needed for vector control. No Yes Yes
• Use if ropes can not be removed. Note that the accuracy is less then with Rotational Auto-Tuning.
• Used for V/f Control or in vector control modes when the drive was previously set up properly and now
Stationary Auto-Tuning
the motor cable has changed.
for Line-to-Line Resis- T1-01 = 2 Yes Yes Yes
• Used in V/f control if drive and motor capacities differ.
tance
• Should not be used for any vector control modes unless the motor cable has changed.
• A motor test report is available. Once the no-load current and the rated slip have been entered, the drive
Stationary Auto-Tuning 2 T1-01 = 4 calculates and sets all other motor-related parameters. No Yes Yes
• Use if ropes can not be removed and if slip and no-load current data are available.
Table 4.6 lists the data that must be entered for Auto-Tuning. Make sure this data is available before starting Auto-
Tuning. The necessary information is usually listed on the motor nameplate or in the motor test report provided by the
motor manufacturer. Also refer to pages 97 and 101 for details on Auto-Tuning process and selections.
104 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.5 Auto-Tuning
Operation
Tuning Type (T2-01)
Input 2 11
Input Value Unit 0 1
Parameter Stationary Stator Rotational Back
Motor Data input Stationary
Resistance EMF Constant
Control Method A1-02 - 7 7 7 7
4
Motor Rated Power T2-04 kW Yes Yes No No
Motor Rated Voltage T2-05 Vac Yes Yes No No
Motor Rated Current T2-06 A Yes Yes Yes No
Number of Motor Poles T2-08 - Yes Yes No No
Motor Rated Speed T2-09 r/min Yes Yes No No
Stator 1 Phase Resistance T2-10 Ω Yes No No No
d-axis Inductance T2-11 mH Yes No No No
q-axis Inductance T2-12 mH Yes No No No
Voltage Constant <1> T2-13 mVs/rad (el.) Yes No No No
Voltage Constant <1> T2-14 mVmin (mech.) Yes No No No
Encoder Resolution (Pulses per Revolution) T2-16 - Yes Yes No No
Encoder Offset T2-17 deg (mech.) Yes Yes No No
<1> Only parameter T2-13 or T2-14 has to be input. Select one and leave the other empty.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 105
4.5 Auto-Tuning
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not touch the motor during Auto-Tuning. Lethal voltages may be present on the motor case.
Failure to comply may result in serious injury from electrical shock.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. When executing Stationary Auto-Tuning for motor data or PG encoder offset, the motor does not
rotate, however, power is applied. Do not touch the motor until Auto-Tuning is completed. Failure to comply may result in death or
serious injury from electrical shock.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. The holding brake must remain engaged for the entire Stationary Auto-Tuning sequence.
Ensure a brake release digital output signal cannot be issued by the drive. Failure to comply could result in serious injury or death.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Do not release the mechanical brake during Stationary Auto-Tuning. Inadvertent brake release
may cause damage to equipment or injury to personnel. Ensure that the mechanical brake release circuit is not controlled by the drive
multi-function digital outputs exclusively.
• Rotational Auto-Tuning is the preferred tuning method because it gives more accurate results than Non-Rotating Auto-
Tuning. Perform Rotational Auto-Tuning when the motor can be uncoupled from the elevator mechanical system
(remove ropes from traction sheave). Perform Stationary Auto-Tuning when the motor and mechanical system cannot
be uncoupled.
• Make sure that the mechanical brake remains applied for all Stationary Auto-Tuning methods. Make sure to release the
brake for all Rotational Auto-Tuning methods.
• When using a motor contactor, make sure it is closed throughout the Auto-Tuning process.
• H1 and H2 signals must be ON when performing Auto-Tuning.
• A digital input programmed for Baseblock (H1- = 8/9) must be set so that the drive is not in a baseblock condition.
• Confirm that the motor is mechanically fixed.
• To cancel Auto-Tuning, press the STOP key on the digital operator.
106 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.5 Auto-Tuning
• Auto-Tuning requires the user to input data from the motor nameplate or motor test report. Make sure this data is
available before Auto-Tuning the drive.
• When using Auto-Tuning for motor 2, make sure motor 2 is connected to the drive output when performing the tuning.
• For best performance, the drive input supply voltage must be greater than the motor rated voltage.
Note: Improved performance is possible when using a motor with a base voltage that is 20 V (40 V for 400 V class models) lower than
the input supply voltage. This is particularly important when operating the motor above 90% of base speed, where high torque
precision is required.
DANGER! Sudden Movement Hazard. Stay clear of the motor during rotational autotuning. The motor may start operating suddenly.
During automatic starting of equipment, the machine may start moving suddenly, which could result in death or serious injury.
• Clear all personnel from the drive, motor, and machine area before applying power.
• Secure covers, couplings, shaft keys, and machine loads before applying power to the drive.
Table 4.10 describes digital input and output terminal operation while Auto-Tuning is executed.
Table 4.10 Digital Input and Output Operation During Auto-Tuning
Motor Type Auto-Tuning Type Digital Input Digital Output
Rotational Auto-Tuning Digital input functions are disabled. Functions the same as during normal operation
Stationary Auto-Tuning 1 Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
IM Motor
Stationary Auto-Tuning for Line-to-Line Resistance Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
Stationary Auto-Tuning 2 Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
Motor Data Input Digital input functions are disabled. Digital output functions are disabled.
Stationary Auto-Tuning Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
Stationary Stator Resistance Auto-Tuning Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
PM Motor Initial Magnet Pole Search Parameters Auto-Tuning Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
Stationary PG Encoder Offset Auto-Tuning Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
Rotational PG Encoder Offset Auto-Tuning Digital input functions are disabled. Maintains the status at the start of Auto-Tuning
Rotational Back EMF Constant Auto-Tuning Digital input functions are disabled. Functions the same as during normal operation
Note: When using a PM motor for the first time or when replacing the drive or PM motor, be sure to set the motor parameters properly
and check that the speed detection functions properly prior to operation. Using a PM motor requires setting the encoder offset
correctly and entering motor data. Perform Encoder Offset Auto-Tuning after replacing the motor, encoder, or drive. Insufficient
torque may cause the elevator car to move in the direction of the load or cause the motor to behave erratically (reverse operation,
Operation
code will appear on the digital operator.
Figure 4.9
A B
DIGITAL OPERATOR JVOP-180
ALM DIGITAL OPERATOR JVOP-180
ALM
4
- A.TUNE - DRV Rdy - MODE - DRV
REV DRV
DRV FOUT
Tune Proceeding
X.XX Hz/ X.XXA Er-03
STOP key YEA_
FWD FWD RESET common
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 107
4.5 Auto-Tuning
Step Display/Result
- MODE - PRG
Auto-Tuning
2.
Press or until the Auto-Tuning display appears. AUTO
- A.TUNE - PRG
Tuning Mode
3. T1-01= 0 ∗0∗
Press to begin setting parameters. Standard Tuning
- A.TUNE - PRG
Tuning Mode
4. T1-01= 0 ∗0∗
Press to select the value for T1-01. Standard Tuning
“0”
FWD
5.
Save the setting by pressing . Entry Accepted
- A.TUNE - PRG
Tuning Mode
6. The display automatically returns to the display shown in Step 3. T1-01= 0 ∗0∗
Standard Tuning
Step Display/Result
- A.TUNE - PRG
Mtr Rated Power
1. T1-02= 3.70kW
Press to access the motor output power parameter T1-02. (0.00 ~ 650.00)
“3.70kW”
ESC FWD DATA
- A.TUNE - PRG
Mtr Rated Power
2. T1-02= 003.70kW
Press to view the default setting. (0.00 ~ 650.00)
“3.70kW”
FWD
- A.TUNE - PRG
Mtr Rated Power
3. Press F1 , F2 , , and to enter the motor power nameplate data in kW. T1-02= 004.00kW
left right (0.00 ~ 650.00)
“3.70kW”
FWD
4.
Press to save the setting. Entry Accepted
108 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.5 Auto-Tuning
Step Display/Result
- A.TUNE - PRG
Mtr Rated Power
5. The display automatically returns to the display in Step 1. T1-02= 4.00kW
(0.00 ~ 650.00)
“3.70kW”
ESC FWD DATA
- A.TUNE - PRG
Mtr Rated Power
T1-02= 4.00kW
(0.00 ~ 650.00)
“3.70kW”
Repeat Steps 1 through 5 to set the following parameters: ESC FWD DATA
• T1-03, Motor Rated Voltage
• T1-04, Motor Rated Current
6.
• T1-05, Motor Base Frequency
• T1-06, Number of Motor Poles
• T1-07, Motor Base Speed - A.TUNE - PRG
Rated Speed
T1-07= 1450RPM
(0 ~ 24000)
“1450RPM”
ESC FWD DATA
Note: Refer to Parameter Settings during Induction Motor Auto-Tuning: T1 on page 110 for details.
■ Starting Auto-Tuning
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. The drive and motor may start unexpectedly during Auto-Tuning, which could result in death or
serious injury. Ensure the areas surrounding the drive, motor and load are clear before proceeding with Auto-Tuning.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. High voltage will be supplied to the motor when Stationary Auto-Tuning is performed even with
the motor stopped, which could result in death or serious injury. Do not touch the motor until Auto-Tuning has been completed.
WARNING! When performing Rotational Auto-Tuning for motor data or PG encoder offset, always uncouple the motor from the
mechanical system (remove ropes from traction sheave). Performing Rotational Auto-Tuning with the mechanical system connected to
the motor can cause hazardous situations, injury to personnel and damage to the equipment.
NOTICE: Rotational Auto-Tuning will not function properly if a holding brake is applied on the load. Ensure the motor can freely spin
before beginning Auto-Tuning. Failure to comply could result in improper operation of the drive.
Enter the required information from the motor nameplate. Press to proceed to the Auto-Tuning start display.
Step Display/Result
- A.TUNE - DRV
Auto-Tuning
Operation
1. 0.00 Hz/ 0.00A
After entering the data listed on the motor nameplate, press to confirm. Tuning Ready ?
Press RUN key
ESC FWD
Press to activate Auto-Tuning. The drive begins by injecting current into the motor for about 1 min,
- A.TUNE - DRV Rdy
Tune Proceeding 4
2. and then starts to rotate the motor. X.XX Hz/ X.XXA
Note: The first digit on the display indicates which motor is undergoing Auto-Tuning (motor 1 or motor 2). The
second digit indicates the type of Auto-Tuning being performed. FWD
- MODE - DRV
FWD RESET
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 109
4.5 Auto-Tuning
<1> Values shown are specific to 200 V class drives. Double value for 400 V class drives.
110 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.5 Auto-Tuning
Operation
No. Name Setting Range Default
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 111
4.5 Auto-Tuning
112 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.5 Auto-Tuning
0: mV (r/min)
1: mV (rad/sec)
Note: If T2-13 is set to 0, then the drive will use E5-24 (Motor Induction Voltage Constant 2), and will automatically set E5-09 (Motor
Induction Voltage Constant 1) to 0.0. If T2-13 is set to 1, then the drive will use E5-09 and will automatically set E5-24 to 0.0.
Operation
T2-14 PM Motor Induced Voltage Constant 0.0 to 2000.0 Depending on T2-02
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 113
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Verify drive parameter b1-03 Stopping Method is set to 0:Ramp to Stop before starting the
drive. Failure to comply may cause the elevator to free-fall when the Up/Down command is removed.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. The drive is capable of running the motor at high speed. Verify the maximum drive output
frequency before starting the drive. Failure to comply may cause injury or death due to inadvertent high speed operation.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard.Use the Initial Pole Search Status Signal (H2- = 61) to interlock the brake to ensure the
brake is not released before the Initial Magnetic Pole Search is completed. Failure to comply may cause inadvertent elevator
movement resulting in serious injury.
<1> If source of the speed reference is assigned to the control terminals (b1-01 = 1), then d1-18 will automatically be set to 0 (so that the drive uses
multi-speed references d1-01 to d1-08).
<2> If the speed reference selection in d1-18 is set so that either the high speed reference has priority (d1-18 = 1), or so that the leveling speed has
priority (d1-18 = 2), then the drive will look to the multi-function input terminals for the speed reference.
114 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
• A fault occurs. The stopping method depends on the specific fault that occurred, in combination with certain parameter
settings.
• The Safe Disable inputs are opened or a Base Block signal is input. In this case, the brake is applied immediately and
the drive output shuts off.
Different speed reference settings can be selected by combining the three digital inputs as shown in the table below.
Note: Parameters d1-19 through d1-26 are displayed only if d1-18 is set to 1 or 2.
Operation
0 0 1 Speed reference 5 (d1-05)
1 0 1 Speed reference 6 (d1-06)
0 1 1 Speed reference 7 (d1-07)
1 1 1 Speed reference 8 (d1-08) 4
0 = Off, 1 = On
Setting d1-18 = 0
Up to eight speed references can be set using parameters d1-01 to d1-08. The drive starts with an Up or Down command,
and stops when the Up or Down command is removed. When d1-18 = 0, parameters d1-19 through d1-23 will not be
displayed.
Setting d1-18 = 3
Allows seven speed references to be set using parameters d1-02 to d1-08. The drive starts with an Up or Down command,
and stops either when all three input terminals that set the speed reference are released, or when the Up/Down command
is released. When d1-18 = 0, parameters d1-19 through d1-23 will not be displayed.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 115
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Different speed settings can be selected depending on the assignment of the speed selection digital inputs (H1-) as
shown in the table below.
Note: Parameters d1-19 through d1-26 are displayed only if d1-18 is set to 1 or 2.
Leveling and Nominal Speed assigned Leveling speed not assigned Nominal Speed not assigned
Selected Speed (H1- = 50 and H1- = 53) (H1- ≠ 53) (H1- ≠ 50)
50 51 52 53 50 51 52 51 52 53
Nominal Speed (d1-19) 1 0 0 A 1 0 0 0 0 0
Intermediate Speed 1 (d1-20) 0 1 0 A 0 1 0 1 0 0
Intermediate Speed 2 (d1-21) 1 1 1 A 1 1 1 N/A N/A N/A
Intermediate Speed 3 (d1-22) 0 1 1 A 0 1 1 1 1 0
Releveling Speed (d1-23) 0 0 1 A 0 0 1 0 1 0
Leveling Speed (d1-26) 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 B B B
Zero Speed 0 0 0 0 N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
0 = Off, 1 = On, A = 0 when d1-18 = 2 and no influence when d1-18=1, B = no influence, N/A = Not available
Higher Speed has Priority and the Leveling Speed Input is Assigned (d1-18 = 1 and H1- = 53) (Default)
The higher speed has priority over the leveling speed. The leveling signal is disregarded as long as any other speed
selection input is active. The drive decelerates to the leveling speed (d1-26) when the selected speed reference signal is
removed.
DC Injection/ DC Injection/
Position lock Position lock
Speed
Safe disable (terminals H1/H2 on)
and Baseblock off (H1-=8/9)
Up/Down Command
Leveling speed
Selected speed (other than leveling)
Input is set No effect
Higher Speed Priority is Selected and the Leveling Speed Input is Not Assigned (d1-18 = 1 and H1- ≠ 53)
The drive decelerates to the leveling speed (d1-26) when the selected speed reference signal is removed.
If no speed reference is selected at start, the drive will trigger an “FrL” fault. Set parameter S6-15 to 0 to disable Speed
Reference Missing (FrL) detection. With this setting the drive starts using leveling speed if no other speed reference is
selected.
DC Injection/ DC Injection/
Position lock Position lock
Speed
116 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Leveling Speed has Priority and the Leveling Speed Input is Assigned (d1-18 = 2, H1- = 53)
The leveling signal has priority over other speed references. The drive decelerates to the leveling speed (d1-26) when the
leveling speed selection input is activated. The drive stops when either the leveling input or the Up/Down command is
released.
DC Injection/ DC Injection/
Position lock Position lock
Speed
Safe disable (terminals H1/H2 on)
and Baseblock off (H1-=8/9)
Up/Down Command
Leveling speed Leveling speed has priority
Leveling Speed Priority is Selected and the Nominal Speed Input is Not Assigned (d1-18 = 2, H1- ≠ 50)
The drive runs at nominal speed (d1-19) when no speed selection input is set. When the leveling speed signal is set, the
drive decelerates to the leveling speed. The leveling speed signal has priority over all other speed signals.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. This function may not work properly if a broken wire connection to the drive I/O causes improper elevator
speed selection. Properly tighten wire connections at the drive terminals before enabling this function.
DC Injection/ DC Injection/
position lock position lock
Speed
Safe disable (terminals H1/H2 on)
and Baseblock off (H1-=8/9)
Up/Down Command
Leveling speed
Operation
The H2 parameters assign functions to digital output terminals M1-M2, M3-M4, M5-M6, P1-C1, and P2-PC digital input
terminal functions, refer to H2-01 to H2-05: Terminals M1-M2, M3-M4, M5-M6, P1-PC, and P1-P2 Function
Selection on page 188. 4
■ Multi-Function Analog Inputs
The H3 parameters assign functions to analog input terminals A1 and A2 analog input functions, refer to Multi-Function
Analog Input Terminal Settings on page 199.
■ Multi-Function Analog Outputs
The H4 parameters assign functions to analog output terminals FM and AM. Select the function for these terminals by
entering the last three digits of the desired U monitor. For a list of analog output functions, refer to U: Monitors on
page 372.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 117
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Figure 4.10
C2-03
(Jerk at
C2-02 Decel Start)
(Jerk at
Accel End) C2-04
(Jerk at
C2-01 Decel End) C2-05 (Jerk Below Leveling Speed)
C1-01
(Jerk at (Accel Ramp 1)
Accel Start) d1-26 (Leveling Speed)
C1-02
(Decel Ramp 1)
Figure 4.13 Accel/Decel Ramp and the Jerk Function
Units used to set the acceleration and deceleration ramp as well as the Jerk function change with the setting of parameter
o1-03. Refer to Digital Operator Display Unit Selection on page 99 for details.
◆ Inspection Operation
■ Start Condition in Inspection Operation
Inspection operation is performed when an Up or Down signal is input while one of the following conditions is true:
• Parameter d1-18 is set to 0 or 3 and the selected speed is higher than d1-28 but lower than d1-29.
• Parameter d1-18 is set to 1 or 2 and a digital input programmed for Inspection Operation Speed (H1- = 54) is
enabled.
Inspection Operation uses the same acceleration characteristics and brake sequence at start as normal operation.
The carrier frequency is set to 2 kHz during Inspection Operation, but can be changed using parameter C6-21.
■ Stop Condition in Inspection Operation
To stop the drive during Inspection Operation, either remove the Up or Down command or reset the input terminal for
Inspection Operation.
A deceleration ramp can be set for Inspection Operation using parameter C1-15.
• If C1-15 = 0.00, the drive immediately applies the brake, shuts off the drive output, and opens the motor contactor, i.e.,
the multi-function output terminals set for “Brake Control” (H2- = 50) and “Output Contactor Control” (H2- =
51) are cleared.
• If C1-15 > 0.00, the drive decelerates to stop at the rate set to C1-15, then applies the brake, shuts the output off, and
opens the motor contactor.
■ Inspection Operation Timing Chart
A timing chart for Inspection Operation appears in Figure 4.14.
Inspection Operation without Decel Ramp (C1-15=0) Inspection Operation with Decel Ramp (C1-15>0)
Speed Speed
Safe disable (terminals H1/H2 on) Safe disable (terminals H1/H2 on)
and Baseblock off (H1-=8/9) and Baseblock off (H1-=8/9)
H1- = 54 (Inspection Operation) H1- = 54 (Inspection Operation)
<1> <1>
Up/Down command Up/Down command
H2- = 51 (Output Cont. Contr.) H2- = 51 (Output Cont. Contr.)
H2- = 50 (Brake Control) H2- = 50 (Brake Control)
<1> The drive stops if either the Up/Down command or Inspection Operation signals are removed.
Figure 4.14 Inspection Operation Sequence
118 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
◆ Brake Sequence
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Rapid deceleration may cause the drive to fault on an overvoltage condition, resulting in death
or serious injury due to an uncontrolled motor state. Be sure to set an acceptable deceleration time in parameter C1-09, Fast Stop
Ramp, when using the fast-stop feature.
The drive supports two types of brake sequences, one with torque compensation at start using an analog input terminal
(H3- = 14) and the other without torque compensation at start.
■ Brake Sequence without Torque Compensation
To configure the brake sequence operation without torque compensation, do not set any analog input terminals for
“Torque compensation” (H3- = 14).
Figure 4.11
S1-04 S1-05
S1-10 (DC Injection/ Selected Speed (DC Injection
(Up/Down Command PositionLock Braking/Position
Time at Start) Lock Time at stop) S1-11
Delay Time) d1-26 (Output Contactor
DC Injection Braking/ (Leveling Speed) DC Injection/ Open Delay Time)
Position Lock at Start Position Lock at Stop
Speed
S1-06 S1-07
(Brake (Brake
Release Close
Delay
Time) Delay
Up/Down Command Time)
Safe disable (terminals H1/H2 on)
and Baseblock off (H1-=8/9)
Output Contactor Control
(H2-= 51)
Motor Contactor Response
(H1-= 56)
Brake Control (H2-= 50)
t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9
Enabled
Operation
Time Zone Description
Up or Down command is issued.
Safe Disable terminals H1-HC and H2-HC must be set and Baseblock must be disabled (digital inputs set to H1- = 8/9).
Speed reference must be selected by multi-function input terminals.
t1 Output contactor control signal is set (H2- = 51) by the drive.
4
Drive waits for the “Motor Contactor Feedback” signal (H1- = 56) to be issued. If the motor contactor feedback is not received within t1, or if
the feedback signal is on before the contactor control command has been issued, an SE1 fault is triggered.
If the motor contactor feedback signal is not used, then the drive waits for the operation start delay time set in S1-10 to pass, then proceeds to the
next step.
After the delay time set in S1-10 has passed, the drive outputs current to the motor.
t2 DC Injection Braking or Position Lock begins.
After the brake release delay time set in S1-06 has passed, the drive sets the “Brake Control” output (H2- = 50) in order to release the brake.
DC Injection Braking or Position Lock will continue until:
t3 the time S1-04 has elapsed, or
the time S1-06 has elapsed if S1-06 > S1-04 (this setting should be avoided since the motor could be driven against the applied brake).
t4 The drive accelerates up to the selected speed. The speed is kept constant until the leveling speed is selected.
t5 Leveling speed is selected. The drive decelerates to the leveling speed and maintains that speed until the Up or Down command is removed.
t6 The Up or Down signal is cleared. The drive decelerates to zero speed.
The motor speed reaches the zero speed level (S1-01).
t7 DC Injection Braking or Position Lock is then executed for the time set in S1-05.
After the delay time to apply the brake set in S1-07 has passed, the drive clears the “Brake Control” output (H2- = 50). The brake applies.
t8 The drive continues DC Injection or Position Lock until the time S1-05 has passed. When S1-05 has passed the drive output is shut off.
After the delay for the magnetic contactor set in S1-11 has passed, the drive resets the output terminal set for “Output Contactor Control” (H2-
t9 = 51).
The Safe Disable Inputs can be cleared and Baseblock can be enabled.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 119
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9
Enabled
120 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
To use torque compensation at start, apply at least 50% of the maximum weight to the elevator car and set the drive
according to the Load Condition 2 procedure below. If using a voltage signal to the analog input terminals as a load
sensor, then that input signal will determine the rate of torque compensation applied according to S3-27 and S3-28.
Before the torque compensation function can be used, the analog input scaling must be adjusted to the load sensor output.
This can be done by bringing the elevator into two different load conditions and teaching the corresponding analog input
value and torque reference value to the drive.
Note: 1. This torque compensation requires a closed loop control mode (CLV, CLV/PM).
2. The torque compensation value is limited to 120%.
Set an analog input terminal for torque compensation (H3- = 14) and proceed with the steps below.
Procedure for Load Condition 1 (S3-27, S3-29)
1. Make sure the drive is wired properly. For instructions, refer to Standard Connection Diagram on page 52.
2. Set the speed reference to 0%.
3. Apply no weight to the elevator car.
4. Note the value of the analog input monitor for the load signal input is connected to (U1-13 for terminal A1, U1-14
for terminal A2).
5. Provide an elevator Up or Down command, using Inspection Operation or normal operation mode. The car
should be held in place when the brake releases.
6. Note the drives internal torque reference monitor U1-09.
7. Stop the drive.
8. Set the value noted in step 4 to parameter S3-29. Set the value noted in step 6 to parameter S3-27.
Procedure for Load Condition 2 (S3-28, S3-30)
1. Set the speed reference to 0%.
2. Apply load to the car has much as possible (at least 50% of the maximum weight).
Operation
5. Note the drives internal torque reference monitor U1-09.
6. Stop the drive.
7. Set the value noted in step 3 to parameter S3-30. Set the value noted in step 5 to parameter S3-28.
After setting load conditions 1 and 2, perform a trial run. If required, parameter S3-12 can be set up to add a bias to the 4
load sensor input when riding in a Down direction (default: 0.0%, same torque compensation characteristics in up and
down direction). Figure 4.15 illustrates the effect of torque compensation on the settings of S3-12 and S3-27 through S3-
30.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 121
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Figure 4.13
S3-27
(Torque Compensation Value
with Load Condition 1) During Load Condition 1
Figure 4.17 Torque Compensation at start for the Elevator in Up and Down Direction
122 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
<1> Insert 0 kg for the load to calculate the lowest setting, insert the elevator rated load to calculate the maximum setting for n5-03. Use the lower
setting for initial trials.
4. Change the setting of n5-03 within the limits calculated in step 3 until the desired performance is achieved.
If possible, trace the output speed after soft starter (U1-16) and the motor speed (U1-05) values. Increase n5-03 if the
motor speed does not follow the speed after soft start. Decrease n5-03 if the motor overshoots the designated speed at
the end of acceleration or undershoots the speed at the end of deceleration.
■ Adjusting Position Lock at Start (CLV/PM)
Set the S3- and C5- parameters as described below in order to reduce rollback effects at start.
• With the elevator car unloaded, adjust the speed loop gain (C5-19) and integral time for Position Lock (C5-20). Increase
the gain and reduce the integral time in order to reduce the rollback of the car. Set parameters C5-19 and
C5-20 in the opposite way if vibration occurs.
• Adjust the Position Lock at start gain 2 (S3-02). Increase S3-02 if rollback occurs, decrease S3-02 it if vibration occurs.
• If the elevator is balanced and oscillation at start occurs, attempt gradually increasing the setting in S3-40 in increments
of one pulse.
◆ Rescue Operation
In the event of a power outage, Rescue Operation allows the elevator to travel to the nearest floor by switching to a
backup battery or UPS (Uninterruptable Power Supply) for power.
Operation
NOTICE: When changing parameters while the drive is supplied from the rescue operation power supply, wait at least 5 s after entering
parameters before switching off the power supply. Instantly switching off the power can cause parameter settings corruption that can
only be resolved by initializing the drive. This may cause erroneous drive performance.
4
■ Drive Power Supply for Rescue Operation
There are various methods of supplying power to the drive for rescue operation. Independent of the chosen method, the
voltage in the DC bus of the drive and the voltage supplied to the drive control circuit must meet the specifications
provided in Table 4.13.
The DC bus voltage can either be supplied by a battery connected to the DC bus terminals of the drive or by a UPS
connected to drive terminals L1 and L2. The control circuit voltage can be supplied directly from the drives DC bus (no
external wiring required), from an external battery (connection to CN19), or by using an optional 24 Vdc control power
backup unit.
When using a single-phase AC power supply for rescue operation such as a single-phase UPS, the ripple in the DC bus
voltage will be higher than with a three-phase or battery supply. Make sure that the DC bus voltage never falls below the
minimum value listed in Table 4.13.
When using a PM motor with an incremental PG encoder and a PG-X3 option card, always perform Initial Magnet Pole
Search Parameters Auto-Tuning (T2-01=3) with the normal power supply connected. The tuning function will prepare the
drive for Rescue Operation by automatically setting certain parameters. If the tuning ends with an “End8” to “End10”
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 123
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
fault, then rescue operation will require a battery or UPS that supplies the drive DC bus with at least 280 Vdc for 200 V
class drives and 560 Vdc for 400 V class drives. Alternatively utilize to an absolute PG encoder and a PG-E3 or PG-F3
option card.
Table 4.13 Power Supply Ratings for Rescue Operation
Motor Type Speed Feedback DC Bus Voltage Control Circuit Voltage
Incremental PG Encoder with PG-X3 option 200 V class drives: 48 to 340 Vdc
Induction Motor
card 400 V class drives: 96 to 680 Vdc
Incremental PG Encoder with PG-X3 option
card 200 V class drives: 280 to 340 Vdc When supplied from a battery or the drive DC bus:
“End8” to “End10” error occurs during Initial 400 V class drives: 560 to 680 Vdc 200 V class drives: 250 to 340 Vdc
Magnet Pole Search Auto-Tuning 400 V class drives: 280 to 680 V (recommended: 500 to 680 Vdc)
Incremental PG Encoder with PG-X3 option
Permanent Magnet Motor When supplied via a 24 Vdc control power backup unit:
card 200 V class drives: 72 to 340 Vdc
No error occurs during Initial Magnet Pole 400 V class drives: 144 to 680 Vdc 200 V and 400 V class drives: 24 Vdc
Search Auto-Tuning
Absolute PG Encoder with PG-F3 or PG-E3 200 V class drives: 48 to 340 Vdc
option card 400 V class drives: 96 to 680 Vdc
■ Parameter Setup
Adjust drive parameters as described below when using Rescue Operation.
• Select the type of Rescue Operation power supply for the drives main circuit in parameter S4-06.
• When using a UPS, set the UPS power value to parameter S4-07. Use parameter S4-08 to decide if the Rescue
Operation speed shall be limited automatically depending on the UPS power.
• If deterioration of the battery or UPS shall be detected, also set up parameters S4-12 and S4-13. Measure the DC bus
voltage during operation using the rescue power supply and set the measured value to parameter S4-12. Set the
deterioration detection level to parameter S4-13.
• Set parameters S4-01 to S4-04 if light load direction search shall be automatically performed when Rescue Operation is
started.
■ Wiring Examples
Switching the main power supply to a battery or UPS requires magnetic contactors that must be controlled by an external
controller. Wiring methods and the sequence used for the magnetic contactors depend on the application. This instruction
manual describes the following configurations:
• A single-phase, 230 V UPS is used as backup power supply for a 200 V or 400 V class drive.
• Two separate batteries for the main power and control power supplies. Main power battery voltage is below 250 Vdc for
200 V class drives or 500 Vdc for 400 V class drives.
• Two separate batteries. One is used for the main power supply, a second battery supplies the controller via an optional
24 V Backup Power Supply Unit.
• A single battery with minimum 250 Vdc for 200 V class drives or 500 Vdc for 400 V class drives is used for the main
and control power supply.
Select the configuration that matches your application. Follow the corresponding instructions for wiring and drive
settings. For configurations not covered in the list above, contact your Yaskawa representative or our sales office directly
for consultation.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not connect or disconnect wiring while the power is on. Never remove or install option cards or
attempt to replace the cooling fan while the drive is switched on. Make sure that the drive and all devices connected to the drive have
been shut off prior to performing and type of maintenance or wiring. After shutting off the power, wait for at least the amount of time
specified on the drive before touching any components or perform wiring. The internal capacitor remains charged even after the power
supply is turned off.
NOTICE: Be sure to thoroughly read the instructions for wiring and magnetic contactor sequence described in this section before
setting up the drive for Rescue Operation. Failure to follow these instructions can damage the drive.
NOTICE: Refrain from using Rescue Operation for extend periods of time. Rescue Operation uses a low DC bus voltage, which can
cause the cooling fan to shut off temporarily during Rescue Operation. Continuing to operate under these conditions can trigger an
overheat fault and damage the drive.
124 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Elevat or
cont rol
syst em Magnetic L1000A
Contactor A B2
N UPS
sine wave
230 Vac
single-phase +1
+2 U/T1
R/L1
L1 V/T2
S/L2
L2 W/T3
T/L3
L3
Magnetic -
Contactor B
Power supply Control
CN19 circuit
1
H1- = غغ55 S3 to S8
(Rescue Operation) SC
Magnetic Contactor A
Operation
Operation Sequence
Starting Rescue Operation
1. Open contactor B. 4
2. Set the input terminal programmed for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Close contactor A.
4. Set the Up/Down command.
Ending Rescue Operation
1. After the car has stopped open contactor A.
2. Clear the input terminal set for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Close contactor B to return to operation with normal power supply.
Application Precautions
The drive may fault on a control power supply fault (Uv2) if the UPS can’t provide enough voltage, or if the Light Load
Direction Search is not set properly. If this problem occurs, take the following corrective actions:
Corrective Action:
• Use a separate battery for the controller power supply.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 125
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
• Use a battery with a voltage higher than 250 Vdc for 200 V class drives or 500 Vdc for 400 V class drives and connect
it to the control power supply input (CN19). Alternatively use a 24 Vdc battery and an optional 24 V Backup Power
Supply Unit.
• Enable Light Load Direction Search (S4-01 = 1).
■ Using Separate Batteries for DC Bus and Control Power Supply, DC Bus Battery under 250
Vdc (500 Vdc)
Follow these instructions when using separate batteries for Rescue Operation with the battery for the DC bus having a
lower voltage than 250 Vdc for 200 V class drives and 500 Vdc for 400V class drives.
Wiring
Follow the wiring diagram shown in Figure 4.19. When connecting the battery for the control power supply to the
L1000A, use the 1.1 m cable packaged with the product. The connector cover must first be removed in order to access
connection port CN19 for the battery. Refer to Connecting the Drive and Battery on page 129 for details.
Figure 4.15
L1000A
B2
B1
Magnetic Contactor A
+1
+2 U/T1
DC bus power supply
Battery for DC bus R/L1
L1 V/T2
48 to 340 Vdc
S/L2
96 to 680 Vdc L2 W/T3
T/L3
L3
Magnetic Contactor B -
Control
Magnetic Contactor C Power supply
CN19 circuit
Battery for 1
control circuit
250 to 340 Vdc
(500 to 680 Vdc 4
5s 0.5 s
Magnetic Contactor A
Magnetic Contactor C
H1- = غغ55
(Rescue Operation)
Figure 4.19 Wiring Two Batteries for DC Bus and Control Power Supply (DC Bus Battery is less than 250 V)
Operation Sequence
Starting Rescue Operation
1. Open contactor B and wait at least 5 seconds.
2. Set the input terminal programmed for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Close contactors A and C.
4. Set the Up/Down command.
Ending Rescue Operation
1. After the car has stopped, open contactors A and C.
2. Clear the input terminal set for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Wait at least 0.5 s and then close contactor B to return to operation with normal power supply.
126 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
■ Using a Battery for the DC Bus and 24 V Power Supply Unit Option for the Control Circuit
Follow the instructions when using a 24 V Power Supply Unit option for the control circuit and a battery for the main
circuit. The main circuit battery voltage must be higher than 48 Vdc for 200 V class drives and 96 Vdc for 400 V class
drives.
Wiring
Yaskawa offers a 24 V Power Supply Option for the control circuit that is useful in applications unable to connect to a
backup battery greater than 250 V. Wiring instructions can be found in Figure 4.20. For a more detailed explanation of
the 24 V Power Supply Option, refer to the manual provided with the option.
Figure 4.16
L1000A
B2
B1
Magnetic Contactor A
+1
S 3S 8
H1- = غغ55
(Rescue Operation) SC
5s 0.5 s
Magnetic Contactor A
Magnetic Contactor C
Operation
H1- = غغ55
(Rescue Operation)
Figure 4.20 Using a Battery for the DC Bus and 24 V Power Supply Unit Option for the Control Circuit
Operation Sequence 4
Starting Rescued Operation
1. Open contactor B and wait at least 5 seconds.
2. Set the input terminal programmed for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Close contactors A and C.
4. Set the Up/Down command.
Ending Rescue Operation
1. After the car has stopped, open contactors A and C.
2. Clear the input terminal set for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Wait at least 0.5 s and then close contactor B to return to operation with normal power supply.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 127
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
L1000A
B2
B1
Magnetic Contactor A
Magnetic Contactor B -
Power supply Control
CN19 circuit
1
Magnetic Contactor A
H1- = غغ55
(Rescue Operation)
Figure 4.21 Using a Backup Battery With Minimum 250 Vdc (500 Vdc)
Operation Sequence
Starting Rescue Operation
1. Open contactor B.
2. Set the input terminal programmed for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Close contactor A.
4. Set the Up/Down command.
Ending Rescue Operation
1. After the car has stopped, open contactor A.
2. Clear the input terminal set for Rescue Operation (H1- = 55).
3. Close contactor B to return to operation with normal power supply.
128 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
DANGER! Switch off the power supply before wiring and connecting the battery cable. Failure to comply will lead to death or serious
injury from electric shock.
NOTICE: A straight-edge screwdriver should be inserted into the opening provided on the connector cover at the proper angle.
Attempting to insert the screwdriver blade at a different angle could damage the drive.
Figure 4.18
Operation
4
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 129
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
3. Use a pair of diagonal cutters to cut an opening in the connector cover that allows the cable to pass through. The
cable should pass through the connector cover with the cover fastened to the drive.
Figure 4.20
Connect
to battery.
130 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
Screw
Connector
cover
Operation
4
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 131
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
NOTICE: Be sure that the connector fastens at the correct angle to the CN19 connector port. The incorrect angle could damage the
battery, cable, or connector.
Figure 4.26
Port CN19
Battery cable
Downward Leftward
132 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
7. Use a Phillips screwdriver (M4) to fasten the screw that holds the CN19 connector cover in place.
NOTICE: Use the screw provided to fasten the connector cover into place. Using a different screw may damage the internal drive
components.
Figure 4.29
Connect
to battery
Operation
■ Light Load Direction Search Function
Light Load Direction Search can be used to automatically perform Rescue Operation in the direction with the lower load.
4
It can help to minimize the amount of power required by the backup power supply required for Rescue Operation. Light
Load Direction Search can be set so that it is automatically performed when Rescue Operation is started. To enable Light
Load Direction Search set parameter S4-01 = 1.
When Light Load Direction Search is enabled the drive first runs in the up and then in the down direction, each for the
time set to S4-03. It then compares the load condition of both operations and travels to the next floor using the lighter load
condition direction. The speed reference used for Light Load Direction Search can be set in parameter S4-04.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 133
4.6 Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications
• When the lightest load direction is up, the drive stops after Light Load Direction Search and then accelerates upwards to
the Rescue Operation speed set in parameter d1-25. The output terminals set for “Light Load Direction” (H2- = 54)
and “Light Load Direction detection status”(H2- = 55) will close.
Figure 4.31
Up command (internal) Up Up
Up command (internal) Up
134 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.7 Setup Troubleshooting and Possible Solutions
Symptom Page
Cannot Change Parameter Settings 135
Motor Does Not Rotate Properly after Pressing RUN Button or after Entering Motor Does Not Rotate 135
External Up/Down Command Motor Rotates in the Opposite Direction from the Up/Down Command 136
Motor Gets Too Hot 136
Drive Does Not Allow Selection of Rotational Auto-Tuning 136
Noise From Drive or Output Lines When the Drive is Powered On 136
Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter (GFCI) 136
Riding comfort related problems 137
◆ Motor Does Not Rotate Properly after Pressing RUN Button or after Entering
External Up/Down Command
Operation
The drive is not in the Drive Mode.
• Enter the Drive Mode. Refer to The Drive and Programming Modes on page 90.
Stop the drive and check if the correct frequency reference source is selected. If the digital operator is the source, the
LO/RE button LED must be on. If the source is REMOTE, it must be off.
Take the following steps to solve the problem:
The button is enabled (o2-01=1) and was pushed.
• Push the button.
4
• o2-01 is set to 0 by default, i.e. the LO/RE button is disabled.
• When Auto-Tuning completes, the drive is switched back to the Programming Mode. The Up/Down command will
Auto-Tuning has just completed. not be accepted unless the drive is in the Drive Mode.
• Use the digital operator to enter the Drive Mode. Refer to The Drive and Programming Modes on page 90.
A Fast Stop was executed and is not reset. Reset the Emergency Stop command.
Check parameter b1-02 (Up/Down Command Selection).
Set b1-02 so that it corresponds with the correct Up/Down command source.
Settings are incorrect for the source that provides the Up/Down 0: Digital operator
command. 1: Control circuit terminal (default setting)
2: MEMOBUS/Modbus communications
3: Option card
• Check the wiring for the control terminal.
There is faulty wiring in the control circuit terminals. • Correct wiring mistakes.
• Check the input terminal status monitor (U1-10).
Check parameter b1-01 (Speed Reference Selection).
Set b1-01 to the correct source of the speed reference.
0: Digital operator
The speed reference source setting is incorrect.
1: Control circuit terminal (default setting)
2: MEMOBUS/Modbus communications
3: Option card
The settings for the analog speed reference are incorrect. Check the settings (signal level, function, bias, gain) for the analog input that supplies the speed reference.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 135
4.7 Setup Troubleshooting and Possible Solutions
• When the STOP button is pressed, the drive will decelerate to stop.
The STOP button is enabled (o2-02=1) and was pressed
• Switch off the Up/Down command and then re-enter a new Up/Down command.
when the drive was started from a REMOTE source. • o2-02 is set to 0 by default, i.e. the Stop button is disabled.
◆ Electrical Noise From Drive or Output Lines When the Drive is Operating
Cause Possible Solutions
• Lower the carrier frequency (C6-03).
• Install a noise filter on the input side of drive input power.
• Install a noise filter on the output side of the drive.
PWM switching in the drive generates excessive noise. • Place the wiring inside a metal conduit to shield it from switching noise.
• Ground the drive and motor properly.
• Separate the main circuit wiring and the control lines.
• Make sure wires and the motor have been properly grounded.
136 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.7 Setup Troubleshooting and Possible Solutions
Operation
when the motor reaches top
CLV/PM Incorrect motor data. (E2-02) and no-load current values (E2-03), or perform Auto-Tuning again.
speed.
• For PM motors readjust the motor data in E5- or perform Auto-Tuning.
If the Inertia Compensation Function is used (n5-01=1) make sure the values
Inertia compensation function is not set up correctly.
in n5-02 and n5-03 are correct.
All
The acceleration rate changes too quickly when reaching the Decrease the Jerk at the End of Acceleration. Decrease C2-02 if set in m/s2, 4
selected speed. increase C2-02 if set in s.
Increase the Minimum and Middle Voltage Levels for the V/f pattern voltage
V/f and OLV Not enough torque at low speed. (E1-10 and E1-08 respectively). Make sure that the Starting and Leveling
Current does not rise too high.
OLV and Motor data incorrect. Adjust the motor data (E2- ), especially the motor slip (E2-02) and no-
CLV Too much slip compensation. load current values (E2-03), or perform Auto-Tuning.
Motor stops shortly (under- Increase the Speed Control Gain and reduce the Speed Control Integral Time
shoot) when the leveling used for Low Speed at Stop. The parameters to be changed depend on the set-
speed is reached. Speed control loop responds too slow.
CLV ting of C5-05 and whether a third set of speed loop settings is used. Refer to
CLV/PM Speed Loop Adjustments (CLV and CLV/PM) on page 122.
If the Inertia Compensation Function is used (n5-01 = 1) make sure the values
The inertia compensation function is not set up correctly.
in n5-02 and n5-03 are correct.
The deceleration rate changes too quickly when reaching Decrease the Jerk at the End of Deceleration. Decrease C2-04 if set in m/s2,
All
leveling speed. increase C2-04 if set in s.
Motor speed overshoot at
acceleration end and under-
Use the Inertia Compensation Function. Set n5-01 to 1 and then adjust param-
shoot when reaching leveling CLV
Inertia is high. eters n5-02 and n5-03 as described in Inertia Compensation (CLV and CLV/
speed occurs. Problem can CLV/PM
PM) on page 122.
not be resolved by adjusting
the speed loop.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 137
4.7 Setup Troubleshooting and Possible Solutions
138 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
4.8 Verifying Parameter Settings and Backing Up Changes
Operation
can be set and monitored.
2: Advanced Access Level. All parameters can be set and monitored.
Parameters selected by the user are saved as User Parameters, including recently viewed parameters and parameters
specifically selected for quick access.
A2-01
User Parameters If parameter A2-33 is set to 1, recently viewed parameters will be listed between A2-17 and A2-32. Parameters A2-01 A1-00 to
to
A2-32
1 to 32 through A2-16 must be manually selected by the user. o4-13
– 4
If A2-33 is set to 0, recently viewed parameters will not be saved to the group of User Parameters. A2- parameters
are now available for manual programming.
0: Parameters A2-01 through A2-32 are reserved for the user to create a list of User Parameters.
User Parameter
1: Save history of recently viewed parameters. Recently edited parameters will be saved to A2-17 through A2-32 for
A2-33 Automatic Selec- 0, 1 1
quick access. The most recently changed parameter is saved to A2-17. The second most recently changed parameter is
tion
saved to A2-18.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 139
4.8 Verifying Parameter Settings and Backing Up Changes
◆ Copy Function
Parameter settings can be copied to another drive to simplify parameter restoration or multiple drive setup. The drive
supports the following copy options:
• LCD Operator (standard in all models)
The LCD operator used to operate the drive supports copying, importing, and verifying parameter settings. Refer to o3:
Copy Function on page 228 for details.
• USB Copy Unit and CopyUnit Manager
The Copy Unit is an external option connected to the drive to copy parameter settings from one drive and save those
settings to another drive. Refer to the manual supplied with the USB Copy Unit for instructions.
CopyUnit Manager is a PC software tool that allows the user to transfer parameter settings between the Copy Unit and
a PC. This tool is especially useful when managing parameters for various drives or applications. Refer to the manual
supplied with CopyUnit Manager for instructions.
• DriveWizard Plus
DriveWizard is a PC software tool for parameter management, monitoring, and diagnosis. DriveWizard can load, store,
and copy drive parameter settings. For details, refer to Help in the DriveWizard software.
Note: To obtain the driver and software of USB Copy Unit, Copy Unit Manager and DriveWizardPlus, access these sites:
China: http://www.yaskawa.com cn
Europe: http://www.yaskawa.eu.com
Japan: http://www.e-mechatronics.com
U.S.A.: http://www.yaskawa.com
Other areas: contact a Yaskawa representative.
140 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5
Parameter Details
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 141
5.1 A: Initialization
5.1 A: Initialization
The initialization group contains parameters associated with initial setup of the drive. Parameters involving the display
language, access levels, initialization, and password are located in this group.
◆ A1: Initialization
■ A1-00: Language Selection
Selects the display language for the digital operator.
Note: This parameter is not reset when the drive is initialized using parameter A1-03.
Setting 0: English
Setting 1: Japanese
Setting 2: German
Setting 3: French
Setting 4: Italian
Setting 5: Spanish
Setting 6: Portuguese
Setting 7: Chinese
■ A1-01: Access Level Selection
Allows or restricts access to drive parameters.
Note: This parameter is not reset when the drive is initialized using parameter A1-03.
142 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.1 A: Initialization
Setting 0: No initialization
Setting 1110: User Initialize
Drive parameters are reset to values selected by the user as User Settings. User Settings are stored when parameter o2-03
is set to “1: Set defaults”.
Note: User Initialization resets all parameters to a user-defined set of default values previously saved to the drive. Set parameter o2-03
to 2 to clear the user-defined default values.
Setting 2220: 2-Wire Initialization
Resets all parameters back to their original default settings with digital inputs S1 and S2 configured as Forward run and
Reverse run, respectively.
Parameter Details
Setting 5550: oPE04 Reset
An oPE04 error appears on the digital operator when a terminal block with settings saved to its built-in memory is
installed in a drive that has edited parameters. Set A1-02 to 5550 to use the parameter settings saved to the terminal block
memory.
Notes on Parameter Initialization
5
The parameters shown in Table 5.1 will not be reset when the drive is initialized by setting A1-03 = 2220 or 3330.
Although the control mode in A1-02 is not reset when A1-03 is set to 2220 or 3330, it may change when an application
preset is selected.
Table 5.1 Parameters not Changed by Drive Initialization
No. Parameter Name
A1-00 Language Selection
A1-02 Control Method Selection
E1-03 V/f Pattern Selection
E5-02 Motor Rated Capacity (for PM)
E5-03 Motor Rated Current (for PM)
E5-04 Motor Poles (for PM)
E5-05 Motor Stator Resistance (for PM)
E5-06 Motor d-Axis Inductance (for PM)
E5-07 Motor q-Axis Inductance (for PM)
E5-09 Motor Induction Voltage Constant 1 (for PM)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 143
5.1 A: Initialization
- MODE - PRG
Programming
2.
Press or until the Parameter Setting Mode screen appears.
HELP FWD DATA
-PRMSET- PRG
Initialization
3. A1-00=0
Press to enter the parameter menu tree. Select Language
FWD
-PRMSET- PRG
Select Language
4. Select the flashing digits by pressing F1 , F2 or . A1-00=0 ∗0∗
left right English
FWD
-PRMSET- PRG
Enter Password
5. A1- 04 = 0
Select A1-04 by pressing . (0~9999)
“0”
FWD
-PRMSET- PRG
Select Password
Press while holding down at the same time. A1-05 will appear. A1- 05 = 04
6. (0~9999)
Note: Because A1-05 is hidden, it will not be displayed by simply pressing . “0”
FWD
“05” flashes
144 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.1 A: Initialization
Step Display/Result
-PRMSET- PRG
Select Password
7. A1- 05 = 0000
Press . (0~9999)
“0”
FWD
-PRMSET- PRG
Select Password
8. Use F1 , F2 , , and to enter the password. A1-05= 1234
(0~9999)
left right “0”
FWD
9.
Press to save what was entered. Entry Accepted
-PRMSET- PRG
Select Password
10. The display automatically returns to the display shown in step 5. A1- 05 = 1234
(0~9999)
“0”
FWD
Table 5.3 Check to see if A1-02 is locked (continuing from step 10 above)
Step Display/Result
-PRMSET- PRG
Control Method
A1-02= 2 ∗2∗
1.
Press to display A1-02. Open Loop Vector
FWD
“02” flashes
2.
Press to make sure that the setting values cannot be selected.
- MODE - PRG
Programming
3.
Parameter Details
Press to return to the first display.
HELP FWD DATA
Table 5.4 Enter the Password to Unlock Parameters (continuing from step 3 above)
Step Display/Result
5
-PRMSET- PRG
Initialization
1. A1-00=0
Press to enter the parameter setup display. Select Language
FWD
-PRMSET- PRG
Select Language
-PRMSET- PRG
Enter Password
3. A1- 04 = 0
Press to scroll to A1-04 and . (0~9999)
“0”
FWD
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 145
5.1 A: Initialization
Step Display/Result
-PRMSET- PRG
Enter Password
4. Enter the password “1234”. A1- 04 = 1234
(0~9999)
“0”
FWD
5.
Press to save the new password. Entry Accepted
-PRMSET- PRG
Enter Password
6. Drive returns to the parameter display. A1- 04 = 0
(0~9999)
“0”
FWD
-PRMSET- PRG
Control Method
7. A1-02= 2 ∗2∗
Press and scroll to A1-02. Open Loop Vector
FWD
-PRMSET- PRG
Control Method
8. A1-02= 2 ∗2∗
Press to display the value set to A1-02. If the first “2” blinks, parameter settings are unlocked. Open Loop Vector
FWD
-PRMSET- PRG
Control Method
A1-02= 0 ∗2∗
9. V/F Control
Use or to change the value if desired (though changing the control mode at this point is not typically done).
“2”
FWD
V/f
10.
Press to save the setting, or press to return to the previous display without saving changes. Entry Accepted
-PRMSET- PRG
Control Method
11. The display automatically returns to the parameter display. A1-02= 0 ∗0∗
V/F Control
FWD
Note: Parameter settings can be edited after entering the correct password. Performing a 2-wire initialization resets the password to
“0000”. Reenter the password to parameter A1-05 after drive initialization.
146 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.1 A: Initialization
Parameter Details
5
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 147
5.2 b: Application
5.2 b: Application
◆ b1: Operation Mode Selection
■ b1-01: Speed Reference Selection
Selects the frequency reference source for the REMOTE mode.
Note: If an Up/Down command is input to the drive but the speed reference entered is 0 or below the minimum frequency, the RUN
indicator LED on the digital operator will light and the STOP indicator will flash.
148 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.2 b: Application
Setting 0: Operator
Allows the user to enter Up/Down commands from the digital operator. Use this setting when performing a test run only.
Setting 1: Control Circuit Terminal
Up/Down commands are issued from the control circuit terminals. This is the standard setting used in most elevator
applications.
Setting 2: MEMOBUS/Modbus Communications
This setting requires entering the Up/Down commands via serial communications by connecting the RS-485/422 serial
communication cable to control terminals R+, R-, S+, and S- on the removable terminal block. Refer to MEMOBUS/
Modbus Configuration on page 384 for instructions.
Setting 3: Option Card
This setting requires entering the Up/Down commands via the communication option card by plugging a communication
option card into the CN5-A port on the control board. Refer to the option card manual for instructions on integrating the
drive into the communication system.
Note: If b1-02 is set to 3, but an option card is not installed in CN5-A, an oPE05 operator programming error will be displayed on the
digital operator and the drive will not run.
Parameter Details
Ramps the motor to stop at the deceleration ramp set in C1-02. The actual time required for deceleration may vary by load
conditions (mechanical loss, inertia).
Setting 1: Coast to stop
The drive will shut off output to the motor and allow it to coast freely to stop when the Up/Down command is removed.
■ b1-06: Digital Input Reading
5
Defines how the digital inputs are read.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 149
5.2 b: Application
Setting 0: Disabled
An Up/Down command is not accepted while the digital operator is in the Programming Mode.
Setting 1: Enabled
An Up/Down command is accepted in any digital operator mode.
Setting 2: Prohibit programming during run
It is not possible to enter the Programming Mode as long as the drive output is active. The Programming Mode cannot be
displayed during Run.
■ b1-14: Phase Order Selection
Sets the phase order for drive output terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3. Switching motor phases will reverse the direction
of the motor. Use this parameter to switch the direction of the Up and Down commands.
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
b1-14 Phase Order Selection 0 or 1 0
When an Up/Down command is issued, the DC current level injected into the motor changes linearly from the level set to
b2-08 to the level set to E2-03 within the time set to b2-03.
Figure 5.1
Output Speed
b2-08 common_TMonly
E2-03
Magnetizing Current
Reference Time
S1-04
Figure 5.1 Magnetic Flux Compensation
150 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.2 b: Application
The level of the DC current injected to the motor is limited to 80% of the drive rated current or to the motor rated current,
whichever value is smaller.
Note: 1. If b2-08 is set below 100%, it can take a relatively long time for flux to develop.
2. If b2-08 is set to 0%, the DC current level will be the DC Injection current set to S1-02.
3. As DC Injection can generate a fair amount of noise, b2-08 may need to be adjusted to keep noise levels acceptable.
Parameter Details
◆ b6: Dwell Function
The Dwell function temporarily holds the frequency reference at a predefined value for a set time then continues
accelerating or decelerating.
Figure 5.3 shows how the Dwell function works.
Note: Set the stopping method to "Ramp to Stop" (b1-03 = 0) to use the Dwell function. 5
Figure 5.3
OFF ON OFF
Up/Down Command
common_TMonly
b6-01 b6-03
Output Speed
b6-02 b6-04
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 151
5.2 b: Application
Speed
Speed reference
Torque
0 100%
Figure 5.4 Droop Control Gain
152 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.2 b: Application
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
■ b8-16: Energy Saving Control Constant (Ki)
Enter the Energy Saving value (Ki) as specified on the motor nameplate (for IPM motors only).
Parameter Details
5
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 153
5.3 C: Tuning
5.3 C: Tuning
C parameters set the characteristics for acceleration, deceleration, and Jerk. Other parameters in the C group cover
settings for slip compensation, torque compensation, and carrier frequency.
Figure 5.5 shows an operation example for changing accel/decel ramps. The example below requires that the stopping
method be set for “Ramp to stop” (b1-03 = 0).
Figure 5.5
ON OFF ON ON OFF ON
Up/Down
command
ON OFF ON
Accel/Decel Ramp Selection 1
(Terminals S3 to S8, H1- = “7”)
ON
Accel/Decel Ramp Selection 2
(Terminals S3 to S8, H1- = “1A”)
154 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.3 C: Tuning
Output Speed
common_TMonly
C1-11
Accel/Decel
Switching Speed
Parameter Details
■ C1-11: Accel/Decel Switching Speed
Sets the speed at which the drive switches between accel/decel ramp settings. Refer to Switching Accel/Decel Ramps by
a Speed Level on page 155.
No.
C1-11
Parameter Name
Accel/Decel Switching Speed
Setting Range
0.0 to 100.0%
Default
0.0%
5
Note: Setting C1-11 to 0.0% disables this function.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 155
5.3 C: Tuning
A Fast Stop can be selected as the action the drive should take when certain faults occur, such as L8-03 (Overheat Pre-
Alarm Operation Selection).
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
C1-09 Fast Stop Ramp 0.0 to 600.0 s <1> 1.50 s <1>
<1> The setting range and default value depend on the display units set in parameter o1-03. If o1-03 is set between 0 and 4, the time required to go
from 0% speed to 100% maximum speed is expressed in seconds. If o1-03 is set to 5 or 6, then setting units will appear in m/s2 or ft/s2. If the
drive is in V/f control mode, the Fast stop ramp can be set in seconds only.
NOTICE: Rapid deceleration can trigger an overvoltage fault. The drive output shuts off when faulted and the motor coasts. Set an
appropriate Fast Stop time to C1-09 to avoid this uncontrolled motor state and to ensure that the motor stops quickly and safely.
<1> The setting range and default value depend on the display units set in parameter o1-03. If o1-03 is set between 0 and 4, the time required to go
from 0% speed to 100% maximum speed is expressed in seconds. If o1-03 is set to 5 or 6, then setting units will appear in m/s2 or ft/s2. If the
drive is in V/f control mode, the inspection deceleration ramp can be set in seconds only.
156 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.3 C: Tuning
Figure 5.7
C2-01
Time
Parameter Details
■ C3-02: Slip Compensation Primary Delay Time
Adjusts the filter on the output side of the slip compensation function. Although this parameter rarely needs to be
changed, adjustment may help in the following situations:
• Decrease the setting when the slip compensation response is too slow.
• Increase this setting when speed is unstable.
5
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
C3-02 Slip Compensation Primary Delay Time 0 to 10000 ms 2000 ms
The slip compensation limit is constant throughout the constant torque range (speed reference ≤ E1-06). In the constant
power range (speed reference ≥ E1-06), it is increased based on C3-03 and the output speed as shown in Figure 5.8.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 157
5.3 C: Tuning
Figure 5.8
E1-04
E1-06 × C3-03
C3-03
common_TMonly
Output speed
E1-06 E1-04
Base Maximum
Frequency Frequency
Figure 5.8 Slip Compensation Limit
Setting 0: Disabled
Slip compensation is not provided. The actual motor speed might be higher than the speed reference.
Setting 1: Enabled (6 Hz and above)
Slip compensation is enabled during regenerative operation. It will not be active at output frequencies below 6 Hz.
Setting 2: Enabled (compensation provided wherever possible)
Slip compensation is enabled during regenerative operation and at frequencies as low as 2 Hz. The drive uses the motor
rated slip set to E2-02 to automatically calculate the frequency range where compensation will be disabled.
■ C3-05: Output Voltage Limit Operation Selection
Determines if the motor flux reference is automatically reduced when output voltage reaches the saturation range.
If the input power supply voltage is low or the motor has a high voltage rating, this function improves the speed precision
when moving heavy loads at high speeds. When selecting the drive, remember that the reduction in flux causes a slightly
higher current at high speed when this function is enabled.
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
C3-05 Output Voltage Limit Operation Selection 0 or 1 Determined by A1-02
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
■ C3-21: Motor 2 Slip Compensation Gain
Used to improve speed accuracy for motor 2. Functions in the same way that C3-01 functions for motor 1.
Adjust this parameter only after the motor rated current (E4-01), motor rated slip (E4-02), and the motor no-load current
(E4-03) have all been set.
Refer to C3-01: Slip Compensation Gain on page 157 for details on adjusting this parameter.
Note: Default setting is 0.0 in V/f Control (A1-02 = 0). Default setting is 1.0 in Open Loop Vector Control (A1-02 = 2) and Closed Loop
Vector Control (A1-02 = 3). In Closed Loop Vector Control, slip compensation gain acts as an adaptable gain.
158 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.3 C: Tuning
Note: The default for V/f Control (A1-02 = 0) is 2000 ms. The default for Open Loop Vector Control (A1-02 = 2) is 200 ms.
The slip compensation limit is constant throughout the constant torque range (frequency reference ≤ E3-06). In the
constant power range (frequency reference ≥ E3-06), it is increased based on C3-23 and the output frequency as shown in
the following diagram.
Figure 5.9
E3-04
E3-06 × C3-23
common_TMonly
C3-23
Output Frequency
E3-06 E3-04
Base Maximum
Frequency Frequency
Parameter Details
■ C4-01: Torque Compensation Gain
Sets the gain for the torque compensation function.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 159
5.3 C: Tuning
Adjustment
Although this parameter rarely needs to be changed, it may be necessary to adjust the torque compensation gain in small
steps of 0.05 in the following situations:
• Increase this setting when using a long motor cable.
• Decrease this setting when motor oscillation occurs.
Adjust C4-01 so that the output current does not exceed the drive rated current.
Note: Refrain from adjusting torque compensation in Open Loop Vector Control, as it can have a negative effect on torque accuracy.
Adjustment
Although C4-02 rarely needs to be changed, adjustments may be necessary in the following situations:
• Increase this setting if the motor vibrates.
• Decrease this setting if the motor responds too slowly to changes in the load.
■ C4-03: Torque Compensation at Forward Start
Sets the amount of torque at start in the forward direction to improve motor performance during start with a heavy load.
Compensation is applied using the time constant set in parameter C4-05. Enable this function when the load pulls the
motor in reverse when starting with a Forward Up/Down command. Setting of 0.0% disables this feature.
160 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.3 C: Tuning
Torque limits
C5-01, C5-03, C5-13, C5-19
+ + Torque reference
Primary
Speed reference P filter
- I +
common_TMonly
I limit
C5-06
L7-01 to L7-04
Detected speed C5-02, C5-04, C5-08
C5-14, C5-20
Figure 5.10 Speed Control Block Diagram
Parameter Details
Perform the following steps for adjusting Speed Control Loop parameters:
1. Check parameter C5-07 and set a speed loop setting switching point. For CLV/PM the drive is preset to 2%. For
CLV set C5-07 between 8~10%.
2. Start a trip and check for any problems like rollback, vibration, overshoot, etc.
3. Adjust C5-19/20 in order to solve rollback problems During Position Lock right before the motor starts
accelerating. Increase C5-19, then shorten C5-20 if the motor rolls back right after the brake releases. Set them 5
in the opposite way if vibration occurs. If the rollback can not be eliminated by setting C5-19/10, refer to
parameters S3-01/02 (Position Lock Gains at Start).
4. Adjust C5-03/04 in order to improve the performance at start after Position Lock has been finished. Increase C5-
03, then shorten C5-04 if the speed response is slow. Set them in the opposite way if vibration occurs.
5. Adjust C5-01/02 in order to solve problems that occur at speeds higher than C5-07. Increase C5-01, then shorten
C5-02 if overshoot when reaching the top speed occurs. Set them in the opposite way if vibration occurs.
6. Adjust C5-13/14 in order to improve the stopping behavior. Increase C5-13, then shorten C5-14 if the landing
accuracy is poor. Adjust them in the opposite way if vibrations occur. If problems can not be resolved by setting
C5-13/14, refer to parameter S3-03 Position Lock Gain at Stop). Note that C5-13/14 settings will not be effective
if the speed reference is set from an analog input.
7. Repeat steps 2 to 6 until the desired riding comfort has been reached. Also refer to Riding Comfort Related
Problems on page 137.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 161
5.3 C: Tuning
■ C5-01, C5-03, C5-13 / C5-02, C5-04, C5-14: Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain 1, 2, 3 /
Speed Control Loop Integral Time 1, 2, 3
These parameters adjust the responsiveness of the Speed Control Loop.
P = C5-01
common_
P I
I = C5-02 TMonly
P = C5-03
I = C5-04
Speed
0 C5-07
162 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.3 C: Tuning
Figure 5.12
common_
P I
P = C5-01
TMonly
I = C5-02
P = C5-13
I = C5-14
Speed
0 C5-07
Figure 5.12 Settings at Low and High Speed during Deceleration (Leveling Speed is Selected)
Parameter Details
C5-18 Load Inertia Ratio 0.0 to 6000.0 1.0
■ C5-19, C5-20: Speed Control Loop P Gain Time, I Time during Position Lock
These parameters adjust the responsiveness of Speed Control Loop during Position Lock. Increase C5-19 and shorten C5-
20 if the motor rolls back immediately after the brake releases. Decrease C5-19 and lengthen C5-20 if vibrations occur.
5
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
C5-19 Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain Time during Position Lock 0.00 to 300.00 Determined by A1-02
C5-20 Speed Control Loop Integral Time during Position Lock 0.000 to 10.000 s 0.100 s
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 163
5.3 C: Tuning
0: 2-phase/3-phase conversion
1: 2-phase modulation
2: 3-phase modulation
Note: The drive rated output current is reduced with setting 2. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for details.
Setting 0: 5 kHz
Setting 1: Same value set to C6-03
■ C6-21: Inspection Operation Carrier Frequency
Sets the carrier frequency during Inspection Run.
Setting 0: 2 kHz
Setting 1: Use the value set to C6-03
164 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.4 d: Reference Settings
<1> Setting units and the default setting are determined by parameter o1-03. Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit Selection (o1-
03) on page 382 for details.
Parameter Details
Six different speeds (d1-19 to d1-23, d1-26) can be programmed to the drive and can be selected using dedicated digital
inputs. Each of the speed references set to d1-19 through d1-23 takes priority over the leveling speed set to d1-26. When
d1-18 is set to “1”, parameter d1-01 to d1-08 are not displayed. Refer to Separate Speed Inputs (d1-18 = 1 or 2) on
page 116 for details.
Setting 2: Leveling speed reference has priority
Six different speeds (d1-19 to d1-23, d1-26) can be programmed to the drive and can be selected using dedicated digital 5
inputs. The leveling speed reference in d1-26, however, takes priority over all other speed references when enabled via
one of the multi-function input terminals (H1-= 53). When d1-18 is set to “2”, parameters d1-01 to d1-08 are not
displayed. Refer to Separate Speed Inputs (d1-18 = 1 or 2) on page 116 for details.
Setting 3: Use multi-speed references d1-02 to d1-08, no speed selection stops the drive
Up to seven separate preset speed references can be programmed to the drive using parameters d1-02 through d1-08 can
be selected using binary coded digital inputs. When d1-18 is set to “3”, parameters d1-19 through d1-23 are not displayed.
Refer to Multi-Speed Inputs 1, 2 (d1-18 = 0 or 3) on page 115 for details.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 165
5.4 d: Reference Settings
<1> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03. Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit
Selection (o1-03) on page 382 for details.
<1> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03. Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit
Selection (o1-03) on page 382 for details.
<1> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03. Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit
Selection (o1-03) on page 382 for details.
<1> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03. Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit
Selection (o1-03) on page 382 for details.
<1> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03. Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit
Selection (o1-03) on page 382 for details.
166 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.4 d: Reference Settings
<1> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03. Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit
Selection (o1-03) on page 382 for details.
<1> Enter the same values to the E3 and E4 parameters that are set for the E1 and E2 parameters.
Note: 1. The drive will control motor 1 when this parameter is set to 0.00.
2. Set the accel/decel times in parameters C1-12 and C1-13 when using motor 2.
3. When motor 2 is selected, the following monitors will display values in Hz: U1-01, U1-02, U1-05, U4-19, U4-20.
Parameter Details
When the speed priority selection in d1-18 is set to “0” or “3” and the speed reference value falls below the level set in d1-
28, the drive interprets the selected speed as leveling speed. This parameter must be set to use the Speed Control Loop
setting 3 when d1-18 = 0/3. Refer to C5: Speed Control Loop on page 161 for details.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 167
5.4 d: Reference Settings
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
■ d6-06: Field Forcing Limit
Sets the maximum level at which the Field Forcing function can boost the excitation current reference. The value is set as
a percentage of the motor no load current. This parameter does not normally need to be changed.
168 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
Note: The braking transistor operation levels are valid for the internal braking transistor of the drive. When using an external CDBR
braking chopper, refer to the instruction manual of that unit.
Note: Parameter is not reset to the default value when the drive is initialized using A1-03.
Parameter Details
■ V/f Pattern Settings E1-04 to E1-13
Figure 5.13 illustrates the V/f pattern setting.
NOTICE: The motor may require more acceleration torque with drive operation than with a commercial power supply. Set a proper V/f
pattern by checking the load torque characteristics of the elevator to be used with the motor.
5
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
E1-04 Maximum Output Frequency 10.0 to 120.0 Hz <1> <2>
E1-05 Maximum Voltage 0.0 to 255.0 V <3> <3>
E1-06 Base Frequency 0.0 to 120.0 Hz <2>
E1-07 Middle Output Frequency 0.0 to 120.0 Hz <2>
E1-08 Middle Output Frequency Voltage 0.0 to 255.0 V <3> <2> <3> <4>
E1-09 Minimum Output Frequency 0.0 to 120.0 Hz <2>
E1-10 Minimum Output Frequency Voltage 0.0 to 255.0 V <3> <3> <4>
E1-11 <5> Middle Output Frequency 2 0.0 to 120.0 Hz 0.0 Hz
E1-12 <5> Middle Output Frequency Voltage 2 0.0 to 255.0 V <3> 0.0 V <3>
E1-13 Base Voltage 0.0 to 255.0 V <3> 0.0 V <3> <6>
<1> Setting range depends on the control mode being used. CLV allows a setting range of 10.0 to 120.0 Hz, while CLV/PM allows a setting range
of 4.0 to 120.0 Hz.
<2> Default setting is determined by the control mode (A1-02).
<3> Values shown here are for 200 V class drives. Double values when using a 400 V class unit.
<4> Default setting is determined by the drive model (o2-04).
<5> Parameter ignored when E1-11 and E1-12 are set to 0.0.
<6> Auto-Tuning will set E1-13 to the same value as E1-05.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 169
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
common_TMonly
Frequency (Hz)
Figure 5.13 V/f Pattern
Note: 1. The following condition must be true when setting up the V/f pattern: E1-09 ≤ E1-07 < E1-06 ≤ E1-11 ≤ E1-04
2. To make the V/f pattern a straight line below E1-06, set E1-09 = E1-07. In this case the E1-08 setting is disregarded.
3. E1-03 is unaffected when the parameters are initialized using parameter A1-03, but the settings for E1-04 through E1-13 are returned
to their default values.
4. Parameters E1-11, E1-12, and E1-13 should only be used to fine-tune the V/f pattern in the constant output range. These parameters
rarely need to be changed.
Note: 1. The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L2A0018 to 2A0033 and CIMR-L4A0009
to 4A0018 display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L2A0047 to 2A0415 and CIMR-L4A0024 to 4A0260 display
values in 0.1 A units.
2. Setting the motor rated current in E2-01 lower than the motor no-load current in E2-03 will trigger an oPE02 error. Set E2-03 correctly
to prevent this error.
170 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
Note: The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L2A0018 to 2A0033 and CIMR-
L4A0009 to 4A0018 display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L2A0047 to 2A0415 and CIMR-L4A0024 to
4A0260 display values in 0.1 A units.
Parameter Details
Sets the voltage drop due to motor leakage inductance as a percentage of motor rated voltage. This value is automatically
set during Auto-Tuning (Rotational Auto-Tuning, Stationary Auto-Tuning 1, 2).
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 171
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
172 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
■ E3-04 to E3-10
Parameters E3-04 through E3-10 set up the V/f pattern used for motor 2 as shown in Figure 5.14.
Note: Certain E3- parameters might not be visible depending on the control mode. Refer to Parameter Table on page 338 for
details.
Parameter Details
E3-07 Motor 2 Mid Output Frequency 0.0 to 120.0 Hz <1>
E3-08 Motor 2 Mid Output Frequency Voltage 0 to 255.0 V <2> <1>
E3-09 Motor 2 Minimum Output Frequency 0.0 to 120.0 Hz <1>
E3-10 Motor 2 Minimum Output Frequency Voltage 0.0 to 255.0 V <2> <1>
<1> Default setting is determined by the control mode selected for motor 2 (E3-01).
<2> Values shown here are specific to 200 V class drives; double the value for 400 V class drives.
Figure 5.14
5
Output (V)
E3-05
E3-08
E3-10 common_TMonly
E3-09 E3-07 E3-04
Frequency (Hz)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 173
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
Note: 1. The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L2A0018 to 0033 and CIMR-L4A0009 to
0018 display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L2A0047 to 2A0415 and CIMR-L4A0024 to 4A0260 display values in
0.1 A units.
2. An oPE02 error will occur if the motor rated current in E4-01 is set lower than the motor no-load current in E4-03. Set E4-03 correctly
to prevent this error.
Note: The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L2A0018 to 0033 and CIMR-L4A0009
to 0018 display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L2A0047 to 2A0415 and CIMR-L4A0024 to 4A0260 display
values in 0.1 A units.
174 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
Parameter Details
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
E5-03 Motor Rated Current 10 to 200% of drive rated current Determined by o2-04
Note: The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L2A0018 to 2A0033 and CIMR-
L4A0009 to 4A0018 display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L2A0047 to 2A0415 and CIMR-L4A0024 to
4A0260 display values in 0.1 A units.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 175
5.5 E: Motor Parameters
Note: 1. Set E5-24 to 0 when setting E5-09. However, setting both E5-09 and E5-24 to 0 will trigger an alarm. An alarm will also be triggered
if neither E5-09 nor E5-24 are set to 0.
2. This parameter is not reset when the drive is initialized using parameter A1-03.
Note: 1. Set E5-24 to 0.0 when setting E5-09. However, setting both E5-09 and E5-24 to 0.0 will trigger an alarm. An alarm will also be
triggered if neither E5-09 nor E5-24 are set to 0.0. When E5-01 is set to FFFF, then E5-09 should be set to 0.0.
2. This parameter is not reset when the drive is initialized using parameter A1-03.
176 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.6 F: Option Settings
■ F1-03, F1-08, F1-09: Overspeed (oS) Operation Selection, Detection Level, Delay Time
An oS fault is triggered when the speed feedback exceeds the value set in F1-08 for longer than the time set in F1-09. Set
the stopping method for an oS fault in parameter F1-03.
Parameter Details
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
F1-03 Operation Selection at Overspeed (oS) 0 to 3 1
F1-08 Overspeed Detection Level 0 to 120% 115%
F1-09 Overspeed Detection Delay Time 0.0 to 2.0 s 0.0 s
■ F1-04, F1-10, F1-11: Operation at Speed Deviation (dEv), Detection Level, Delay Time
A speed deviation error (dEv) is triggered when the difference between the speed reference and the speed feedback
exceeds the value set in F1-10 for longer than the time set in F1-11. The stopping method when a speed deviation fault
occurs can be selected in parameter F1-04.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 177
5.6 F: Option Settings
Example: To have a ratio of 1/32 between the speed feedback option card pulse input and output, set F1-06 = 032.
Note: A common cause for a dv3 fault is the incorrect setting of E5-11. Make sure the correct encoder offset has been entered to E5-11.
Note: A common cause for a dv4 fault is the incorrect setting of E5-11. Make sure the correct encoder offset is set to E5-11.
178 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.6 F: Option Settings
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
■ F1-29: dEv Detection Condition Selection
Selects when dEv error detection is active.
Setting 0: After speed reference, SFS output and motor speed have matched once.
Setting 1: After speed reference, SFS output have matched once.
Setting 2: Always during Run.
Figure 5.15
Speed
Motor speed
A Setting 2
B Setting 1
C Setting 0
Time
A
Parameter Details
level set in F1-51, a speed feedback hardware fault is detected. Available when F1-20 = 1.
0: Disabled
The R track is not used. The rotor magnet position is calculated from the C and D track signal only.
1: Enabled
The R track signals are used to determine the rotor magnet position.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 179
5.6 F: Option Settings
Setting 0: 8 bit
Setting 1: 12 bit
Setting 2: 16 bit
180 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.6 F: Option Settings
Setting 0: 0 to 10 V
Setting 1: -10 to 10 V
Parameter Details
When F5-09 = 2, the parameters listed in the table below are used to assign functions to the output terminals on the option
card.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 181
5.6 F: Option Settings
182 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.6 F: Option Settings
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
■ F6-08: Reset Communication Parameters
Determines whether F6- communication-related parameters are reset after initialization.
Setting 0: Do not reset parameters F6- when the drive is initialized with A1-03
Setting 1: Reset F6- when the drive is initialized with A1-03
Note: F6-08 is not reset when the drive is initialized, but does determine whether initializing the drive resets the other F6-
communication parameters.
◆ CANopen Parameters
Parameters F6-35 and F6-36 set up the drive to operate on a CANopen network.
Refer to the Yaskawa AC Drive Option CANopen Installation Manual and Technical Manual for details on parameter
settings.
Parameter Details
5
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 183
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Setting
No. Parameter Name Default
Range
H1-03 Terminal S3 Function Selection 3 to 79
H1-04 Terminal S4 Function Selection 3 to 79
H1-05 Terminal S5 Function Selection 3 to 79 Determined by d1-18 <1>
H1-06 Terminal S6 Function Selection 3 to 79
H1-07 Terminal S7 Function Selection 3 to 79
H1-08 Terminal S8 Function Selection 3 to 79 F: Through Mode
<1> With the speed reference priority d1-18 is set to 0 or 3, the default settings for parameters H1-03 to H1-07 governing input terminals S3 to S7
are: 24, 13, 3, 4, and 5 respectively. When d1-18 is set to 1 or 2, the default settings for H1-03 to H1-7 become 50, 54, 51, 53, and F
respectively.
184 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Drive Operation
DIgital Input Function
Input Open Input Closed
Setting 8 (N.C.) Baseblock (Interrupt output) Normal operation
Setting 9 (N.O.) Normal operation Baseblock (Interrupt output)
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. When using a mechanical holding brake with the drive in a lifting application, close the brake
when the drive output is cut off by a baseblock command triggered by one of the input terminals. Failure to comply will result in a
slipping load from the motor suddenly coasting when the baseblock command is entered and may cause serious injury or death.
Parameter Details
• To trigger the Fast Stop function with a N.O. switch, set H1- = 15.
• To trigger the Fast Stop function with a N.C. switch, set H1- = 17.
Figure 5.16 shows an operation example of Emergency Stop.
Figure 5.16
Up/Down/Stop 5
ON ON
Fast Stop
H1- = 17
ON ON
Decelerates at C1-09
common_
Output Speed TIME TMonly
Figure 5.16 Fast Stop Sequence
NOTICE: Rapid deceleration can trigger an overvoltage fault. When faulted, the drive output shuts off, and the motor coasts. To avoid
this uncontrolled motor state and to ensure that the motor stops quickly and safely, set an appropriate Fast Stop time to C1-09.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 185
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Drive M Motor 1
common_
M Motor 2
TMonly
Figure 5.17 Motor Selection
When switching between motor 1 and motor 2, the parameters used to control those motors also change. Below,
Table 5.11 lists the parameters that correspond to each motor.
Table 5.11 Parameters for Switching Between Two Motors
No. Setting 16 Open (Motor 1) ⇒ Setting 16 Closed (Motor 2)
C1-: Acceleration/Deceleration Time C1-01 to C1-04 ⇒ C1-12 to C1-13
E1-, E3-: V/f Pattern
E1-, E3- ⇒ E3-, E4-
E2-, E4-: Motor Parameters
Note: 1. The drive can switch from motor 2 to operate motor 1 in V/f Control based on the speed reference set for motor 2. Refer to Motor
Switch Selection on page 167 for details.
2. It is not possible to switch between motor 1 and motor 2 during run. Doing so will trigger the “rUn” alarm.
3. It is not possible to switch between motors when CLV/PM control mode is selected.
4. The motor 2 selection function is available only with OLV control mode (A1-02 = 0).
5. When switching from motor 1 to motor 2, check to make sure that motor 2 is operating.
If a digital output is programmed for “Motor 2 selection” (H1-01, H1-02, or H1-03 = 1C), motor will be selected when the
output is closed.
Setting 18: Timer function input
This setting configures a digital input terminal as the input for the timer function. Use this setting combination with the
timer function output (H2- = 12). Refer to b4: Delay Timers on page 151 for details.
Setting 1A: Accel/decel ramp selection 2
Used to select accel/decel ramps 1 to 4 in combination with the Accel/decel ramp selection 1 command. Refer to C1-01 to
C1-08: Accel, Decel Ramps 1 to 4 on page 154 for details.
Setting 20 to 2F: External fault
The External fault command stops the drive when problems occur with external devices.
To use the External fault command, set one of the multi-function digital inputs to any value between 20 to 2F. The digital
operator will display EF where is the number of the terminal to which the external fault signal is assigned.
For example, if an external fault signal is input to terminal “EF3” will be displayed.,
Select the value to be set in H1- from a combination of any of the following three conditions:
• Signal input level from peripheral devices (N.O., N.C.)
• External fault detection method
• Operation after external fault detection
The following table shows the relationship between the conditions and the value set to H1-:
Terminal statuses, detection conditions, and stopping methods marked with an ” O ” are applicable to the corresponding
settings.
186 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Parameter Details
page 115 for details.
Setting 53: Leveling speed
Closing a terminal set for “Leveling speed” makes the drive run at the speed reference set to d1-26. Conditions change,
however, according to the speed selection mode set in d1-18. Refer to Multi-Speed Inputs 1, 2 (d1-18 = 0 or 3) on
page 115 for details.
5
Setting 54: Inspection operation
Causes the drive to operate at the speed reference set in d1-24. To use Inspection Run, this terminal must be close before
the Up or Down command is entered. Refer to Inspection Operation on page 118 for details.
Setting 55: Rescue operation
Initiates Rescue Operation when the terminal closes. Refer to Rescue Operation on page 123 for details.
Setting 56: Motor contactor feedback
Can be used as monitoring input for the motor contactor and allows the drive to detect contactor malfunction.
Setting 57: High speed limit up
When this input is closed the speed in up direction will be limited to the leveling speed. No speed limit is applied when
the car is going down.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 187
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
188 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Status Description
Open Drive is stopped.
Closed An Up/Down command is input or the drive is during deceleration or during DC injection.
Status Description
Open The operating speed is faster than the minimum output frequency (E1-09) and the zero speed level at stop (S1-01).
Closed The operating speed is below the minimum output frequency (E1-09) and the zero speed level at stop (S1-01).
Note: When using CLV or CLV/PM control modes, the zero speed level is defined by S1-01. In all other control modes, the zero speed
level is the minimum output speed set to E1-09.
Figure 5.18
Output speed
or
motor speed E1-09 (Max. Output Frequency) or
S1-01 (Zero Speed Level)
common_
OFF
Zero Speed
ON
TMonly
Figure 5.18 Zero-Speed Time Chart
Setting 2: Speed agree 1 (fref/fout Agree 1)
Closes whenever the actual output speed (CLV, CLV/PM) is within the Speed Agree Width (L4-02) of the current speed
reference regardless of the direction.
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed does not match the speed reference while the drive is running.
Closed Output speed or motor speed is within the range of speed reference ±L4-02.
Parameter Details
Note: Detection works in both directions, forward and reverse.
Figure 5.19
Speed
reference
L4-02
Output speed
or motor speed
5
L4-02
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 189
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed and the speed reference are not both within the range of L4-01 ±L4-02.
Closed Output speed or motor speed and the speed reference are both within the range of L4-01 ±L4-02.
Note: Detection works in both forward and reverse. The value of L4-01 is used as the detection level for both directions.
Figure 5.20
L4-01
Speed
reference +/- L4-02
User Set
OFF ON OFF ON
Speed Agree 1
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed exceeded L4-01 + L4-02.
Closed Output speed or motor speed is below L4-01 or has not exceeded L4-01 + L4-02.
Note: Detection works in both forward and reverse. The value of L4-01 is used as the detection level for both directions.
Figure 5.21
Output speed
or motor speed L4-02
L4-01
L4-01
L4-02
common_
Speed
detection 1 ON OFF TMonly
Figure 5.21 Speed Detection 1 Time Chart
Refer to L4-01, L4-02: Speed Agreement Detection Level and Detection Width on page 206 for more details.
Setting 5: Speed Detection 2
Output closes whenever the output speed or motor speed (CLV, CLV/PM) is above the detection level set in L4-01. The
terminal remains closed until the output speed or motor speed falls below L4-01 minus the setting of L4-02.
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed is below L4-01 minus L4-02 or has not exceeded L4-01.
Closed Output speed or motor speed exceeded L4-01.
Note: Detection works in both forward and reverse. The value of L4-01 is used as the detection level for both directions.
190 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Figure 5.22
L4-01
L4-02
common_
Speed
Detection 2
OFF ON TMonly
Figure 5.22 Speed Detection 2 Time Chart
Refer to L4-01, L4-02: Speed Agreement Detection Level and Detection Width on page 206 for more details.
Setting 6: Drive ready
Output closes whenever the drive is ready to operate the motor. The terminal will not close under the conditions listed
below, and any Up/Down commands will be disregarded.
• When the power is shut off
• During a fault
• When the internal power supply of the drive has malfunctioned
• When a parameter setting error makes it impossible to run
• Although stopped, an overvoltage or undervoltage situation occurs
• While editing a parameter in the Programming Mode (when b1-08 = 0)
• When parameter L8-88 = 0 and at least one Safe Disable input is open
Setting 7: DC bus undervoltage
Output closes whenever the DC bus voltage or control circuit power supply drops below the trip level set in L2-05. A
fault in the DC bus circuit will also cause the terminal to set for “DC bus undervoltage” to close.
Status Description
Open DC bus voltage is above the level set to L2-05
Closed DC bus voltage has fallen below the trip level set to L2-05.
Parameter Details
Setting 8: During baseblock (N.O.)
Output closes to indicate that the drive is in a baseblock state. While in baseblock, output transistors do not switch and no
main circuit voltage is output.
Status Description
Open Drive is not in a baseblock state. 5
Closed Baseblock is being executed.
Status Description
Open Speed reference is provided from External reference 1 (b1-01).
Closed Speed reference is being sourced from the digital operator.
Status Description
Open Up/Down command is provided from External reference 1 (b1-02).
Closed Up/Down command is being sourced from the digital operator.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 191
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Setting E: Fault
The output closes when the drive faults (excluding CPF00 and CPF01 faults).
Setting F: Not used (Through mode)
Select this setting when using the terminal in a pass-through mode. When set to F, an output does not trigger any function
in the drive. Setting F, however, still allows the output status to be read by a PLC via a communication option or
MEMOBUS/Modbus communications.
Setting 10: Minor fault
Output closes when a minor fault condition is present.
Setting 11: Fault reset command active
Output closes whenever there is an attempt to reset a fault situation from the control circuit terminals, via serial
communications, or using a communications option card.
Setting 12: Timer output
This setting configures a digital output terminal as output for the timer function. Refer to b4: Delay Timers on page 151
for details.
Setting 13: Speed agree 2 (fref /fout agree 2)
Closes whenever the actual output speed or motor speed (CLV, CLV/PM) is within the speed agree width (L4-04) of the
current speed reference, regardless of the direction.
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed does not match the speed reference while the drive is running.
Closed Output speed or motor speed is within the range of speed reference ±L4-04.
Speed
reference common_
L4-04
Output speed
TMonly
or motor speed
L4-04
OFF ON
Speed Agree 2
Figure 5.23 Speed Agree 2 Time Chart
Refer to L4-03, L4-04: Speed Agreement Detection Level and Detection Width (+/-) on page 206 for more details.
192 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed and speed reference are both outside the range of L4-03 ±L4-04
Closed Output speed or motor speed and the speed reference are both with in the range of L4-03 ±L4-04
Figure 5.24
Output speed
or motor speed
Speed L4-03
reference Output speed
+/- L4-04
Speed
reference
common_
User Set OFF ON TMonly
Speed Agree 2
Figure 5.24 User Set Speed Agree 2 Example with a Positive L3-04 Value
Refer to L4-03, L4-04: Speed Agreement Detection Level and Detection Width (+/-) on page 206 for more details.
Setting 15: Speed detection 3
Output opens when the output speed or motor speed (CLV, CLV/PM) rises above the detection level set in L4-03 plus the
detection with set in L4-04. The terminal remains open until the output speed or motor speed falls below the level set in
L4-03. As the detection level L4-03 is a signed value, the detection works in the specified direction only.
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed exceeded L4-03 plus L4-04.
Closed Output speed or motor speed is below L4-03 or has not exceeded L4-03 plus L4-04 yet.
Figure 5.25
Parameter Details
or motor speed L4-04
L4-03 TMonly
5
Speed
ON OFF
detection 3
Figure 5.25 Speed Detection 3 Example with a Positive L3-04 Value
Refer to L4-03, L4-04: Speed Agreement Detection Level and Detection Width (+/-) on page 206 for more details.
Setting 16: Speed detection 4
Output closes whenever the output speed or motor speed (CLV, CLV/PM) is above the detection level set in L4-03. The
terminal remains closed until the output speed or motor speed falls below L4-03 minus the setting of L4-04. As the
detection level L4-03 is a signed value, speed detection works in the specified direction only.
Status Description
Open Output speed or motor speed is below L4-03 minus L4-04 or has not exceeded L4-03 yet.
Closed Output speed or motor speed exceeded L4-03.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 193
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Figure 5.26
Speed
OFF ON
detection 4
Status Description
Open Elevator is being driven in up direction or stopped.
Closed Elevator is being driven in down direction.
Figure 5.27
Output Speed
Up command
Down command
Status Description
Open Baseblock is being executed.
Closed Drive is not in a baseblock state.
Status Description
Open Motor 1 is selected.
Closed Motor 2 is selected.
194 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
The fault reset function allows the drive to automatically clear a fault. The terminal set to 1E will close after the fault is
cleared and the drive has attempted to reset. If the drive cannot successfully reset within the number of attempts permitted
by L5-01, a fault will be triggered and the terminal set to 1E will open. Refer to L5: Automatic Fault Reset on page 207
for details on automatic reset.
Setting 1F: Motor overload alarm (oL1)
The output closes when the motor overload level estimated by the oL1 fault detection exceeds 90% of the oL1 detection
level.
Setting 20: Drive overheat pre-alarm (oH)
Output closes whenever the drive heatsink temperature reaches the level specified by parameter L8-02. Refer to L8-02:
Overheat Alarm Level on page 211 for details on drive overheat detection.
Setting 2F: Maintenance period
Output closes when the cooling fan, DC bus capacitors, or DC bus pre-charge relay may require maintenance as
determined by the estimated performance life span of those components. Component performance life is displayed as a
percentage on the digital operator screen. Refer to Periodic Maintenance on page 291 for details.
Setting 30: During torque limit
Output closes when the motor is operating at the torque limit specified by the L7- parameters or an analog input. This
setting can only be used in OLV, CLV and CLV/PM control modes. Refer to L7-01 to L7-04: Torque Limits on page 211
for details.
Setting 33: Within position lock bandwidth
Output closes when the motor rotor position is within the position lock bandwidth (S3-04) during Position Lock at start or
stop.
Setting 37: During frequency output
Output closes when the drive is outputting a frequency.
Status Description
Open Drive is stopped or one of the following functions is being performed: baseblock, DC Injection Braking, Short Circuit Braking.
Closed Drive is outputting frequency.
Figure 5.28
Parameter Details
OFF ON
Up/Down command
Baseblock OFF ON
command
Output
frequency 5
OFF ON
During run
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 195
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Up/Down command
common_TMonly
Motor pole search status
196 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Setting 0: 0 to 10 Vdc
The input level is 0 to 10 Vdc. The minimum input level is limited to 0%, so that a negative input signal due to gain and
bias settings will be read as 0%.
Setting 1: –10 to 10 Vdc
The input level is –10 to 10 Vdc. If the resulting voltage is negative after being adjusted by gain and bias settings, then the
motor will rotate in reverse.
■ H3-02: Terminal A1 Function Selection
Selects the input signal level for analog input A1. Refer to Multi-Function Analog Input Terminal Settings on page 199
for instructions on how to adjust the signal level.
Parameter Details
No. Name Setting Range Default
H3-03 Terminal A1 Gain Setting -999.9 to 999.9% 100.0%
H3-04 Terminal A1 Bias Setting -999.9 to 999.9% 0.0%
Setting Examples
• Gain H3-03 = 200%, bias H3-04 = 0, terminal A1 as speed reference input (H3-02 = 0):
A 10 Vdc input is equivalent to a 200% frequency reference and 5 Vdc is equivalent to a 100% frequency reference. 5
Since the drive output is limited by the maximum frequency parameter (E1-04), the speed reference will be equal to E1-
04 above 5 Vdc.
Figure 5.29
H3-01 = 0 H3-01 = 1
common_TMonly
Gain = 200 % Gain = 200 %
Speed 100%
reference E1-04
-10 V -5 V
100 % 0V 5V 10 V
E1-04
-100%
E1-04
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 197
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
• Gain H3-03 = 100%, bias H3-04 = -25%, terminal A1 as speed reference input:
An input of 0 Vdc will be equivalent to a -25% speed reference.
When parameter H3-01 = 0, the speed reference is 0% between 0 and 2 Vdc input.
When parameter H3-01 = 1, the motor will rotate in reverse between -10 and 2 Vdc input.
Figure 5.30
H3-01 = 0 H3-01 = 1
common_TMonly
100 %
100%
Speed H3-01 = 0
reference -10 V -6.0 V
2.0 V 10 V
-25% Analog Input
Voltage
0
2.0 V 10 V
Analog Input -100%
-25% Voltage E1-04
H3-01 = 1 -150%
Figure 5.30 Speed Reference Setting by Analog Input with Negative Bias
Setting 0: 0 to 10 Vdc
The input level is 0 to 10 Vdc. Refer to Setting 0: 0 to 10 Vdc on page 197 for details.
Setting 1: –10 to 10 Vdc
The input level is –10 to 10 Vdc. Refer to Setting 1: –10 to 10 Vdc on page 197 for details.
■ H3-10: Terminal A2 Function Selection
Determines the function assigned to analog input terminal A2. Refer to Multi-Function Analog Input Terminal Settings
on page 199 for a list of functions and descriptions.
198 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Parameter Details
reference is supplied by a different source other than the analog inputs, this function will have no effect. Use this setting
also when only one of the analog inputs is used to supply the speed reference.
By default, analog inputs A1 and A2 are set for this function. Using A1 and A2 at the same time increases the speed
reference by the total of all inputs.
Example: If the analog speed reference from analog input terminal A1 is 50% and a bias of 20% is applied by analog 5
input terminal A2, the resulting speed reference will be 70% of the maximum output speed.
Setting 2: Auxiliary speed reference 1 (used as a second speed reference)
Sets the auxiliary speed reference 1 when multi-step speed operation is selected. Refer to Speed Selection Using Digital
Inputs (b1-01 = 0) on page 115 for details.
Setting 3: Auxiliary speed reference 2 (used as a third speed reference)
Sets the auxiliary speed reference 2 when multi-step speed operation is selected. Refer to Speed Selection Using Digital
Inputs (b1-01 = 0) on page 115 for details.
Setting 14: Torque compensation (load cell input)
This selection allows an analog signal to the input terminal adjust the amount of torque compensation to handle and
unbalance at start when elevators sensors indicate that a large load has been added to the car. This helps to minimize
shock and jerking at start. Setting 14 requires an analog signal from a load sensor. For more information on torque
compensation, refer to Adjusting the Torque Compensation at Start on page 121.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 199
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
A setting of 031 or 000 applies no drive monitor to the analog output. With this setting, terminal functions as well as FM
and AM output levels can be set by a PLC via a communication option or MEMOBUS/Modbus (through mode).
■ H4-02, H4-03: Multi-Function Analog Output Terminal FM Gain and Bias
H4-05, H4-06: Terminal AM Gain and Bias
Parameters H4-02 and H4-05 set the terminal FM and AM output signal level equal to 100% of the monitor (gain).
Parameters H4-03 and H4-06 set the bias added to the monitor output for terminals FM and AM. Both are set as a
percentage, where 100% equals 10 Vdc analog output. The output voltage of both terminals is limited to 10 Vdc.
Select an output signal range between 0 to +10 Vdc or -10 to +10 Vdc using parameters H4-07 and H4-08. Figure 5.31
illustrates how gain and bias settings work.
200 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.7 H: Terminal Functions
Figure 5.31
H4-07, 08 = 0 H4-07, 08 = 1
common_TMonly
15V
Gain = 150%
Output Voltage
Bias = 0%
10V
Gain = 100%
10 V Bias = 0%
Gain 150% 5V
Bias 0% Gain = 50%
Output Voltage Bias = 0%
-100%
Gain 100%
5V Bias 0% 100%
Monitor Value
-5 V
Gain 50%
Bias 0%
0V -10 V
0% Monitor Value 100%
-15 V
Figure 5.31 Analog Output Gain and Bias Setting Example 1 and 2
Example 3: Set H4-03 to 30% for an output signal of 3 V at terminal FM when the monitored value is at 0%.
Figure 5.32
Setting 0: 0 to 10 V
Setting 1: -10 V to 10 V
Parameter Details
The H5- parameters are used to set up the drive for MEMOBUS/Modbus Communications. Refer to MEMOBUS/
Modbus Communications on page 383 for detailed descriptions of the H5- parameters.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 201
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Note: 1. When the motor protection function is enabled (L1-01≠ 0), an oL1 alarm can be output through one of the multi-function outputs by
setting H2-01 to 1F. The output will close when the motor overload level reaches 90% of the oL1 detection level.
2. Set L1-01 to a value between 1 and 5 when running a single motor from the drive to select a method to protect the motor from
overheat. An external thermal relay is not necessary.
Setting 0: Disabled (motor overload protection is not provided)
Use this setting if no motor overheat protection is desired.
Setting 1: General-purpose motor (standard self-cooled)
Because the motor is self-cooled, the overload tolerance drops when the motor speed is lowered. The drive appropriately
adjusts the electrothermal trigger point according to the motor overload characteristics, protecting the motor from
overheat throughout the entire speed range.
Overload Tolerance Cooling Ability Overload Characteristics
100
90 Motor designed to operate from line power. Continuous operation at less than line power
Motor cooling is most effective when running at frequency with 100% load can trigger motor
rated base frequency (check the motor nameplate or overload protection (oL1). A fault is output and the
60
50 Continuous specifications). motor will coast to stop.
A
B
C
05 33 100 120 167 200
Speed (%)
Setting 2: Drive dedicated motor (speed range for constant torque: 1:10)
Use this setting when operating a drive duty motor that allows constant torque in a speed range of 1:10. The drive will
allow the motor to run with 100% load from 10% up to 100% speed. Running at slower speeds with full load can trigger
an overload fault.
Overload Tolerance Cooling Ability Overload Characteristics
150
Rated Speed=100% Speed
60 s
A: Max. speed for 200LJ and above
B: Max. speed for 160MJ to 180 LJ
Torque (%)
Motor is designed to effectively cool itself even at Continuous operation with 100% load from 5 Hz to
low speeds. 50 Hz.
55
50
Continuous A
B
C
202 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
150
Rated Speed=100% Speed
60 s A: Max. speed for 200LJ and above
B: Max. speed for 160MJ to 180 LJ
100 C: Max. speed for 132MJ and below
Torque (%)
90
Motor is designed to effectively cool itself at ultra- Continuous operation with 100% load from 0.5 Hz to
low speeds. 50 Hz.
50 Continuous
A
B
C
0 1 100120 167 200
Speed (%)
125
Torque (%)
115
Continuous
100
83
77 Motor is designed to effectively cool itself at ultra- Continuous operation with 100% load from 0.2% to
67
low speeds (about 0.2% of base speed). 100% of base speed.
Parameter Details
Percent of base speed (%)
Defaulted to operate with an allowance of 150% overload operation for one minute in a hot start.
Figure 5.33 illustrates an example of the electrothermal protection operation time using a general-purpose motor
operating at the value of E1-06, Motor Base Speed, with L1-02 set to one minute.
During normal operation, motor overload protection operates in the area between a cold start and a hot start.
• Cold start: Motor protection operation time in response to an overload situation that was suddenly reached when
starting a stationary motor.
• Hot start: Motor protection operation time in response to an overload situation that occurred during sustained
operation at rated current.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 203
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Figure 5.33
3
Cold start
0.4
Hot start
0.1
Motor current (%)
0 100 150 200 E2-01 = 100% motor current
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
204 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Setting 0: Disabled
No Stall Prevention is provided. If the acceleration time is too short, the drive may not be able to get the motor up to speed
fast enough, causing an overload fault.
Setting 1: Enabled
Enables Stall Prevention during acceleration.
If the output current rises above the Stall Prevention level set in L3-02, then the drive stops accelerating. Acceleration will
not resume until the output current falls 15% below the setting in L3-02.
The Stall Prevention level is automatically reduced in the constant power range.
Figure 5.34
Output current
L3-02
-15%
Time
Output speed
Parameter Details
■ L3-02: Stall Prevention Level during Acceleration
Sets the output current level at which the Stall Prevention during acceleration is activated.
• Lower L3-02 if stalling occurs when using a motor that is relatively small compared to the drive.
• Also set parameter L3-03 when operating the motor in the constant power range.
■ L3-05: Stall Prevention Selection during Run
Determines how Stall Prevention works during Run. Stall Prevention during run prevents the motor from stalling by
automatically reducing the speed when a transient overload occurs while the motor is running at constant speed.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 205
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Setting 0: Disabled
Drive runs at the set speed reference. A heavy load may cause the motor to stall and trip the drive with an oC or oL fault.
Setting 1: Decelerate using C1-02
If the current exceeds the Stall Prevention level set in parameter L3-06, then the drive will decelerate at decel ramp 1 (C1-
02). Once the current level drops below the value of L3-06 minus 2% for 100 ms, the drive accelerates back to the speed
reference at the active acceleration ramp.
Setting 2: Decelerate using C1-04
Same as setting 1 except the drive decelerates at decel ramp 2 (C1-04).
■ L3-06: Stall Prevention Level during Run
Sets the Stall Prevention level during run as a percentage of the drive rate output current.
<1> The upper limit and default for this setting is determined by L8-38.
For details on setting 2, 3, 4, and 5, refer to H2-01 to H2-05: Terminals M1-M2, M3-M4, M5-M6, P1-PC, and P1-P2
Function Selection on page 188.
■ L4-03, L4-04: Speed Agreement Detection Level and Detection Width (+/-)
Parameter L4-03 sets the detection level for the digital output functions “Speed agree 2,” “User-set speed agree 2,”
“Speed detection 3,” and “Speed detection 4.”
Parameter L4-04 sets the hysteresis level for these functions.
For details on setting 13, 14, 15, and 16, refer to H2-01 to H2-05: Terminals M1-M2, M3-M4, M5-M6, P1-PC, and P1-
P2 Function Selection on page 188.
206 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Analog 100%
speed
reference 10%
400 ms common_TMonly
Figure 5.35 Loss of Reference Function
Parameter L4-05 selects the operation when a speed reference loss is detected.
Setting 0: Stop
Drive follows the speed reference (which is no longer present) and simply stops the motor.
Setting 1: Continue operation with reduced speed reference
The drive will continue operation at the speed reference value set in parameter L4-06. When the external speed reference
value is restored, the operation is continued with the speed reference.
■ L4-06: Speed Reference at Reference Loss
Sets the speed reference level the drive runs with when L4-05 = 1 and a reference loss was detected. The value is set as a
percentage of the speed reference before the loss was detected.
Parameter Details
No. Name Setting Range Default
L4-13 Door Zone Level 0.0 to 100.0% 0.0%
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 207
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Fault
common_
TMonly DC Injection/
Position Lock
DC Injection/
Position Lock
Output Speed
Up or Down command
Fault (H2- = E)
208 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Note: When overtorque occurs in the application, the drive may stop due to overcurrent (oC) or overload (oL1). To prevent this, an
overload situation should be indicated to the controller before oC or oL1 occur in the drive. Use the torque detection for this
purpose.
H2-01 through H2-05 Setting Description
B Torque detection 1, N.O. (output closes when overload or underload is detected)
18 Torque detection 2, N.O. (output close when overload or underload is detected)
Figure 5.37 and Figure 5.38 show the function of overtorque and undertorque detection.
Figure 5.37
Parameter Details
10 % hysteresis 10 % hysteresis
L6-02/05
L6-03/06 L6-03/06
Torque detection 1 (NO)
or
Torque detection 2 (NO) ON ON 5
Figure 5.37 Overtorque Detection Operation
Figure 5.38
L6-03/06 L6-03/06
Torque detection 1 (NO)
or
Torque detection 2 (NO) ON ON
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 209
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: oL3, oL4 at speed agree (Alarm)
Overtorque detection is active only when the output speed is equal to the speed reference, i.e., no detection during
acceleration and deceleration. The operation continues after detection and an oL3/oL4 alarm is triggered.
Setting 2: oL3, oL4 at run (Alarm)
Overtorque detection works as long as the Up/Down command is active. The operation continues after detection and an
oL3 or oL4 alarm is triggered.
Setting 3: oL3, oL4 at speed agree (Fault)
Overtorque detection is active only when the output speed is equal to the speed reference, i.e., no detection during
acceleration and deceleration. The operation is stopped and an oL3 or oL4 fault is triggered.
Setting 4: oL3, oL4 at run (Fault)
Overtorque detection works as long as a Up/Down command is active. Operation stops and an oL3 or oL4 fault is
triggered.
Setting 5: UL3, UL4 at speed agree (Alarm)
Undertorque detection is active only when the output speed is equal to the speed reference, i.e., no detection during
acceleration and deceleration. The operation continues after detection and an oL3 or oL4 alarm is triggered.
Setting 6: UL3, UL4 at run (Alarm)
Undertorque detection works as long as the Up/Down command is active. The operation continues after detection and an
oL3 or oL4 alarm is triggered.
Setting 7: UL3, UL4 at speed agree (Fault)
Undertorque detection is active only when the output speed is equal to the speed reference, i.e., no detection during
acceleration and deceleration. The operation is stopped and an oL3 or oL4 fault is triggered.
Setting 8: UL3, UL4 at run (Fault)
Undertorque detection works as long as a Up/Down command is active. Operation stops and an oL3 or oL4 fault is
triggered.
■ L6-02, L6-05: Torque Detection Level 1, 2
These parameters set the detection levels for the torque detection functions 1 and 2. In V/f control mode, these levels are
set as a percentage of the drive rated output current, while in vector control modes these levels are set as a percentage of
the motor rated torque.
No. Name Setting Range Default
L6-02 Torque Detection Level 1 0 to 300% 150%
L6-05 Torque Detection Level 2 0 to 300% 150%
210 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
quadrant 2 quadrant 1
REV motor rotation FWD motor rotation
quadrant 3 quadrant 4
Parameter Details
L7-04 Reverse Regenerative Torque Limit 0 to 300% 200%
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 211
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
Setting 2: Enabled during operation
Setting 3: Enabled during constant speed
A phase loss on the power supply side is detected by measuring the voltage ripple in the DC bus and the drive input
voltage.
Input phase loss (PF) detection is typically triggered by single phase losses, voltage drop or phase imbalance.
Input phase loss detection is disabled when Rescue Operation is activated by one of the input terminals.
■ L8-06: Input Phase Loss Detection Level
Determines the level for input phase loss detection when a ripple is observed in the DC bus. Phase loss is detected when
the value set to L8-06 is greater than the difference between the peak value and the lowest value of the voltage ripple.
100% detection level = voltage (200 V or 400 V) × 2
212 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Fault when one phase is lost
An output phase loss fault (LF) is triggered when one output phase is lost. The output shuts off and the motor coasts to
stop.
Setting 2: Fault when two phases are lost
An output phase loss fault (LF) is triggered when two output phases are lost. The output shuts off and the motor coasts to
stop.
■ L8-09: Output Ground Fault Detection Selection
Enables or disables the output ground fault detection.
Setting 0: Disabled
Ground faults are not detected.
Setting 1: Enabled
A ground fault (GF) is triggered when high leakage current or a ground short circuit occurs in one or two output phases.
■ L8-10: Heatsink Cooling Fan Operation Selection
Selects the heatsink cooling fan operation.
Parameter Details
No. Name Setting Range Default
L8-10 Heatsink Cooling Fan Operation Selection 0 to 2 0
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 213
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Setting 0: Disabled
No current unbalance protection is provided to the motor.
Setting 1: Enabled
The LF2 fault is triggered if an output current imbalance is detected. Drive output shuts off and the motor coasts to stop.
■ L8-35: Installation Selection
Selects the type of installation for the drive and changes the drive overload (oL2) limits accordingly.
Note: This parameter is not reset when the drive is initialized.
214 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Setting 0: Disabled
The carrier frequency is not automatically reduced.
Setting 3: Enabled
The torque capability is improved by reducing the carrier frequency when the output current exceeds a certain value.
■ L8-39: Reduced Carrier Frequency
Determines value the carrier frequency is reduced to by the torque boost function.
Parameter Details
Setting 0: Disabled
Disable braking transistor protection when not using the internal braking transistor, including the following instances:
• When using a regen converter such as DC5.
• When using a regen unit such as RC5.
• When using external braking transistor options like CDBR units. 5
• When using the drive in common DC bus applications and the internal braking chopper is not installed.
Enabling L8-55 under such conditions can incorrectly trigger a braking transistor fault (rF).
Setting 1: Enabled
The following models come with a built-in braking transistor:
• CIMR-L 2A0018 to 2A0115
• CIMR-L 4A0009 to 4A0060
Enable L8-55 when connecting a braking resistor or a braking resistor unit to the drive built-in braking transistor.
Overload Tolerance for Internal Braking Transistor
Below, Figure 5.40 show the overload tolerance level for the drive’s built-in braking transistor.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 215
5.8 L: Protection Functions
Figure 5.40
50% 230
50
8
70% 90 500
30
16 160
100% 58 760
Usage
20
5 common_
(%ED) 130%
(%) 43 106 270 1200 TMonly
10
150%
380
21 67 150 600
5
80 170 420
3
29 1800
2
Figure 5.40 Overload Tolerance for Braking Transistor (CIMR-L 2A0018 to 2A0115, CIMR-L 4A0009 to 4A0060)
Setting 0: Mode 0
Setting 1: Mode 1
When the Safe Disabled Input is triggered, the operator displays and alarm, and the corresponding output terminal will
react as follows:
L8-88 Safe Disable Operation Alarm Display during Safety Disable Alarm Output (H2- = 10 ) Drive Ready
Selection (H2- = 6)
0 (mode 0) Hbb ALM flashes ON OFF
1 (mode1) Hbb ALM flashes OFF ON
216 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.9 n: Special Adjustments
Although this parameter rarely needs to be changed, it may require adjustment in the following situations:
• If hunting occurs, increase the setting value in steps of 0.05 while checking the response.
• If response is low, decrease the setting value in steps of 0.05 while checking the response.
■ n2-02, n2-03: Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Time Constant 1, 2
Parameter n2-02 sets the time constant normally used by AFR.
Parameter n2-03 sets the time constant during regenerative operation.
Note: Setting parameter n2-02 higher than n2-03 will trigger an oPE08 error.
Although these parameters rarely need to be changed, they may require adjustment in the following situations:
• If hunting occurs, increase n2-02. If response is low, decrease it.
• Increase n2-03 if overvoltage occurs with high inertia loads at the end of acceleration or with sudden load changes.
Parameter Details
• If setting n2-02 to a higher value, also increase C4-02 (Torque Compensation Delay Time Constant 1) proportionally.
900 900
750 750
0 0
0 0.5 1 0 0.5 1
Time (s) Time (s)
common_TMonly
Conventional Speed Control Inertia Compensation Control
Figure 5.41 Overshoot Suppression by Inertia Compensation
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 217
5.9 n: Special Adjustments
Figure 5.42
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
■ n5-02: Motor Acceleration Time
Sets the time required to accelerate the motor from a full stop up to the rated speed at the rated torque.
Calculation
The motor acceleration time can be calculated by,
Where:
π JMotor nrated • JMotor is the motor inertia in kgm/s2.
n5-02 =
30 Trated • nrated is the rated speed of the motor in r/min
• Trated is the rated torque of the motor in N⋅m.
218 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.9 n: Special Adjustments
<1> Insert 0 kg for the load to calculate the lowest setting, insert the elevator rated load to calculate the maximum setting for
n5-03. Use the lower of calculated values for initial trials and increase n5-03 gradually until the desired performance is
achieved.
Parameter Details
5. Connect the rope the motor.
6. Start operating the elevator while looking at the Speed Feedback Compensation output monitor (U6-56) and the motor
speed feedback (U1-05).
7. Adjust the Speed Feedback Compensation gain (n5-08) and C5-18 so that the monitor values in U6-56 and U1-05 are
relatively low.
Figure 5.43 shows a block diagram for the Speed Feedback Compensation.
5
Figure 5.43
Torque U1-09
ASR Limit Torque
Reference
Operating + Kn (1+1/ST) q-Axis
Speed
C5-01, -02 Current
–
L7- Control
q-Axis Current
n5-07
=1
Speed Observer Gain (P)
Speed Feedback
Speed Observer
= 0, 2 =1 n5-08
output monitor = 0, 2 n5-07
=2
U6-56
common_TMonly
Figure 5.43 Speed Feedback Compensation Operation
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 219
5.9 n: Special Adjustments
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
2 : Speed Feedback Compensation test mode
■ n5-08: Speed Feedback Compensation Gain (P)
Sets the proportional gain for the Speed Feedback Compensation.
Although this parameter rarely requires adjustment, increasing the gain can help improve responsiveness relative to the
load. Lower setting if oscillation occurs.
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Line-to-line resistance tuning
This setting enables line-to-line resistance online tuning. This procedure is effective for speed values up to 6 Hz and
improves the overload capacity in the low speed range by adjusting the value set for the motor resistance.
Setting 2: Voltage correction
The drive adjusts the output voltage during run to improve overload tolerance and minimize the effects of high
temperatures on speed accuracy.
Note: This setting can only be selected if the Energy Saving function is disabled (b8-01 = 0).
220 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.9 n: Special Adjustments
Parameter Details
No. Name Setting Range Default
n8-35 Initial Rotor Position Detection Selection 1 or 2 1
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 221
5.9 n: Special Adjustments
0: Disabled
After the rotor pole position is searched once, the drive starts using the detected rotor position. If the detected position
was wrong, an error will occur when the drive attempts running the motor. The initial pole search takes approximately 1.5
s.
1: Enabled
The rotor pole position is searched multiple times. Only if there is no difference between the search results, the drive
starts using the detected rotor position. Otherwise a dv8 error will be output. The initial pole search takes approximately
1.5 to 5.0 s.
■ Other Settings
Parameters n8-29 to n8-33 can be used to adjust the current control loop. These setting do normally not need to be
changed.
Parameter n8-62 sets a voltage limit in order to prevent voltage saturation.
■ n8-29: q-Axis Current Control Gain during Normal Operation
Sets the q-Axis proportional gain for the automatic current regulator.
222 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.9 n: Special Adjustments
Parameter Details
parameters (motor data, speed loop settings) are adjusted correctly.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 223
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
224 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
Setting 0: Hz
Setting 1: r/min
Note: For motor 2, o1-04 can only be set to 0 for Hertz.
Note: This parameter is displayed only when the drive is set to allow for user-set units (o1-03 = 3).
Parameter Details
Sets the units used to for distance control and for the sheave diameter.
Note: This parameter determines whether the following parameters are set in millimeters or inches: o1-20, S5-11, S5-12, U4-42,
U4-33, and U4-44.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 225
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
Setting 1: 1: 1
Setting 2: 1: 2
Setting 3: 1: 3
Setting 4: 1: 4
■ o1-22: Mechanical Gear Ratio
Sets the gear ratio of the mechanical gear.
Setting 0: Disabled
The LO/RE key is disabled.
Setting 1: Enabled
The LO/RE switches between LOCAL and REMOTE operation. Switching is possible during stop only. When LOCAL is
selected, the LED indicator on the LO/RE key will light up.
■ o2-02: STOP Key Function Selection
Determines if the STOP key on the digital operator can still be used to stop drive operation when the drive is being
controlled from a remote source (i.e., not from digital operator).
Setting 0: Disabled
Setting 1: Enabled
The STOP key will terminate drive operation even if the Up/Down command source is not assigned to the digital
operator. Cycle the Up/Down command to restart the drive if the drive has been stopped by pressing the STOP key.
226 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
Parameter Details
o2-05 Speed Reference Setting Method Selection 0 or 1 0
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 227
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
228 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
Parameter Details
o4-09 IGBT Maintenance Setting 0 to 150% 0%
Setting 0: No action
The drive keeps the record already saved concerning fault trace and fault history.
Setting 1: Reset fault data
Resets the data for the U2- and U3- monitors. Once o4-11 is set to 1 and the ENTER key is pressed, fault data is
erased and the display returns to 0.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 229
5.10 o: Operator Related Settings
Setting 0: No Action
The kWh data are kept
Setting 1: Reset kWh Data
Resets the kWh counter. The monitors U4-10 and U4-11 will display “0” after they are initialized. Once o4-12 is set to 1
and the ENTER key is pressed, kWh data is erased and the display returns to 0.
■ o4-13: Number of Travels Counter Reset
The number of travels counter displayed in U4-24/25 is not reset when the power is cycled or the drive is initialized. Use
o4-13 to reset U4-24/25.
Setting 0: No Action
Keeps the number of travels counter.
Setting 1: Resets the Number of Travels
Resets the number of travels counter. The monitor U4-24/25 will show 0. Once o4-13 is set to 1 and the ENTER key is
pressed, the counter value is erased and the display returns to 0.
■ o4-15: Maintenance Alarm Snooze Period
After a maintenance alarm output has been triggered, o4-15 determines the level that will trigger the next alarm for the
same component. The same alarm will be triggered by the detection level that triggered the original alarm plus the level
set in o4-15.
230 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Parameter Details
■ S1-03: DC Injection Current at Stop
Determines the amount of current to use for DC Injection at stop. Set as a percentage of the drive rated current. When
using OLV Control, the DC injection current is determined by multiplying S1-03 by S3-25 or S3-26.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 231
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
232 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Parameter Details
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
S3-01 Position Lock Gain at Start 1 0 to 100 5
S3-02 Position Lock Gain at Start 2 (Anti-Rollback Gain) 0.00 to 100.00 0.00
Note: 1. Check the C5- parameters to make sure the speed control loop settings are correct before making any adjustments to the Position
Lock gain.
2. Sometimes a fault may occur with detecting the direction of motor rotation (dv4) when using Closed Loop Vector for PM motors. To
correct this, either increase the settings of S3-01 and S3-02, or increase the number of pulses needed to trigger dv4 (F1-19). 5
■ S3-03: Position Lock Gain at Stop
Sets the gain used by the Position Lock control loop at stop to hold the car in place while the brake is applied.
Setting S3-03 to a high value will increase the ability of the drive to hold the car in place. Setting S3-03 too high can
cause motor oscillation and car vibration.
Note: 1. Check the C5- parameters to make sure the speed control loop settings are correct before making any adjustments to the Position
Lock gain.
2. Faults may occur when detecting the direction of motor rotation (dv4) when using CLV/PM. To correct this, either increase the
settings of S3-01 and S3-02, or increase the number of pulses required to trigger dv4 (F1-19).
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 233
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
234 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Figure 5.44
Run Command
ON
SFS output
C1-07
C2-01
S3-21
S3-20
Parameter Details
S3-26 DC Injection Gain in Motoring Operation 0 to 400% 20%
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 235
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
236 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
2: Enabled for motor 1 only
■ S4-02: Light Load Direction Search Method
Determines the method used to perform Light Load Direction Search.
Parameter Details
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
S4-02 Light Load Direction Search Method 0 or 1 1
0: Output current
1: Detect direction of regeneration
■ S4-03: Light Load Direction Search Time
5
Sets the time to perform Light Load Direction Search.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 237
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
0: Battery
1: UPS (single-phase)
2: UPS (three-phase)
■ S4-07: UPS Power
Sets the capacity of the UPS.
0: Disabled
1: Enabled until Light Load Direction Search is complete
2: Enabled until stop
■ S4-12: DC Bus Voltage during Rescue Operation
Sets the DC bus voltage during Rescue Operation.
238 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Speed
0 t
Parameter Details
5
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 239
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Operating
speed d1-19
(Nominal Speed)
Constant speed
operation at
rated speed d1-26
(normal stop (Leveling Speed)
sequence) 0
Time
H1- = 53
(Leveling Speed) ON(close)
Operating
speed d1-19
(Nominal Speed)
40% of nominal
speed
d1-26
(Leveling Speed)
0
Time
H1- = 53
Constant speed (Leveling Speed) ON(close)
operation at
Not Available.
less than the
rated speed (The speed is less than 40% of the nominal speed.)
Operating d1-19
speed (Nominal Speed)
40% of nominal
speed
d1-26
(Leveling Speed)
0
Time
H1- = 53
Leveling Speed ON(close)
240 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
0: Disabled
1: Enabled (Short Floor Operation)
2: Enabled (Advanced Short Floor Operation)
■ S5-02: Nominal Speed for Short Floor Calculation
Determines the rated speed used to calculate the distance for the Short Floor function when speed priority is set for Multi-
step Speed Reference (d1-18 = 0 or 3).
Parameter Details
• Decrease the gain level set to S5-04 and S5-05 if the leveling time is too long or if the optimum speed calculated by the
drive is too slow.
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
S5-04 Distance Calculation Acceleration Time Gain 50.0 to 200.0% 150.0%
Note: Setting S5-04 too low may trigger an overrun due to faster optimum speeds and shortened leveling times. Avoid setting this gain
less than 100%. 5
■ S5-05: Distance Calculation Deceleration Time Gain
Sets the gain used to adjust the jerk at deceleration and optimum speed calculation when Short Floor Operation Selection
(S5-01) is set to 2.
• Increase the gain level set to S5-04 and S5-05 if the leveling time is too short or if the optimum speed calculated by the
drive is too fast.
• Decrease the gain level set to S5-04 and S5-05 if the leveling time is too long or if the optimum speed calculated by the
drive is too slow.
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
S5-05 Distance Calculation Deceleration Time Gain 50.0 to 200.0% 150.0%
Note: Setting S5-05 too low may trigger an overrun due to faster optimum speeds and shortened leveling times. Avoid setting this gain
less than 100%.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 241
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Note: Leveling Distance Control should be used only for elevators with a constant stopping distance. Do not use Leveling Distance
Control in elevators where the stopping distance changes frequently.
The following functions are disabled when Leveling Distance Control is selected:
• Switching between deceleration times
• Droop Control (b7 parameters)
• Shoot Floor, Advanced Short Floor (S5-01 = 1, 2)
Leveling Distance Control is disabled when any one of the following functions are selected:
• Analog frequency reference
• Rescue Operation
• Inspection Operation
• During Motor 2 selection
Direct Landing
Direct Landing (S5-10 = 1) is activated at the start of deceleration, and brings the elevator car to the designated floor
without the use of the leveling speed.
Direct Landing disables Leveling Distance Control, and uses a speed reference calculated by multiplying E1-04 times S5-
13. If a Stop distance correction command (H1- = 5C) is triggered during Direct Landing, then the drive will switch
to the stop distance set in S5-12 for the remaining distance. Direct Landing will end once data from the encoder indicates
that the stopping distance is 0.
Figure 5.45 illustrates a Direct Landing Operation example.
Table 5.15 Conditions for Direct Landing
Speed Priority Direct Landing Start Conditions
Multi-step speed sequence
Speed reference ≥ E1-04 × S5-13 and the Up/Down command is not active or the speed reference is 0.
(d1-18 = 0, 3)
High speed reference has priority
(d1-18 = 1) The Up/Down command is not active, the speed reference is 0, or the leveling speed reference has been selected by one of the
Leveling speed reference has priority multi-function input terminals (H1-).
(d1-18 = 2)
242 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Brake Apply
Operation
Delay Time
Speed
(S1-07)
S2 Time
<1>
<1> Area S1 is the deceleration distance (S5-11) from the start of deceleration to stop. Area S2 is the stopping distance (S5-12) from the point
at which the stopping distance compensation signal is entered to when the car arrives at the designated floor.
Figure 5.46 Direct Landing Operation Example
Leveling Distance Control
Leveling Distance Control (S5-10 = 2) uses the leveling speed reference for the remaining distance to arrive at the
designated floor. Leveling Distance Control is activated when the conditions listed in Table 5.16 are met.
Table 5.16 Leveling Distance Control Operation
Speed Priority Selection Multi-Function Input Terminal Settings Leveling Distance Control Start Conditions
Multi-step speed sequence
– The Up/Down command is not active or the speed reference is 0.
(d1-18 = 0,3)
Leveling speed reference is selected The Up/Down command is not active, or all input terminals set for
High speed reference has priority (H1- = 53) H1- = 50 to 53 are open
Parameter Details
(d1-18 = 1) Leveling speed reference is not selected
Up/Down command is not active.
(H1- ≠ 53)
Rated speed reference is selected The Up/Down command is not active, or all input terminals set for
Multi-step speed sequence (H1- = 50) H1- = 50 to 53 are open.
(d1-18 = 2) Rated speed reference is not selected
Up/Down command is not active.
(H1- ≠ 50)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 243
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Brake Apply
Delay Time
Operation S1-07
Speed
S Time
<1>
<1> Area S is the stopping distance (S5-12) from the point at which leveling operation is complete to when the car arrives at the designated
floor.
Figure 5.47 Operation Sequence Example for Leveling Distance Control
0: Disable
1: Direct Landing
2: Leveling Distance Control
■ S5-11: Deceleration Distance
Sets the deceleration distance when Stop Distance Control is enabled. Refer to Direct Landing on page 242 for details.
<1> The setting range becomes 0.00 to 650.00 inches when the length units are set for inches (o1-12 = 1).
<1> The setting range becomes 0.00 to 393.00 inches when the length units are set for inches (o1-12 = 1).
244 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
Parameter Details
No. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
S6-04 Output Current Error (SE3) Detection Delay Time 0 to 5000 ms 200 ms
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 245
5.11 S: Elevator Parameters
0: Always enabled
1: During run only
■ S6-15: Speed Reference Loss Detection
Enabled or disables detection for missing speed reference (FrL).
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
■ S6-16: Restart after Baseblock Selection
Allows the drive to restart the motor after returning to normal operation from Baseblock state (H1- = 8/9) or from
Safe Torque-Off state (Safe Disable inputs H1 and H2 enabled) while the Up/Down command is still active.
◆ T: Motor Tuning
Auto-Tuning automatically sets and tunes parameters required for optimal motor performance. Refer to Auto-Tuning on
page 104 for details on Auto-Tuning parameters.
246 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
5.12 U: Monitor Parameters
Parameter Details
• Maintenance data and replacement information for various drive components
• kWh data
• Highest peak current that has occurred and output speed at the time the peak current occurred
• Motor overload status information
• Detailed information about the present Up/Down command and speed reference source selection
Refer to U4: Maintenance Monitors on page 376 for a complete list of U4- monitors and descriptions. 5
◆ U6: Control Monitors
Control monitors show:
• Reference data for the output voltage and vector control
• Data on PM motor rotor synchronization, forward phase compensation, and flux positioning
• Pulse data from the motor encoder
• Pulse data for Position Lock control
• Speed Loop and Inertia Compensation control monitors
Refer to Figure 5.10 on page 161 for details and an illustration showing where monitors are located in the speed control
loop block.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 247
5.12 U: Monitor Parameters
248 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6
Troubleshooting
This chapter provides descriptions of the drive faults, alarms, errors, related displays, and
guidance for troubleshooting.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 249
6.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Sudden Movement Hazard
Ensure there are no short circuits between the main circuit terminals (R/L1, S/L2, and T/L3) or between the
ground and main circuit terminals before restarting the drive.
Failure to comply may result in serious injury or death and will cause damage to equipment.
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may illustrate drives without covers or safety shields to display details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
Always ground the motor-side grounding terminal.
Improper equipment grounding could result in death or serious injury by contacting the motor case.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use equipment.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Maintenance, inspection and replacement of parts must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar with
installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives.
Do not perform work on the drive while wearing loose clothing, jewelry, or without eye protection.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Remove all metal objects such as watches and rings, secure loose clothing and wear eye protection before beginning
work on the drive.
Do not remove covers or touch circuit boards while the power is on.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Fire Hazard
Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque.
Loose electrical connections could result in death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical connections.
Improperly tightened terminal screws can also cause erroneous equipment operation.
250 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Do not connect the AC power line to the output motor terminals of the drive. Failure to comply could result in
death or serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line voltage application to output terminals.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line voltage
application to output terminals.
• Do not connect AC line power to output terminals U, V, and W.
• Make sure that the power supply lines are connected to main circuit input terminals R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 (or R/L1 and S/
L2 for single-phase power).
NOTICE
Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive and circuit boards.
Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Never connect or disconnect the motor from the drive while the drive is outputting voltage.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in damage to the drive.
Do not use unshielded cable for control wiring.
Failure to comply may cause electrical interference resulting in poor system performance. Use shielded twisted-pair
wires and ground the shield to the ground terminal of the drive.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use the product.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive or braking circuit.
Carefully review instruction manual TOBPC72060000 when connecting a braking option to the drive.
Do not modify the drive circuitry.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive and will void warranty.
Yaskawa is not responsible for modification of the product made by the user.
Check all the wiring after installing the drive and connecting other devices to ensure that all connections are
correct.
Troubleshooting
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive.
Equipment Hazard
Do not check or test control circuit signals while the drive is running.
Improper use of test equipment could result in damage to the drive circuitry by short circuit.
6
Do not perform a withstand voltage test on any part of the unit.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the sensitive devices within the drive.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 251
6.2 Drive Alarms, Faults, and Errors
252 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.2 Drive Alarms, Faults, and Errors
boL Braking Transistor Overload 257 FrL Speed Reference Missing 261
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communication
CE 257 LF Output Phase Loss 261
Error
oC Overcurrent 261
,
CPF00, CPF01 Control Circuit Error 257
Option Card Connection Error at Option
<1> oFA00 262
Connector CN5-A
Option Card Fault at Option Connector
CPF02 A/D Conversion Error 257 oFA01 262
CN5-A
, CPF07, ,
Terminal Board Connection Error 258 oFA10, oFA11 262
CPF08
Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port
CN5-A
, to
CPF20, CPF21 Control Circuit Error 258 oFA12 to oFA17 262
<1>
CPF24 Drive Unit Signal Fault 258 oFb00 Option Card Connection Error (CN5-B) 262
Troubleshooting
Speed Deviation (for Control Mode with ,
dEv 259 oFb03, oFb11 Option Card Error (CN5-B) 263
Encoder)
dv4 Inversion Prevention Detection 259 oFC01 Option Card Fault (CN5-C) 263
dv6 Overacceleration Detection 259 oFC02 Option Card Fault (CN5-C) 263
Err EEPROM Write Error 260 oFC50 Encoder Option AD Conversion Error 263
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 253
6.2 Drive Alarms, Faults, and Errors
oFC53 Encoder Communication Data Error 264 rr Dynamic Braking Transistor Fault 266
oFC54 Encoder Error 264 SE1 Motor Contactor Response Error 266
PF Input Phase Loss 266 voF Output Voltage Detection Error 268
<1> Displayed as , when occurring at drive power up. When one of the faults occurs after successfully starting the drive, the display
will show , .
dEv Speed Deviation (for Control Mode with Encoder) YES 270
L8-88 = 0: YES
Hbb Safe Disable Signal Input 271
L8-88 = 1: No (default)
L8-88 = 0: YES
HbbF Safe Disable Circuit Fault Signal Input 271
L8-88 = 1: No (default)
254 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.2 Drive Alarms, Faults, and Errors
LT-3 Soft Charge Bypass Relay Maintenance Time No output <1> 271
PGo Encoder Disconnected (for Control Mode with Encoder) YES 272
■ Operation Errors
Table 6.5 Operation Error Displays
oPE01 Drive Capacity Setting Error 274 oPE08 Parameter Selection Error 275
oPE02 Parameter Setting Range Error 274 oPE10 V/f Pattern Setting Error 275
Troubleshooting
oPE03 274 oPE16 Energy Saving Constants Error 275
Error
oPE04 Terminal Board Mismatch Error 274 oPE18 Parameter Setting Error 275
oPE05 Reference Source Selection Error 274 oPE20 PG-F3 Setting Error 275
oPE06 Control Mode Selection Error 274 oPE21 Elevator Parameter Setting Fault 275
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 255
6.2 Drive Alarms, Faults, and Errors
■ Auto-Tuning Errors
Table 6.6 Auto-Tuning Error Displays
End1 Excessive V/f Setting 276 Er-05 No-Load Current Error 277
End3 Rated Current Setting Alarm 276 Er-09 Acceleration Error 278
End4 Adjusted Slip Calculation Error 276 Er-10 Motor Direction Error 278
End5 Resistance Tuning Error 276 Er-11 Motor Speed Error 278
End6 Leakage Inductance Alarm 276 Er-12 Current Detection Error 278
End7 No-Load Current Alarm 276 Er-13 Leakage Inductance Error 278
End8 Rescue Operation Speed Warning 277 Er-18 Induction Voltage Error 278
Er-01 Motor Data Error 277 Er-21 Z Pulse Correction Error 279
Er-02 Alarm 277 Er-22 Initial Rotor Pole Search Error 279
256 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.3 Fault Detection
Troubleshooting
The torque limit was reached continuously for three seconds or longer while ramping to stop in OLV Control.
Cause Possible Solution
Motor parameters are improperly set. Check the motor parameter settings and repeat Auto-Tuning.
Torque limit is too low. Set the torque limit to the most appropriate setting (L7-01 through L7-04).
• Adjust the deceleration ramp (C1-02, -04, -06, -08).
Load inertia is too big.
• Set the speed reference to the minimum value and interrupt the Up/Down command when the drive finishes decelerating.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name 6
or CPF00 or CPF01
Control Circuit Error
<1> <1>
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 257
6.3 Fault Detection
CPF07
Terminal Board Connection Error
CPF08
258 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.3 Fault Detection
Troubleshooting
Pulses indicate that the motor is rotating in the opposite direction of the speed reference. Set the number of pulses to trigger
dv4 inverse detection to F1-19.
Note: Set F1-19 to 0 to disable inverse detection in applications where the motor may rotate in the opposite direction of the speed
reference.
Cause Possible Solution
• Set the encoder offset to E5-11 as specified on the motor nameplate.
The encoder offset is not set properly to E5-11. • If the problem continues after cycling power, then replace either the PG option card or the encoder itself. Replacing the encoder
or changing the motor/encoder rotation direction requires readjustment of the encoder offset. 6
Noise interference along the encoder cable is disturbing • Make sure the motor is rotating in the correct direction.
the encoder signals. • Look for any problems on the load side that might be causing the motor to rotate in the opposite direction.
Encoder is disconnected, not wired properly, or the PG • Rewire the encoder and make sure all lines including shielded line are properly connected.
option card or the encoder itself is damaged. • If the problem continues after cycling power, replace the PG option card or the encoder.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Overacceleration Detection
dv6
The acceleration of the elevator car exceeds the overacceleration detection level (S6-10)
Cause Possible Solution
Set E5-11 to the encoder offset value written on the motor nameplate. The encoder offset needs to be adjusted whenever the
The encoder offset (E5-11) is incorrect.
encoder is replaced or when reversing the direction of the motor.
Noise along the encoder cable.
Cables for the motor encoder are not wired properly, or Check the encoder wiring for any loose connections. Make sure that the shielded line is properly grounded.
the PG option card (or the encoder itself) is damaged.
Incorrect motor data has been set to the E5 parameters. Check the values set to the E5 parameters to make sure they match the information on the motor nameplate.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 259
6.3 Fault Detection
• Press .
Noise has corrupted data while writing to the EEPROM. • Correct the parameter setting.
• Cycle power to the drive. Refer to Diagnosing and Resetting Faults on page 283.
• If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
instructions on replacing the control board.
• If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
Hardware problem.
instructions on replacing the control board.
260 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.3 Fault Detection
Troubleshooting
• Check for faulty wiring or poor connections on the output side of the drive.
Phase loss has occurred on the output side of the drive.
• Correct the wiring.
Terminal wires on the output side of the drive are loose. Apply the tightening torque specified in this manual to fasten the terminals. .
If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
The output circuit is damaged.
instructions on replacing the control board.
• Measure the line-to-line resistance for each motor phase. Ensure all values are the same.
Motor impedance or motor phases are uneven.
• Replace the motor.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
6
Overcurrent
oC
Drive sensors have detected an output current greater than the specified overcurrent level.
Cause Possible Solution
The motor has been damaged due to overheating or the • Check the insulation resistance.
motor insulation is damaged. • Replace the motor.
• Check the motor cables.
• Remove the short circuit and reapply power to the drive.
One of the motor cables has shorted out or there is a
grounding problem. • Check the resistance between the motor cables and the ground terminal .
• Replace damaged cables.
• Measure the current flowing into the motor.
• Replace the drive with a larger capacity drive if the current value exceeds the rated current.
The load is too heavy.
• Determine if there is sudden fluctuation in the current level.
• Reduce the load to avoid sudden changes in the current level or switch to a larger drive.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 261
6.3 Fault Detection
Calculate the amount of torque required for the desired acceleration and/or deceleration ramp relative to the inertia moment of the
load.
Accel/decel ramp is too fast. If the drive is not capable of producing that much torque in time, try the following setting changes:
• Reduce the acceleration and/or deceleration ramp (i.e., increase the accel/decel time).
• Use a larger capacity drive.
The drive is attempting to operate a specialized motor or • Check the motor capacity.
a motor larger than the maximum size allowed. • Ensure that the rated capacity of the drive is greater than or equal to the capacity rating found on the motor nameplate.
Magnetic contactor (MC) on the output side of the drive
Set up the operation sequence so that the MC is not tripped while the drive is outputting current.
has turned on or off.
• Check the ratios between the voltage and frequency.
V/f setting is not operating as expected. • Set parameters E1-04 through E1-10 appropriately (E3-04 through E3-10 for motor 2).
• Lower the voltage if it is too high relative to the frequency.
• Check the amount of torque compensation.
Excessive torque compensation.
• Reduce the torque compensation gain (C4-01) until there is no speed loss and less current.
• Review the possible solutions provided for handling noise interference.
Drive fails to operate properly due to noise interference.
• Review the section on handling noise interference and check the control circuit lines, main circuit lines, and ground wiring.
• Check which motor control method the drive is set to (A1-02).
The motor control method and motor do not match. • For IM motors, set A1-02 = “0”, “2”, or “3”.
• For PM motors, set A1-02 = “7”.
The rated output current of the drive is too small Use a larger drive.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Option Card Connection Error at Option Connector CN5-A
oFA00
Option compatibility error
Cause Possible Solution
The option card installed into port CN5-A is
Check if the drive supports the option card to be installed. Contact Yaskawa for assistance.
incompatible with the drive.
A PG option card is connected to option port CN5-A PG option cards are supported by option ports CN5-B and CN5-C only. Place the PG option card into the correct option port.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Option Card Fault at Option Connector CN5-A
oFA01
Option not properly connected
Cause Possible Solution
• Turn the power off and reconnect the option card.
• Check if the option card is properly plugged into the option port. Make sure the card is fixed properly.
The option board connection to port CN5-A is faulty. • If the option is not a communication option card, try to use the card in another option port. If the option card works properly in
a different option port, replace the drive because port CN5-A is damaged. If the error persists (oFb01 or oFC01 occur), replace
the option card.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
, oFA05, oFA06
, oFA10, oFA11
Option card error occurred at option port CN5-A
to oFA12 to oFA17
to oFA30 to oFA43
262 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.3 Fault Detection
to oFb03 to oFb11
Option card error occurred at Option Port CN5-B
to oFb12 to oFb17
Cause Possible Solution
• Cycle power to the drive.
Option card or hardware is damaged. • If the problem continues, replace the control board or the entire drive. Contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative for
instructions on replacing the control board.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Option Card Connection Error at Option Port CN5-C
oFC00
Option compatibility error
Cause Possible Solution
The option card installed into port CN5-C is
Confirm that the drive supports the option card to be installed. Contact Yaskawa for assistance.
incompatible with the drive.
A communication option card has been installed in
Communication option cards are only supported by option port CN5-A. It is not possible to install more than one comm. option.
option port CN5-C.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-C
oFC01
Option not properly connected
Cause Possible Solution
• Turn the power off and reconnect the option card.
• Check if the option card is properly plugged into the option port. Make sure the card is fixed properly.
The option board connection to port CN5-C is faulty.
• Try to use the card in another option port (in case of a PG option use port CN5-B). If the option card works in a different port,
replace the drive because port CN5-C is damaged. If the error persists (oFA01 or oFb01 occur), replace the option board.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-C
oFC02
A maximum of two PG option boards can be used simultaneously. Remove the PG option board installed into option port CN5-A.
Cause Possible Solution
An option card of the same type is already installed in
Except for PG options, each option card type can only be installed once. Make sure only one type of option card is connected.
option port CN5-A or CN5-B.
An input option card is already installed in option port Make sure that a comm. option, a digital input option, or an analog input option is installed. The same type of card cannot be
CN5-A or CN5-B. installed twice.
Three PG option boards are installed. A maximum of two PG option boards can be used simultaneously. Remove the PG option board installed into option port CN5-A.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
to oFC03 to oFC11
Option card error occurred at option port CN5-C
Troubleshooting
to oFC12 to oFC17
oFC50
Encoder Option AD Conversion Error 6
Error with the A/D conversion level (VCC level), or A/D conversion timed out.
Cause Possible Solution
The PG option card is damaged. Replace the PG option card.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Encoder Option Analog Circuit Error
oFC51
Incorrect signal level (+2.5 V signal)
Cause Possible Solution
The PG option card is damaged. Replace the PG option card.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Encoder Communication Timeout
oFC52
Signal encoder timed out waiting to receive data
Cause Possible Solution
Encoder cable wiring is wrong. Correct the wiring.
Encoder cable is disconnected. Reconnect the cable.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 263
6.3 Fault Detection
264 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.3 Fault Detection
Accel/decel ramp is too short. Increase the settings for the acceleration and deceleration times (C1-01 through C1-08).
• Adjust the preset V/f pattern (E1-04 through E1-10) by reducing E1-08 and E1-10.
The output voltage is too high.
• Do not lower E1-08 and E1-10 excessively. This reduces load tolerance at low speeds.
Drive capacity is too small. Replace the drive with a larger model.
• Reduce the load when operating at low speeds.
Overload occurred when operating at low speeds. • Replace the drive with a model that is one frame size larger.
• Lower the carrier frequency (C6-03).
Excessive torque compensation. Reduce the torque compensation gain (C4-01) until there is no speed loss but less current.
Output current fluctuation due to input phase loss Check the power supply for phase loss.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Overtorque Detection 1
oL3
The current has exceeded the value set for torque detection (L6-02) for longer than the allowable time (L6-03).
Cause Possible Solution
Parameter settings are not appropriate for the load. Check the settings of parameters L6-02 and L6-03.
Fault on the machine side (e.g., machine is locked up). Check the status of the load. Remove the cause of the fault.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Overtorque Detection 2
oL4
The current has exceeded the value set for Overtorque Detection 2 (L6-05) for longer than the allowable time (L6-06).
Cause Possible Solution
Parameter settings are not appropriate for the load. Check the settings of parameters L6-05 and L6-06.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
External Digital Operator Connection Fault
• The external operator has been disconnected from the drive.
oPr Note: An oPr fault will occur when all of the following conditions are true:
• Output is interrupted when the operator is disconnected (o2-06 = 1).
• The Up/Down command is assigned to the operator (b1-02 = 0 and LOCAL has been selected).
Cause Possible Solution
• Check the connection between the operator and the drive.
External operator is not properly connected to the drive. • Replace the cable if damaged.
• Turn off the drive input power and disconnect the operator. Then reconnect the operator and turn the drive input power back on.
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
Overspeed (for Control Mode with Encoder)
oS
The motor speed feedback exceeded the F1-08 setting.
Cause Possible Solution
• Increase the settings for C5-01 (Speed Control Proportional Gain 1) and reduce C5-02 (Speed Control Integral Time 1).
Overshoot is occurring.
• If using a closed loop vector mode, enable Inertia Compensation.
Inappropriate parameter settings. Check the setting for the overspeed detection level and the overspeed detection time (F1-08 and F1-09).
Digital Operator Display Fault Name
DC Bus Overvoltage
ov Voltage in the DC bus has exceeded the overvoltage detection level.
• For 200 V class: approximately 410 V
• For 400 V class: approximately 820 V
Cause Possible Solution
• Increase the deceleration ramp (C1-02, C1-04, C1-06, C1-08).
Deceleration ramp is too short and regenerative energy
Troubleshooting
• Make sure the braking resistor rating/external braking transistor rating fits the application.
is flowing from the motor into the drive.
• If an external braking transistor is used, make sure it is connected properly and working as expected.
• Check if sudden drive acceleration triggers an overvoltage alarm.
Fast acceleration ramp causes the motor to overshoot the
• Increase the acceleration ramp (C1-01, C1-03, C1-05, C1-07).
speed reference.
• Increase the jerk setting in C2-02 (decrease if o1-03 > 3)
Install a DC link choke.
Surge voltage entering from the drive input power.
Note: Voltage surge can result from a thyristor convertor and phase advancing capacitor using the same input power supply.
Ground fault in the output circuit causes the DC bus
capacitor to overcharge.
• Check the motor wiring for ground faults.
• Correct grounding shorts and turn the power back on.
6
• Check the voltage.
Drive input power voltage is too high.
• Lower drive input power voltage within the limits listed in the specifications.
• Check braking transistor wiring for errors.
The braking transistor is wired incorrectly.
• Properly rewire the braking resistor device.
Encoder cable is disconnected. Reconnect the cable.
Encoder cable wiring is wrong. Correct the wiring.
Noise interference along the encoder wiring. Separate the wiring from the source of the noise (often the output lines from the drive).
• Review the list of possible solutions provided for controlling noise.
Drive fails to operate properly due to noise interference.
• Review the section on handling noise interference and check the control circuit lines, main circuit lines, and ground wiring.
• Adjust the parameters that control hunting.
Motor hunting occurs.
• Adjust the AFR time constant (n2-02 and n2-03).
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 265
6.3 Fault Detection
266 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.3 Fault Detection
Troubleshooting
The main circuit capacitors are worn. • Replace either the control board or the entire drive if U4-05 exceeds 90%. For instructions on replacing the control board,
contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative.
• Cycle power to the drive and see if the fault reoccurs.
• If the problem continues, replace either the control board or the entire drive. For instructions on replacing the control board,
The relay or contactor on the soft-charge bypass circuit contact Yaskawa or a Yaskawa representative.
is damaged. • Check monitor U4-06 for the performance life of the soft-charge bypass.
• Replace either the control board or the entire drive if U4-06 exceeds 90%. For instructions on replacing the control board,
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 267
6.3 Fault Detection
268 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.4 Alarm Detection
Troubleshooting
The option card is not properly connected to the • The connector pins on the option card are not properly lined up with the connector pins on the drive.
drive. • Reinstall the option card.
• Check options available to minimize the effects of noise.
• Take steps to counteract noise in the control circuit wiring, main circuit lines and ground wiring.
• Try to reduce noise on the controller side.
A data error occurred due to noise.
• Use surge absorbers on magnetic contactors or other equipment causing the disturbance.
• Use recommended cables or some other type of shielded line. Ground the shield to the controller side or on the input power side.
• All wiring for comm. devices should be separated from drive input power lines. Install an EMC noise filter to the drive input power.
Digital Operator Display Minor Fault Name 6
Serial Communication Stand By
CALL
Communication has not yet been established.
Cause Possible Solutions
• Check for wiring errors.
Communications wiring is faulty, there is a short
• Correct the wiring.
circuit, or something is not connected properly.
• Check for disconnected cables and short circuits. Repair as needed.
Programming error on the master side. Check communications at start-up and correct programming errors.
• Perform a self-diagnostics check.
Communications circuitry is damaged. • If the problem continues, replace either the control board or the entire drive. For instructions on replacing the control board, contact
Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative.
A termination resistor must be installed at both ends of a communication line. Slave drives must have the internal termination resistor
Termination resistor setting is incorrect.
switch set correctly. Place DIP switch S2 to the ON position.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 269
6.4 Alarm Detection
270 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.4 Alarm Detection
• Check if the unused terminals have been set for H1- = 20 to 2F (External Fault).
Multi-function contact inputs are set incorrectly.
• Change the terminal settings.
Digital Operator Display Minor Fault Name
Safe Disable Signal Input
Hbb
Both Safe Disable Input channels are open.
Cause Possible Solutions
• Check signal status at the input terminals H1 and H2.
Both Safe Disable Inputs H1 and H2 are open. • Check the Sink/Source Selection for the digital inputs.
• If the Safe Disable function is not utilized, check if the terminals H1-HC, and H2-HC are linked.
Replace either the control board or the entire drive. For instructions on replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest
Internally, both Safe Disable channels are broken.
sales representative.
Digital Operator Display Minor Fault Name
Safe Disable Circuit Fault Signal Input
HbbF
One Safe Disable channel is open while the other one is closed.
Cause Possible Solutions
The signals to the Safe Disable inputs are wrong or Check signal status at the input terminals H1 and H2. If the Safe Disable function is not utilized, the terminals H1-HC, and H2-HC
the wiring is incorrect. must be linked.
Replace either the control board or the entire drive. For instructions on replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest
One of the Safe Disable channels is faulty.
sales representative.
Digital Operator Display Minor Fault Name
High Current Alarm
HCA
Drive current exceeded overcurrent warning level (150% of the rated current).
Cause Possible Solutions
Load is too heavy. Either reduce the load for applications with repetitive operation (repetitive stops and starts, etc.), or replace the drive.
Calculate the amount of torque required for the desired acceleration and/or deceleration ramp relative to the inertia moment of the
load.
Accel/decel ramp is too short. If the torque level is not right for the load, take the following steps:
• Increase the acceleration and deceleration times (C1-01 through C1-08).
• Increase the capacity of the drive.
A special-purpose motor is being used, or the drive is
• Check the motor capacity.
attempting to run a motor greater than the maximum
• Use a motor appropriate for the drive. Ensure the motor is within the allowable capacity range.
allowable capacity.
The current level increased due to a momentary
power loss or while attempting to perform a fault The alarm will appear only briefly. There is no need to take action to prevent the alarm from occurring in such instances.
reset.
Digital Operator Display Minor Fault Name
Cooling Fan Maintenance Time
LT-1 The cooling fan has reached its expected maintenance period and may need to be replaced.
Note: An alarm output (H2- = 10) will only be triggered if H2- = 2F.
Cause Possible Solutions
The cooling fan has reached 90% of its expected
Replace the cooling fan and reset the Maintenance Monitor by setting o4-03 to 0.
performance life.
Digital Operator Display Minor Fault Name
Capacitor Maintenance Time
LT-2 The main circuit and control circuit capacitors are nearing the end of their expected performance life.
Note: An alarm output (H2- = 10) will only be triggered if H2- = 2F.
Troubleshooting
Cause Possible Solutions
The main circuit and control circuit capacitors have Replace either the control board or the entire drive. For instructions on replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest
reached 90% of their expected performance life. sales representative.
Digital Operator Display Minor Fault Name
Soft Charge Bypass Relay Maintenance Time
LT-3 The DC bus soft charge relay is nearing the end of its expected performance life.
Note: An alarm output (H2- = 10) will only be triggered if H2- = 2F. 6
Cause Possible Solutions
The DC bus soft charge relay has reached 90% of Replace either the control board or the entire drive. For instructions on replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest
expected performance life. sales representative.
Digital Operator Display Minor Fault Name
IGBT Maintenance Time (90%)
LT-4 IGBTs have reached 90% of their expected performance life.
Note: An alarm output (H2- = 10) will only be triggered if H2- = 2F.
Cause Possible Solutions
Check the load, carrier frequency, and output speed.
NOTICE:
Optimize Performance Life. To maximize drive performance life, make sure the drive output current does not exceed 150% of the
IGBTs have reached 90% of their expected
drive rated current. Expected performance life estimates the number of drive starts at three million times if output current does not
performance life.
exceed 150%. This assumes the carrier frequency is at its default setting (8 kHz for models CIMR-L2A0018 to 2A0115, 4A0009 to
4A0091, and 5 kHz for models CIMR-L2A0145, 2A0180, 4A0112, 4A0150) and a peak current of less than 150% of the drive
rated current.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 271
6.4 Alarm Detection
272 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.4 Alarm Detection
Troubleshooting
Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative.
The drive input power transformer is too small and • Check for an alarm when the magnetic contactor, line breaker, and leakage breaker are closed.
voltage drops when the power is switched on. • Check the capacity of the drive input power transformer.
Air inside the drive is too hot. • Check the temperature inside the drive.
Replace either the control board or the entire drive. For instructions on replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest
The CHARGE light is broken or disconnected.
sales representative.
Digital Operator Display Minor Fault Name
6
Output Voltage Detection Error
voF
There is a problem with the output voltage.
Cause Possible Solutions
Replace either the control board or the entire drive. For instructions on replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest
Hardware is damaged.
sales representative.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 273
6.5 Operator Programming Errors
274 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.5 Operator Programming Errors
Troubleshooting
Elevator Parameter Setting Fault
oPE21
Elevator parameters are not set correctly.
Cause Possible Solutions
Advanced Short Floor is enabled (S5-01 = 2) and one of the following contradictory settings:
⇒Change settings so that 4.8 ≤ E1-04 < 100.0.
• The maximum output speed (E1-04) is set higher than 100 Hz or less than 4.8 Hz.
⇒Correct the setting in parameters C1-01 through C1-08 so that 0.1≤ accel/decel time < 50.
• The accel/decel ramps (C1-01 to C1-08) are set longer than 50.0 s or shorter than 0.1 s.
• The deceleration distance (S5-11) is set to value lower than the minimum deceleration
distance (U4-43).
⇒Correct parameter settings so that S5-11 > U4-43.
⇒Correct parameter settings so that S5-12 > U4-44.
6
• The stop distance (S5-12) is set to a value lower than the minimum stop distance (U4-44).
Both S5-10 and S5-01 are enabled at the same time. ⇒Correct the setting in parameters S5-01 and S5-10.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 275
6.6 Auto-Tuning Fault Detection
End1 Excessive V/f Setting (detected only during Rotational Auto-Tuning, and displayed after Auto-Tuning is complete)
End2 Motor Iron-Core Saturation Coefficient (detected only during Rotational Auto-Tuning and displayed after Auto-Tuning is complete)
276 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.6 Auto-Tuning Fault Detection
Er-02 Alarm
Troubleshooting
Results from Auto-Tuning are outside the parameter
setting range or the tuning process took too long. Check and correct faulty motor wiring.
Motor cable or cable connection faulty.
Digital Operator Display Error Name
Cause
Motor data entered during Auto-Tuning was
Possible Solutions
• Make sure the data entered to the T1 parameters match the information written on the motor nameplate.
6
incorrect. • Restart Auto-Tuning and enter the correct information.
• Check and correct faulty motor wiring.
Results from Auto-Tuning are outside the parameter
• Perform Rotational Auto-Tuning. Remember that the rope must be fully removed from the motor and the brake must be released to
setting range or the tuning process took too long.
perform Rotational Auto-Tuning.
• Disconnect the motor from machine and restart Auto-Tuning. If motor and load cannot be uncoupled make sure the load is lower
The load during Rotational Auto-Tuning was too
than 30%.
high.
• If a mechanical brake is installed, make sure it is fully lifted during tuning.
Digital Operator Display Error Name
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 277
6.6 Auto-Tuning Fault Detection
• Disconnect the motor from machine and restart Auto-Tuning. If motor and load cannot be uncoupled make sure the load is lower
The load during rotational Auto-Tuning was too
than 30%.
high.
• If a mechanical brake is installed, make sure it is fully lifted during tuning.
Digital Operator Display Error Name
278 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.6 Auto-Tuning Fault Detection
Troubleshooting
6
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 279
6.7 Copy Function Related Displays
280 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.7 Copy Function Related Displays
Troubleshooting
Cause Possible Solutions
Failed while attempting to read parameter settings from the Press and hold the READ key on the USB Copy Unit for at least one second to have the unit read parameters from the
drive. drive.
Digital Operator Display Task
rEAd Reading Parameter Settings (flashing)
Cause
Displayed while the parameter settings are being read onto
Possible Solutions
6
Not an error.
the USB Copy Unit.
Digital Operator Display Task
vAEr Voltage Class, Capacity Mismatch
Cause Possible Solutions
The drive the parameters were copied from and the drive
you performing the Verify mode on have different electrical Make sure electrical specifications and capacities are the same for both drives.
specifications or are a different capacity.
Digital Operator Display Task
vFyE Parameter settings in the drive and those saved to the copy function are not the same
Cause Possible Solutions
Indicates that parameter settings that have been Read and To synchronize parameters, either write the parameters saved on the USB Copy Unit or LCD digital operator onto the
loaded onto the Copy Unit or Digital Operator are different. drive, or Read the parameter settings on the drive onto the USB Copy Unit.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 281
6.7 Copy Function Related Displays
282 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
6.8 Diagnosing and Resetting Faults
Troubleshooting
Monitor
U1 -01= 0.00%
3. Press to display the parameter setting screen.
U1-02= 0.00% RSEQ
U1-03= 0.00A LREF
FWD
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 283
6.8 Diagnosing and Resetting Faults
RESET ENTER
RUN STOP
Drive
Close then open the fault signal digital input via terminal S4. Fault Reset Switch
Resetting via Fault Reset Digital Input S4 S4 Fault Reset Digital Input
S4 is set for “Fault Reset” as default (H1-04 = 14).
SC Digital Input Common
2 ON
If the above methods do not reset the fault, turn off the drive main power supply. Reapply power after the digital
operator display is out.
1 OFF
Note: If the Up/Down command is present, the drive will disregard any attempts to reset the fault. Remove the Up/Down command
before attempting to clear a fault situation.
284 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7
Periodic Inspection & Maintenance
This chapter describes the periodic inspection and maintenance of the drive to ensure that it
receives the proper care to maintain overall performance.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 285
7.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Ensuring Safety during Auto-Tuning
When using a PM motor for the first time, or when replacing the drive or PM motor, always make sure that
motor parameter have been set properly and the speed detection function accurately prior to operation. Using a
PM motor requires that the encoder offset be set correctly in addition to entering motor data to
corresponding parameters. If the motor, encoder, or drive is ever replaced, be sure to perform Encoder Offset
Auto-Tuning.
Insufficient torque can cause the elevator car to move in the direction of the load, or cause the motor to behave
erratically (reverse operation, stand still, sudden accelerations, etc.).
For more information, refer to the instruction manual included with the motor.
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not connect or disconnect wiring to the drive or motor while the power is on. Failure to comply will result in
death or serious injury.
Before servicing, disconnect all power to the equipment. The internal capacitor remains charged even after the power
supply is turned off. The charge indicator LED will extinguish when the DC bus voltage is below 50 Vdc. To prevent
electric shock, wait at least five minutes after all indicators are OFF and measure the DC bus voltage level to confirm
safe level.
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may show drives without covers or safety shields to show details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
Do not attempt to modify or alter the drive in any way not explained in this manual.
Yaskawa is not responsible damage caused by modification of the product made by the user. Failure to comply could
result in death or serious injury from operation of damaged equipment.
The diagrams in this section may show drives without covers or safety shields to show details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
Improper equipment grounding could result in death or serious injury by contacting ungrounded electrical
equipment.
Always ground the ground terminal. (200 V Class: Ground to 100 W or less, 400 V Class: Ground to 10 W or less)
motor case.
286 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Verify motor wiring bare wire ends do not contact the drive chassis or enclosure when wiring drive terminals U/
T1, V/T2, W/T3.
Failure to comply may result in serious injury or death due to electrical shock.
Do not perform work on the drive while wearing loose clothing, jewelry or without eye protection.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Remove all metal objects such as watches and rings, secure loose clothing, and wear eye protection before beginning
work on the drive.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use the equipment.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Maintenance, inspection, and replacement of parts must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar with
installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives.
Before servicing, disconnect all power to the equipment and lock out the power source.
Failure to comply may result in injury from electrical shock. Wait at least five minutes after all indicators are OFF and
measure the DC bus voltage level and main circuit terminals to confirm the circuit is safe before wiring.
Fire Hazard
Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque.
Loose electrical connections could result in death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical connections.
Do not use an improper voltage source.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire.
Verify that the rated voltage of the drive matches the voltage of the incoming power supply before applying power.
Do not use improper combustible materials in drive installation, repair or maintenance.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire. Attach the drive or braking resistors to metal or other
noncombustible material.
Maintenance
Burn Hazard
Do not touch a hot drive heatsink. Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury.
Shut off the power to the drive when replacing the cooling fan. To prevent burns, wait at least 15 minutes and make sure 7
heatsink has cooled down.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 287
7.1 Section Safety
NOTICE
Equipment Hazard
Never connect or disconnect the motor from the drive while the drive is outputting voltage. Improper
sequencing of output motor circuits could result in damage to the drive.
Do not connect electromagnetic switches or magnetic contactors to the output motor circuits without proper
sequencing. Do not open the main circuit between the drive and the motor while the PM motor is rotating.
Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive and circuit boards.
Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Do not connect or disconnect the motor from the drive while the drive is outputting voltage.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in damage to the drive.
Follow cooling fan replacement instructions. The cooling fan cannot operate properly when it is installed
incorrectly and could seriously damage the drive.
Follow the instructions in this manual to replace the cooling fan, making sure that the label is on top before inserting
the cooling fan into the drive. To ensure maximum useful product life, replace both cooling fans when performing
maintenance.
Do not connect the AC power line to the output motor terminals of the drive.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line voltage
application to output terminals. could result in death or serious injury by fire as a result of drive damage from line
voltage application to output terminals.
Do not use unshielded cable for control wiring.
Failure to comply may cause electrical interference resulting in poor system performance. Use shielded, twisted-pair
wires and ground the shield to the ground terminal of the drive.
Do not modify the drive circuitry.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive and will void warranty.
Yaskawa is not responsible for any modification of the product made by the user. This product must not be modified.
Check all the wiring to ensure that all connections are correct after installing the drive and connecting any other
devices.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive.
Make sure wiring to motor terminals U, V, and W connect the corresponding U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3 output
terminals on the drive.
Wiring to the wrong terminals will reverse the phase order, causing the motor to operate in reverse. This could cause
the elevator car to fall when attempting to go up.
Never use a magnet contactor on the input side of the drive.
Refrain from switching an input contactor more often than once every 30 minutes. Normally the drive I/O should be
used to stop and start the motor.
Do not operate damaged equipment.
Failure to comply could result in further damage to the equipment.
Do not connect or operate any equipment with visible damage or missing parts.
288 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.2 Inspection
7.2 Inspection
Power electronics have limited life and may exhibit changes in characteristics or performance deterioration after years of
use under normal conditions. To help avoid such problems, it is important to perform preventive maintenance and
periodic inspection on the drive.
Drives contain a variety of power electronics such as power transistors, semiconductors, capacitors, resistors, fans, and
relays. The electronics in the drive serve a critical role in maintaining proper motor control.
Follow the inspection lists provided in this chapter as a part of a regular maintenance program.
Note: The drive will require more frequent inspection if it is placed in harsh environments, such as:
• High ambient temperatures
• Frequent starting and stopping
• Fluctuations in the AC supply or load
• Excessive vibrations or shock loading
• Dust, metal dust, salt, sulfuric acid, chlorine atmospheres
• Poor storage conditions.
Perform the first equipment inspection one to two years after installation.
Maintenance
• Correct the voltage or power supply to within nameplate
Power Supply Voltage Check main power supply and control voltages. specifications.
• Verify all main circuit phases.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 289
7.2 Inspection
290 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.3 Periodic Maintenance
◆ Replacement Parts
Table 7.3 contains the estimated performance life of components that require replacement during the life of the drive.
Only use Yaskawa replacement parts for the appropriate drive model and revision.
Table 7.3 Estimated Performance Life
Component Estimated Performance Life
Cooling Fan, Circulation Fan 10 years
Electrolytic Capacitors 10 years <1>
<1> The drive has few serviceable parts and may require complete drive replacement.
NOTICE: Estimated performance life based on specific usage conditions. These conditions are provided for the purpose of replacing
parts to maintain performance. Some parts may require more frequent replacement due to poor environments or rigorous use. Usage
conditions for estimated performance life:
Ambient temperature: Yearly average of 40 °C(IP00 enclosure)
Load factor: 80% maximum
Operation time: 24 hours a day
Maintenance
Cooling Fan, Circulation Fan, reaches 99999.
Control Board Cooling Fan
U4-04 Displays the acumulated fan operation time as a percentage of the specified maintenance period.
U4-05 DC Bus Capacitors Displays the acumulated time the capacitors are used as a percentage of the specified maintenance period.
U4-06 Inrush (pre-charge) Relay Displays the number of times the drive is powered up as a percentage of the performance life of the inrush circuit.
U4-07 IGBT Displays the percentage of the maintenance period reached by the IGBTs.
7
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 291
7.3 Periodic Maintenance
<1> LT-1 The cooling fans have reached 90% of their designated lifetime. Replace the cooling fan.
The DC bus capacitors have reached 90% of their designated
<1> LT-2 Replace the drive.
lifetime.
The DC bus charge circuit has reached 90% of its designated
<1> LT-3 Replace the drive.
lifetime.
<1> LT-4 The IGBTs have reached 50% of their designated lifetime. Check the load, carrier frequency, and output frequency.
<2> TrPC The IGBTs have reached 90% of their designated lifetime. Replace the drive.
<1> This alarm message will be output only if the Maintenance Monitor function is assigned to one of the digital outputs (H2- = 2F). The alarm
will also trigger a digital output that is programmed for alarm indication (H2- = 10).
<2> This alarm message will always be output, even if the Maintenance Monitor function is not assigned to any of the digital outputs (H2- =
2F). The alarm will also trigger a digital output that is programmed for alarm indication (H2- = 10).
292 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
Contact your Yaskawa representative or the nearest Yaskawa sales office to order replacement cooling fans as required.
For drives with multiple cooling fans, replace all the fans when performing maintenance to ensure maximum product
performance life.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 293
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
CAUTION! Burn Hazard. Do not touch a hot drive heatsink. Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury. Shut off the
power to the drive when replacing the cooling fan. To prevent burns, wait at least 15 minutes and ensure the heatsink has cooled down.
NOTICE: Follow cooling fan and circulation fan replacement instructions. Improper fan replacement may cause damage to equipment.
When installing the replacement fan into the drive, make sure the fan is facing upwards. Replace all fans when performing maintenance
to help ensure maximum useful product life.
Figure 7.1
D A
D B
C
D
YEA_T
Monly
E
F
294 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
CAUTION! Burn Hazard. Do not touch a hot drive heatsink. Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury. Shut off the
power to the drive when replacing the cooling fan. To prevent burns, wait at least 15 minutes and ensure the heatsink has cooled down.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Follow cooling fan replacement instructions. The cooling fan cannot operate properly when it is installed
incorrectly and could seriously damage the drive. Follow the instructions in this manual to replace the cooling fan, making sure that the
label is on top before inserting the cooling fan into the drive. To ensure maximum useful product life, replace both cooling fans when
performing maintenance.
YEA_
TMon
ly
Figure 7.2 Removing the Fan Cover: 2A0018 to 2A0075, 4A0009 to 4A0039
2. Remove the cooling fan cartridge. Disconnect the pluggable connector and remove the fan.
Figure 7.3
Maintenance
7
Figure 7.3 Removing the Cooling Fan: 2A0018 to 2A0075, 4A0009 to 4A0039
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 295
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
YEA_
TMon
ly
A
A
YEA_
TMon
ly
A – Back B – Front
Figure 7.5 Cooling Fan Power Supply Connectors: 2A0018 to 2A0075, 4A0009 to 4A0039
3. While pressing in on the hooks on the left and right sides of the fan finger guard, guide the fan finger guard until it
clicks back into place.
Figure 7.6
YEA_TMo
nly
Figure 7.6 Reattach the Fan Cover: 2A0018 to 2A0075, 4A0009 to 4A0039
4. Turn the power supply back on and reset the cooling fan operation time for the Maintenance Monitor by setting
o4-03 to 0.
296 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
CAUTION! Burn Hazard. Do not touch a hot drive heatsink. Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury. Shut off the
power to the drive when replacing the cooling fan. To prevent burns, wait at least 15 minutes and ensure the heatsink has cooled down.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Follow cooling fan replacement instructions. The cooling fan cannot operate properly when it is installed
incorrectly and could seriously damage the drive. Follow the instructions in this manual to replace the cooling fan, making sure that the
label is on top before inserting the cooling fan into the drive. To ensure maximum useful product life, replace both cooling fans when
performing maintenance.
YEA_
TMonly
Figure 7.7 Removing the Cooling Fan Cover: 2A0085, 2A0115, 4A0045, and 4A0060
2. Lift out the back end of the fan finger guard first. Unplug the replay connector and free the fan finger guard from
the drive.
Figure 7.8
YEA_TMonly
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 297
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
YEA_TMonly A
A – Back B – Front
Figure 7.9 Cooling Fan Power Supply Connectors: 2A0085, 2A0115, 4A0045, and 4A0060
3. Install the replacement fan into the drive.
Figure 7.10
Insertion area
Front of drive
Figure 7.11 Reattach the Fan Cover: 2A0085, 2A0115, 4A0045, and 4A0060
298 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
5. While pressing in on the hooks located on the left and right sides of the fan cover, free the fan cover by lifting the
back end first.
Figure 7.12
YEA_
TMonly
Figure 7.12 Reattach the Fan Cover: 2A0085, 2A0115, 4A0045, 4A0060
6. Turn the power supply back on and reset the cooling fan operation time for the Maintenance Monitor by setting
o4-03 to 0.
CAUTION! Burn Hazard. Do not touch a hot drive heatsink. Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury. Shut off the
power to the drive when replacing the cooling fan. To prevent burns, wait at least 15 minutes and ensure the heatsink has cooled down.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Follow cooling fan replacement instructions. The cooling fan cannot operate properly when it is installed
incorrectly and could seriously damage the drive. Follow the instructions in this manual to replace the cooling fan, making sure that the
label is on top before inserting the cooling fan into the drive. To ensure maximum useful product life, replace both cooling fans when
performing maintenance.
YEA_
TMonly
Maintenance
2. Lift up directly on the cooling fan as shown in Figure 7.14. Unplug the relay connector and release the fan from
the drive.
Figure 7.14
YEA_
TMonly
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 299
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
YEA_TM
only
YEA_TMonly A
A – Back B – Front
Figure 7.16 Cooling Fan Power Supply Connectors: 4A0075, 4A0091
3. Angle the fan cover as shown in Figure 7.15 and insert the connector tabs into the corresponding holes on the
drive.
Figure 7.17
YEA_
TMonly
Hook Hook
Front of Drive
Figure 7.17 Reattach the Fan Cover: 4A0075, 4A0091
300 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
4. While pressing in on the hooks of the left and right sides of the fan cover, guide the fan finger guard until it clicks
back into place.
Figure 7.18
YEA_
TMonly
CAUTION! Burn Hazard. Do not touch a hot drive heatsink. Failure to comply could result in minor or moderate injury. Shut off the
power to the drive when replacing the cooling fan. To prevent burns, wait at least 15 minutes and ensure the heatsink has cooled down.
NOTICE: Equipment Hazard. Follow cooling fan replacement instructions. The cooling fan cannot operate properly when it is installed
incorrectly and could seriously damage the drive. Follow the instructions in this manual to replace the cooling fan, making sure that the
label is on top before inserting the cooling fan into the drive. To ensure maximum useful product life, replace both cooling fans when
performing maintenance.
B
B D
C E
Maintenance
B
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 301
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
3. Remove the screws holding the fan unit in place and slide the fan unit out of the drive.
Figure 7.20
Common
TMonly
Figure 7.20 Removing the Fan Unit: 2A0145 to 2A0415, and 4A0112 to 4A0260
4. Remove the fan guard and replace the cooling fans.
Note: Do not pinch the fan cable between parts when reassembling the fan unit.
Figure 7.21
A A
2A0145 to 2A0180
4A0112 to 4A0150
A B B
C C
YEA_
D
TMonly
302 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
2. Place the fan connector covered by the tube as shown in Figure 7.22.
Figure 7.22
Fan B1 Fan B2
COMMON
TMonly
Figure 7.22 Cooling Fan Wiring for Models 2A0145, 2A0180, 4A0112 and 4A0150
3. Make sure that the protective tube does not stick out beyond the fan guard.
4. Double-check the relay connector to ensure that it is properly connected.
■ Cooling Fan Wiring: 2A0215, 2A0283, and 4A0180
1. Position the protective tube so that the fan connector sits in the center of the protective tube.
Protective tube
COMMON
TMonly
2. Insert the connector for fan B2 and guide the lead wire for fan B2 so the cable hook holds it in place. Insert the
connector for fan B1.
Figure 7.23
Cable hook
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 303
7.4 Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans
Fan B3
Fan B1 Fan B2
Figure 7.24 Cooling Fan Wiring: 2A0346, 2A0415, 4A0216, and 4A0260
4. Double-check the relay connector to ensure that it is properly connected.
5. Reattach the cable cover to its original position and tighten the screws so that the fan guard holds the cable cover
in place.
Note: Do not pinch the fan cable between parts when reassembling the fan unit.
common_
TMonly
Figure 7.25 Installing the Cooling Fan Unit: 2A0145 to 2A0415, 4A0216, and 4A0260
2. Reattach the covers and digital operator.
3. Turn the power supply back on and reset the cooling fan operation time for the Maintenance Monitor by setting
o4-03 to 0.
304 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.5 Drive Replacement
◆ Terminal Board
CAUTION! Crush Hazard. Carrying the drive by the front cover may cause the main body of the drive to fall, resulting in minor or
moderate injury. Always hold the case when carrying the drive.
NOTICE: Correctly set parameter o2-04 when replacing the control terminal board. Failure to comply may result in drive damage due to
lack of protective functions and poor drive performance.
The drive has a modular I/O terminal block that facilitates quick drive replacement. The terminal board contains on-board
memory that stores all drive parameter settings and allows the parameters to be saved and transferred to the replacement
drive. To transfer the terminal board, disconnect the terminal board from the damaged drive then reconnect it to the
replacement drive. Once transferred, there is no need to manually reprogram the replacement drive.
Note: If the damaged drive and the new replacement drive are have different capacities, the data stored in the control terminal board
cannot be transferred to the new drive and an oPE01 error will appear on the display. The control terminal board can still be used,
but parameter setting from the old drive cannot be transferred. The replacement drive must be initialized and manually
programmed.
Figure 7.26
YEA_comm
on
Maintenance
B
C D 7
A – Removable terminal board D – Bottom cover screws
B – Charge LED E – Control terminal board locking screws
C – Bottom cover
Figure 7.26 Terminal Board
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 305
7.5 Drive Replacement
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not allow unqualified personnel to perform work on the drive. Failure to comply could result in
serious injury. Installation, maintenance, inspection and servicing must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar with
installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive and circuit boards.
Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
The following procedure explains how to replace a drive. This section provides instructions for drive replacement only.
To install option cards or other types of options, refer to the specific manuals for those options.
NOTICE: When transferring a braking transistor, braking resistor, or other type of option from a damaged drive to a new replacement
drive, make sure they are working properly before reconnecting them to the new drive. Replace broken options to prevent immediate
break down of the replacement drive.
1. Remove the terminal cover. Refer to Terminal Cover on page 57 for details.
Note: The shape of the terminal covers and the numbers of the screws differ depending on the drive models. Refer to Component
Names on page 31 for details.
Figure 7.27
YEA_
comm
on
YEA_com
mon
306 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
7.5 Drive Replacement
3. Slide the terminal board as illustrated by the arrows to remove it from the drive along with the bottom cover.
Figure 7.29
YEA_
comm
on
YEA_c
ommon
YEA_
Maintenance
Figure 7.31 Drive Replacement: Installing the Control Terminal Board
7
2. Reconnect all options to the new drive in the same way they were installed in the old drive. Connect option
boards to the same option ports in the new drive that were used in the old drive.
3. Put the terminal cover back into its original place.
4. After powering on the drive, all parameter settings are transferred from the terminal board to the drive memory. If
an oPE04 error occurs, load the parameter settings saved on the terminal board to the new drive by setting
parameter A1-03 to 5550. Reset the Maintenance Monitor function timers by setting parameters o4-01 through
o4-12 to 0, and parameter o4-13 to 1.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 307
7.5 Drive Replacement
308 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8
Peripheral Devices & Options
This chapter explains the installation of peripheral devices and options available for the drive.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 309
8.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may show drives without covers or safety shields to show details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
Do not change wiring, remove covers, connectors or options cards, or attempt to service the drive with power
applied to the drive.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all power to the drive and check for unsafe
voltages before servicing.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use the equipment.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Maintenance, inspection, and replacement of parts must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar with
installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives.
Do not perform work on the drive while wearing loose clothing, jewelry or without eye protection.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Remove all metal objects such as watches and rings, secure loose clothing and wear eye protection before beginning
work on the drive.
Improper equipment grounding could result in death or serious injury by contacting the motor case.
Always properly ground the motor-side grounding terminal.
Fire Hazard
Always use braking resistors that are equipped with a thermal overload relay contact, and utilize this contact to
switch off the drive in case of braking resistor overheat.
When connecting the braking resistors to the drive internal braking transistor, make sure the braking transistor will not
be overloaded with the required duty cycle and the selected resistance value. Failure to comply could result in death or
serious injury by fire from overheating resistors.
Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque.
Loose electrical connections could result in death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical connections.
310 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Applications using a braking option should wire a thermal relay so that the output contactor opens when the
thermal relay trips.
Inadequate braking circuit protection could result in death or serious injury by fire from overheating resistors.
Confirm an actual motor overload condition is not present prior to increasing the thermal oL trip detection
setting.
Check local electrical codes before making adjustments to motor thermal overload settings.
Sudden Movement Hazard
Install a properly controlled contactor on the input-side of the drive for applications where power should be
removed from the drive during a fault condition.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in death or serious injury.
NOTICE
Equipment Hazard
Never connect or disconnect the motor from the drive while the drive is outputting voltage.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in damage to the drive.
Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive and circuit boards.
Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Do not connect or disconnect the motor from the drive while the drive is outputting voltage.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in damage to the drive.
Insulate shields with heat shrink tubing or tape to prevent contact with other signal lines and equipment.
Improper wiring practices could result in drive or equipment malfunction due to short circuit.
Use a class 2 power supply (UL standard) when connecting to the control terminals.
Improper application of peripheral devices could result in drive performance degradation due to improper power
supply.
Do not carelessly connect parts or devices to the drives braking transistor terminals.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 311
8.1 Section Safety
NOTICE
Improper application of peripheral devices could result in malfunction of drive due to electrical interference.
Follow manufacturer recommendations when installing electrical devices near the drive and take precautions to shield
the drive from electrical interference.
Properly integrate auxiliary contacts into the control logic circuit to avoid unnecessary fault displays caused by
contactors or output switches placed between drive and motor.
Improper installation of input and output contactors could result in damage to the drive.
312 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.2 Drive Options and Peripheral Devices
Options
Output Noise Filter LF-310 Series Reduces electromagnetic noise generated by the drive output.
— Isolator DGP Isolates the drive control I/Os for improved noise resistance.
Reference Setting / Monitor Options 8
External meter for displaying the output speed or current using
— Frequency Meter / Ammeter DCF-6A
an analog signal from the drive
Frequency Meter Potentiometer (20 External potentiometer for adjusting the frequency meter
— RH000850
kΩ) scaling
External meter for displaying the output voltage using an
— Output Voltage Meter SDF-12NH
analog signal from the drive
Frequency Setting Potentiometer (2 External potentiometer for setting the speed reference by an
— RH000739
kΩ) analog input
Control Dial for Frequency Setting
— CM-3S Control dial for frequency setting potentiometer
Potentiometer
— Meter Plate NPJT41561-1 Plate with scale for frequency setting potentiometer
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 313
8.2 Drive Options and Peripheral Devices
ERR
COM
JVOP-181
LOCK
py rify ad
Attachment
Others
314 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.3 Connecting Peripheral Devices
YASKAWA
USB Copy Unit
ERR
Supply
COM
JVOP-181
LOCK
USB Cable
py rify ad
Co Ve Re
Magnetic
Contactor
(MC)
+2
+1
DC Link
Choke
AC Reactor Thermal Relay
Zero-phase
Reactor
Fuse
Ground
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 315
8.4 Option Card Installation
<1> Option card DI-A3 cannot set the frequency reference when installed to ports CN5-B or CN5-C. It is still possible, however, to view the input
status using U1-17.
<2> Use connector CN5-C when connecting one encoder option card. Use connectors CN5-B and CN5-C when connecting two encoder option
cards.
◆ Installation Procedure
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not allow unqualified personnel to perform work on the drive. Failure to comply could result in
death or serious injury. Maintenance, inspection, and replacement of parts must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar
with installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives and Option Cards.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the option card, drive, and
circuit boards. Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to circuitry.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque. Failure to comply may cause the
application to operate incorrectly or damage the drive.
Use the procedure described below when installing option cards to the drive.
1. Shut off power to the drive, wait the appropriate amount of time for voltage to dissipate, then remove the operator
and front cover. Refer to Digital Operator and Front Cover on page 59
2. Insert the CN5 connector on the option card into the matching CN5 connector on the drive, then fasten it into
place using one of the screws included with the option card.
Figure 8.2
B F
G
C
J
D
K
L
H
I
YEA_TMonly
A – Connector CN5-C G – Mounting screw
B – Connector CN5-B H – Lead line
C – Connector CN5-A I – Use wire cutters to create an opening
for cable lines
D – Drive grounding terminal (FE) J – Front cover
E – Insert connector CN5 here K – Digital operator
F – Option card L – Terminal cover
Figure 8.2 Installing an Option Card
316 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.4 Option Card Installation
3. Connect one of the lead lines to the ground terminal using one of the screws.
Some option cards come with several different lead lines for connecting the card to the drive. Select the lead line
with the most appropriate length.
There are only two screw holes on the drive for ground terminals. If three option cards are connected, two of the
lead lines will need to share the same ground terminal.
Figure 8.3
common_
TMonly
A
B
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 317
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
Note: The braking circuit must be sized properly in order to dissipate the regenerative energy from the elevator system. The drive is
likely to trip with DC bus overvoltage if the resistor value is too large. Connecting a too small braking resistor can damage the
drive or braking transistor. Consult with you sales representative for proper braking option selection.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. The braking resistor connection terminals are B1 and B2. Do not connect a braking resistor directly to any
other terminals. Improper wiring connections could result in death or serious injury by fire. Failure to comply may result in damage to
the braking circuit or drive.
NOTICE: Connect braking circuits to the drive as shown in the I/O wiring examples. Improperly wiring braking circuits could result in
damage to the drive or equipment.
Always use braking resistors equipped with a thermal overload relay contact, and utilize this contact to switch off the
drive in case of braking resistor overheat. When connecting the braking resistors to the drive internal braking transistor,
make sure the braking transistor will not be overloaded with the required duty cycle and the selected resistance value.
Figure 8.5
Circuit Breaker
MC
R R/L1
S S/L2
T T/L3
400/200V
MC
THRX
1 2
SA
Braking Resistor Unit
(Close: Overheat)
YEA_TMonly
Figure 8.5 Power Supply Interrupt for Overheat Protection (Example)
318 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
L4A0075 to 4A0260) to the positive terminal on the braking unit. Then, wire the negative terminals on the drive and
braking unit together. Terminal +2 is not used.
Connect the braking resistor to CDBR terminals +0 and -0.
Wire the thermal overload relay contact of the CDBR and the braking resistor in series, and connect this signal to a drive
digital input. Use this input to trigger a fault in the drive in case a CDBR or braking resistor overload occurs.
Figure 8.6
+3 + +0 P 1
Thermal Overload
Drive Trip Contact
− − −0 B 2
3 4
YEA_
Thermal
TMonly
Trip Contact
Figure 8.6 Connecting a Braking Unit (CDBR type) and Braking Resistor Unit
(CIMR-L2A0145 to 2A0415 and L4A0075 to 4A0260)
+3 −
Braking Braking Braking
Resistor Resistor Resistor
− + +0 −0 − + +0 −0 − + +0 −0
MASTER
Drive
SLAVE
+15 SLAVE SLAVE
1 5 1 5 1 5
Options
6 2 6 2 6
2
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 319
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
A MCCB MC
R/L1
S/L2
T/L3 Common_
MC
MB TMonly
C MC
MC
Residual currents occurring in drive installations can contain AC, DC, and high frequency components that may prevent a
normal GFCI from operating as desired. If a GFCI is required in the installation, always use an all-current-sensitive
device (Type B according to IEC 60755) to ensure proper ground fault interruption.
Leakage currents generated by the drive during normal operation may trip a GFCI even if a ground fault is not present.
Factors that influence the leakage current are:
• Size of the AC drive
• AC drive carrier frequency
• Motor cable type and length
• EMI/RFI filter
If the GFCI trips spuriously consider changing these items or use a GFCI with a higher trip level.
Note: Choose a GFCI designed specifically for an AC drive. The operation time should be at least 0.1 s with sensitivity amperage of at
least 200 mA per drive. The output waveform of the drive may cause an increase in leakage current. This may in turn cause the
leakage breaker to malfunction. Increase the sensitivity amperage or lower the carrier frequency to correct the problem.
320 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
NOTICE: Install an MC on the input side of the drive when the drive should not automatically restart after power loss. To get the full
performance life out of the electrolytic capacitors and circuit relays, refrain from switching the drive power supply off and on more than
once every 30 minutes. Frequent use can damage the drive. Use the drive to stop and start the motor.
NOTICE: Use a magnetic contactor (MC) to ensure that power to the drive can be completely shut off when necessary. The MC should
be wired so that it opens when a fault output terminal is triggered.
Note: 1. Install an MC to the drive input side to prevent the drive from restarting automatically when power is restored after momentary power
loss.
2. Set up a delay that prevents the MC from opening prematurely to continue operating the drive through a momentary power loss.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Confirm an actual motor overload condition is not present prior to increasing the thermal oL trip detection
setting. Check local electrical codes before making adjustments to motor thermal overload settings. Failure to comply can result in
death or serious injury by fire.
4000
C D
A B
U X R/L1
8
V
W
Y
Z
S/L2
T/L3
Common_
TMonly
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 321
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
C
A B
R/L1
S/L2
T/L3
+1 +2
Common_
TMonly
D
B C
MCCB
A R U R/L1
S/L2
S V
T/L3
T W
MCCB
YEA_
TMon
ly
D
322 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
B C
A MCCB D
R/L1 U/T1
S/L2 V/T2
1
2
4
5
YEA_
M
T/L3 W/T3 3 6 TMon
ly
B
C
A MCCB D
R/L1 U/T1
S/L2 V/T2 M
T/L3 W/T3
E YEA_
TMon
G
ly
F
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 323
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
A
C D E
B MCCB F G
R/L1 U/T1
S/L2 V/T2 M
YEA_
T/L3 W/T3
TMon
ly
◆ Fuse/Fuse Holder
Yaskawa recommends installing a fuse to the input side of the drive to prevent damage to the drive if a short circuit
occurs.
Select the appropriate fuse from the table below.
Table 8.3 Input Fuses
Fuse Type Fuse Holder Fuse Type
Model
Manufacturer: Fuji Electric Manufacturer: Bussmann
CIMR-L
Model Fuse Ampere Rating Model Quantity Model Fuse Ampere Rating
Three-Phase 200 V Class
2A0018 CR2LS-100 100 CM-1A 1 FWH-90B 90
2A0025 CR2L-125 125 CM-2A 1 FWH-100B 100
2A0033 CR2L-150 150 CM-2A 1 FWH-200B 200
2A0047 CR2L-175 175 CM-2A 1 FWH-200B 200
2A0060 CR2L-225 225 – – FWH-200B 200
2A0075 CR2L-260 260 – – FWH-300A 300
2A0085 CR2L-300 300 – – FWH-300A 300
2A0115 CR2L-350 350 – – FWH-350A 350
2A0145 CR2L-400 400 – – FWH-400A 400
2A0180 CR2L-450 450 – – FWH-400A 400
2A0215 CR2L-600 600 – – FWH-600A 600
2A0283 CR2L-600 600 – – FWH-700A 700
2A0346 CR2L-600 600 – – FWH-800A 800
2A0415 CS5F-800 800 – – FWH-1000A 1000
Three-Phase 400 V Class
4A0009 CR6L-50 50 CMS-4 3 FWH-90B 90
4A0015 CR6L-75 75 CMS-5 3 FWH-80B 80
4A0018 CR6L-75 75 CMS-5 3 FWH-100B 100
4A0024 CR6L-100 100 CMS-5 3 FWH-125B 125
4A0031 CR6L-150 150 CMS-5 3 FWH-200B 200
4A0039 CR6L-150 150 CMS-5 3 FWH-250A 250
4A0045 CR6L-200 200 – – FWH-250A 250
4A0060 CR6L-250 250 – – FWH-250A 250
4A0075 CR6L-250 250 – – FWH-250A 250
4A0091 CR6L-300 300 – – FWH-250A 250
4A0112 CR6L-350 350 – – FWH-350A 350
324 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 325
8.5 Installing Peripheral Devices
326 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Appendix: A
Specifications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 327
A.1 Three-Phase 200 V Class Drives
<1> The motor capacity (HP) refers to a NEC rated 4-pole motor. The rated output current of the drive output amps should be equal to or greater
than the motor current. Select the appropriate capacity drive if operating the motor continuously above motor nameplate current.
<2> Assumes operation at the rated output current. Input current rating varies depending on the power supply transformer, input reactor, wiring
connections, and power supply impedance.
<3> Rated motor capacity is calculated with a rated output voltage of 220 V.
<4> Carrier frequency can be set up to 8 kHz while keeping this current rating. Higher carrier frequency settings require derating.
<5> Carrier frequency can be set up to 5 kHz while keeping this current rating. Higher carrier frequency settings require derating.
<6> Carrier frequency is set to 2 kHz. Higher carrier frequency settings require derating
328 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
A.2 Three-Phase 400 V Class Drives
Specifications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 329
A.3 Drive Specifications
Item Specification
The following control methods can be set using drive parameters:
• V/f Control (V/f)
Control Method • Open Loop Vector Control (OLV)
• Closed Loop Vector Control (CLV)
• Closed Loop Vector Control for PM (CLV/PM)
Frequency Control Range 0.01 to 120 Hz
Frequency Accuracy Digital input: within ±0.01% of the max output speed (-10 to +40 °C)
(Temperature Fluctuation) Analog input: within ±0.1% of the max output speed (25°C ±10 °C)
Digital inputs: 0.01 Hz
Frequency Setting Resolution
Analog inputs: 1/2048 of the maximum output speed setting (11 bit plus sign)
Output Speed Resolution 0.001 Hz
Frequency Setting Signal -10 to 10 V, 0 to 10 V
V/f: 150% at 3 Hz
Starting Torque <1> OLV: 200% at 0.3 Hz
CLV, CLV/PM: 200% at 0 r/min
Control V/f: 1:40
Characteristics Speed Control Range <1> OLV: 1:200
CLV: 1:1500
Speed Control Accuracy <1> OLV: ±0.2% (25°C ±10 °C), CLV: ±0.02% (25°C ±10 °C)
OLV: 10 Hz
Speed Response <1>
CLV, CLV/PM: 50 Hz
Torque Limit Parameters setting allow separate limits in four quadrants (available in OLV, CLV, CLV/PM)
0.0 to 6000.0 s (4 selectable combinations of independent acceleration and deceleration settings, unit changeable to m/s2 or
Accel/Decel Ramp
ft/s2)
Braking Transistor Models CIMR-L2A0018 to 2A0115, 4A0009 to 4A0060 have a built-in braking transistor.
V/f Characteristics Freely programmable
Inertia Compensation, Position Lock at Start and Stop/Anti-Rollback Function, Overtorque/Undertorque Detection, Torque
Limit, Speed Reference, Accel/decel Switch, 5 Zone Jerk Settings, Auto-Tuning (Stationary and Rotational Motor/Encoder
Offset Tuning), Dwell, Cooling Fan on/off Switch, Slip Compensation, Torque Compensation, DC Injection Braking at Start and
Main Control Functions
Stop, MEMOBUS/Modbus Comm. (RS-422/485 max, 115.2 kbps), Fault Reset, Removable Terminal Block with Parameter
Backup Function, Online Tuning, High Frequency Injection, Short Floor, Rescue Operation(Light Load Direction Search
Function), Inspection Run, Brake Sequence, Speed related parameters with elevator units display, etc.
Motor Protection Electronic thermal overload relay
Momentary Overcurrent Protection Drive stops when output current exceeds 200% of rated output current
Overload Protection Drive stops after 60 s at 150% of rated output current <2>
200 V class: Stops when DC bus voltage exceeds approx. 410 V
Overvoltage Protection
400 V class: Stops when DC bus voltage exceeds approx. 820 V
Protection
200 V class: Stops when DC bus voltage falls below approx. 190 V
Functions Undervoltage Protection
400 V class: Stops when DC bus voltage falls below approx. 380 V
Heatsink Overheat Protection Thermistor
Stall Prevention Stall Prevention is available during acceleration, and during run.
Ground Protection Electronic circuit protection <3>
DC Bus Charge LED Remains lit until DC bus voltage falls below 50 V
Area of Use Indoors
Ambient Temperature -10 to 40 °C (IP00 enclosure with top protective cover), -10 to 50 °C (IP00 enclosure)
Humidity 95 RH% or less (no condensation)
Environment Storage Temperature -20 to 60 °C (short-term temperature during transportation)
Altitude Up to 1000 meters without derating, up to 3000m with output current and voltage derating
10 to 20 Hz: 9.8 m/s2
Vibration / Shock
20 to 55 Hz: 5.9 m/s2 (2A0018 to 2A0180, 4A0009 to 4A0150) or 2.0 m/s2 (2A0215 to 2A0415, 4A0180 to 4A0260)
Two Safe Disable inputs and 1 EDM output according to ISO13849-1 Cat.3 PLd, IEC61508 SIL2.
Safety Standard <4>
Note: Time from input open to drive output stop is less than 1 ms
Protection Design IP00 enclosure with top protective cover, IP00
<1> The accuracy of these values depends on motor characteristics, ambient conditions, and drive settings. Specifications may vary with different
motors and with changing motor temperature. Contact Yaskawa for consultation.
<2> Overload protection may be triggered when operating with 150% of the rated output current if the output speed is less than 6 Hz.
<3> Ground protection cannot be provided when the impedance of the ground fault path is too low, or when the drive is powered up while a ground
fault is present at the output.
<4> Model CIMR-L4A0260 is not compliant with Safety Standard. For more information, contact your nearest Yaskawa representative or our
sales office.
330 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
A.4 Drive Watt Loss Data
Specifications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 331
A.5 Drive Derating Data
2A0018 to 2A0060
Common_
TMonly
0 8 kHz 15 kHz
2A0145 to 2A0415
Drive Rated
YEA_
0 5 kHz 10 kHz TMonly
Figure A.2 Carrier Frequency Derating (CIMR-L2A0145 to 2A0415)
Figure A.3
Common_
TMonly
0 8 kHz 15 kHz
332 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
A.5 Drive Derating Data
Figure A.4
4A0112 to 4A0260
Drive Rated
YEA_
TMonly
0 5 kHz 10 kHz
Figure A.4 Carrier Frequency Derating (CIMR-L4A0112 to 4A0260)
◆ Temperature Derating
To ensure the maximum performance life, the drive output current must be derated as shown in Figure A.5 when the drive
is installed in areas with high ambient temperature or if drives are mounted side-by-side in a cabinet. In order to ensure
reliable drive overload protection, set parameters L8-12 and L8-35 according to the installation conditions.
■ Parameter Settings
IP00 Enclosure
Drive operation between -10 °C and 50 °C allows 100% continuous current without derating.
IP00 Enclosure with Top Protective Cover
Drive operation between -10 °C and 40 °C allows 100% continuous current without derating. Operation between 40 °C
and 50 °C requires output current derating.
Figure A.5
85
YEA_
0 L8-12
TMonly Specifications
-10 40 50 (Ambient temp : °C)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 333
A.5 Drive Derating Data
334 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Appendix: B
Parameter List
This appendix contains a full listing of all parameters and settings available in the drive.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 335
B.1 Understanding the Parameter Table
V/f Parameter is available when operating the drive with V/f Control.
OLV Parameter is available when operating the drive with Open Loop Vector.
CLV Parameter is available when operating the drive with Closed Loop Vector.
CLV/PM Parameter is available when operating the drive with Closed Loop Vector for PM motors.
Motor 2 Refers to a second motor when the drive is operating two motors. Switch between these motors using the multi-function input terminals.
Note: If a parameter is not available in a certain control mode, the symbol for that control mode is grayed out.
336 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.2 Parameter Groups
Parameter List
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 337
B.3 Parameter Table
A1-00 0: English
(100H) 1: Japanese
Default: 0
2: German
Language Selection Min: 0 142
3: French
Max: 7
4: Italian
<1>
5: Spanish
6: Portuguese
7: Chinese
common_
A1-01 All Modes TMonly Default: 2
(101H)
Access Level Selection 0: View and set A1-01 and A1-04. U- parameters can also be viewed. Min: 0 142
1: User Parameters (access to a set of parameters selected by the user, A2-01 to A2-32) Max: 2
2: Advanced Access (access to view and set all parameters)
common_
All Modes TMonly
A1-02 Default: 2
0: V/f Control
(102H) Control Method Selection Min: 0 142
2: Open Loop Vector Control
<1> Max: 7
3: Closed Loop Vector Control
7: Closed Loop Vector Control for PM Motors
common_
All Modes TMonly
Default: 0
A1-03 0: No initialization
Initialize Parameters Min: 0 143
(103H) 1110: User Initialize (parameter values must be stored using parameter o2-03)
Max: 5550
2220: 2-wire initialization
5550: oPE04 error reset
A1-04 common_
Password
(104H) All Modes TMonly Default: 0000
Min: 0000 144
A1-05 When the value set into A1-04 does not match the value set into A1-05, parameters A1-01
Password Setting Max: 9999
(105H) through A1-03, and A2-01 through A2-33 cannot be changed.
<1> Parameter setting value is not reset to the default value when the drive is initialized.
338 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
◆ b: Application
Application parameters configure the source of the Up/Down command, timer functions, the Dwell function, the Droop
Control function, Energy Savings, and a variety of other application-related settings.
■ b1: Operation Mode Selection
Default: 0.0%
b6-01
Dwell Speed at Start Min: 0.0% 152
(1B6H)
Max: 100.0%
Default: 0.0 s
b6-02
Dwell Time at Start common_ Min: 0.0 s 152
(1B7H) All Modes TMonly Max: 10.0 s
Parameters b6-01 and b6-02 set the speed to hold and the time to maintain that speed at start. Default: 0.0%
b6-03
(1B8H)
Dwell Speed at Stop Parameters b6-03 and b6-04 set the speed to hold and the time to maintain that speed at stop. Min: 0.0%
Max: 100.0%
152 B
Default: 0.0 s
b6-04
Dwell Time at Stop Min: 0.0 s 152
(1B9H)
Max: 10.0 s
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 339
B.3 Parameter Table
◆ C: Tuning
C parameters are used to adjust the acceleration and deceleration ramps, jerk settings, slip compensation, torque
compensation, and carrier frequency selections.
■ C1: Acceleration and Deceleration Ramps
C1-02
common_
(201H) All Modes TMonly
Deceleration Ramp 1 154
Sets the ramp to decelerate from maximum speed to 0.
C1-03
common_
(202H) All Modes TMonly
Acceleration Ramp 2 154
Sets the ramp to accelerate from 0 to maximum speed.
C1-04
common_
(203H) All Modes TMonly
Deceleration Ramp 2 154
Sets the ramp to decelerate from maximum speed to 0.
C1-06
common_
(205H) Deceleration Ramp 3 (Motor 2 All Modes TMonly 154
Decel Time 1)
Sets the ramp to decelerate from maximum speed to 0.
C1-07
common_
(206H) Acceleration Ramp 4 (Motor 2 All Modes TMonly 154
Accel Time 2)
Sets the ramp to accelerate from 0 to maximum speed.
C1-08
common_
(207H) Deceleration Ramp 4 (Motor 2 All Modes TMonly 154
Decel Time 2)
Sets the ramp to decelerate from maximum speed to 0.
common_
C1-09 All Modes TMonly
Fast Stop Ramp 155
(208H)
Sets the ramp for the Fast Stop function.
340 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
C3-02
common_ Default: 2000 ms
(210H) Slip Compensation Primary Delay V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Min: 0 ms 157
Time
Adjusts the slip compensation function delay time. Max: 10000 ms
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 200%
C3-03
Slip Compensation Limit Min: 0% 157
(211H) Sets an upper limit for the slip compensation function as a percentage of motor rated slip for
Max: 250%
motor 1 (E2-02).
Parameter List
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Default: 0
C3-04 Slip Compensation Selection
0: Disabled. Min: 0 158
(212H) during Regeneration
1: Enabled above 6 Hz. Max: 2
2: Enabled whenever slip compensation is possible.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: <5>
C3-05 Output Voltage Limit Operation
Min: 0 158
(213H) Selection 0: Disabled.
1: Enabled. Automatically decreases motor flux when output voltage saturation is reached.
Max: 1 B
<5> Default setting is determined by the control mode (A1-02).
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 341
B.3 Parameter Table
C5-02
common_ Default: <5>
(21CH) Speed Control Loop Integral Time V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Min: 0.000 s 162
1
Sets the integral time 1 of the speed control loop. Max: 10.000 s
C5-03
common_ Default: <5>
(21DH) Speed Control Loop Proportional V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Min: 0.00 162
Gain 2
Sets the proportional gain 2 of the speed control loop. Max: 300.00
C5-04
common_ Default: <5>
(21EH) Speed Control Loop Integral Time V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Min: 0.000 s 162
2
Sets the integral time 2 of the speed control loop. Max: 10.000 s
C5-14
common_ Default: <5>
(273H) Speed Control Loop Integral Time V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Min: 0.000 s 162
3
Sets the integral time 3 of the speed control loop. Max: 10.000 s
342 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
Parameter List
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 343
B.3 Parameter Table
◆ d: Speed References
Speed Reference parameters are used to set the various speed reference values during operation.
■ d1: Speed Reference
d1-02
(281H)
Speed Reference 2 165
d1-03
(282H)
Speed Reference 3 165
d1-04
(283H)
Speed Reference 4 165
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0.00% <6>
Min: 0.00%
d1-05 Sets the Speed reference for the drive when d1-18 is set to 0 or 3. Setting units are determined
Max: 100.00% <6>
(284H) by parameter o1-03.
Speed Reference 5 165
d1-06
(285H)
Speed Reference 6 165
d1-07
(286H)
Speed Reference 7 165
d1-08
(287H)
Speed Reference 8 165
common_
All Modes TMonly
d1-20
common_ Default:
(2C2H) All Modes TMonly
Intermediate Speed 1 0.00% <6>Min: 0.00% 166
Sets intermediate speed reference 1 when d1-18 = 1 or 2. Max: 100.00% <6>
d1-21
common_ Default:
(2C3H) All Modes TMonly
Intermediate Speed 2 0.00% <6>Min: 0.00% 166
Sets intermediate speed reference 2 when d1-18 = 1 or 2. Max: 100.00% <6>
d1-22
common_ Default:
(2C4H) All Modes TMonly
Intermediate Speed 3 0.00% <6>Min: 0.00% 166
Sets intermediate speed reference 3 when d1-18 = 1 or 3. Max: 100.00% <6>
d1-23
common_ Default:
(2C5H) All Modes TMonly
Releveling Speed 0.00% <6>Min: 0.00% 166
Sets speed reference for releveling when d1-18 = 1 or 2. Max: 100.00% <6>
d1-24
common_ Default:
(2C6H) All Modes TMonly
Inspection Operation Speed 50.00% <6>Min: 0.00% 166
Sets speed reference when inspection operation is enabled. Max: 100.00% <6>
d1-25
common_ Default:
(2C7H) All Modes TMonly
Rescue Operation Speed 10.00% <6>Min: 0.00% 166
Sets the speed reference during inspection operation. Max: 100.00% <6>
344 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Default: 0.00 Hz
d1-27 Sets the speed reference for motor 2.
Motor 2 Speed Reference Min: 0.00 Hz 167
(2C9H) Note: 1. If set to 0.00, the drive will control motor 1 instead.
Max: 120.00 Hz
2. When using motor 2, be sure that the accel/decel times are set in parameters C1-12
and C1-13.
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0.00%
d1-28
Leveling Speed Detection Level Min: 0.00% 167
(2CAH) Used when d1-18 = 0 or 3. If the speed reference selected is lower than d1-28, then the drive
Max: 100.00%
uses the leveling speed as the speed reference.
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0.00%
d1-29
Inspection Speed Detection Level Min: d1-28 167
(2CBH) Used when d1-18 = 0 or 3. If the speed reference selected is higher than d1-28 but lower or
Max: 100.00%
equal to d1-29, then the drive uses inspection speed as the speed reference.
<6> Setting ranges and defaults vary by the setting units determined by parameter o1-03.
Refer to Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit Selection (o1-03) on page 382
◆ E: Motor Parameters
■ E1: V/f Pattern
Parameter List
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 345
B.3 Parameter Table
common_
Default:200.0 V <9>
E1-05
Maximum Voltage All Modes TMonly Min: 0.0 V 169
(304H)
To set linear V/f characteristics, set the same values for E1-07 and E1-09. In this case, the Max: 255.0 V <9>
setting for E1-08 will be disregarded. Ensure that the four frequencies are set according to these Default: <5>
E1-06
Base Frequency rules: Min: 0.0 Hz 169
(305H)
E1-09 ≤ E1-07 < E1-06 ≤ Ε1−11 ≤ E1-04 Max: 120.0 Hz
Note that if E1-11 = 0, then both E1-11 and E1-12 are disabled, and the above conditions do not Default: <5>
E1-07 apply.
Middle Output Frequency Min: 0.0 Hz 169
(306H)
Output Voltage (V) Max: 120.0 Hz
E1-05 Default: <2> <9>
E1-08 E1-12
Middle Output Frequency Voltage Min: 0.0 V 169
(307H)
Max: 255.0 V <9>
E1-13
Default: <5>
E1-09
Minimum Output Frequency Min: 0.0 Hz 169
(308H)
Max: 120.0 Hz
E1-08
Default: <2> <9>
E1-10 Minimum Output Frequency
Min: 0.0 V 169
(309H) Voltage E1-10 Max: 255.0 V <9>
E1-11 E1-09 E1-07 E1-06 E1-11 E1-04 Default: 0.0 Hz
(30AH) Middle Output Frequency 2 Frequency (Hz) Min: 0.0 Hz 169
<11> Note: Some parameters may not be available depending on the control mode. Max: 120.0 Hz
E1-12 • E1-07, E1-08 and E-10 are available only in the V/f control and Open Loop Vector control Default: 0.0 V <9>
(30BH) Middle Output Frequency Voltage 2 modes. Min: 0.0 V 169
<11>
• E1-11, E1-12 and E-13 are available only in the V/f control and Closed Loop Vector control Max: 255.0 V <9>
modes.
Default: 0.0 V
E1-13 <9> <13>
Base Voltage 169
(30CH) Min: 0.0 V
Max: 255.0 V <9>
<2> Default setting is dependent on the control mode (A1-02) and the drive model (o2-04).
<5> Default setting is determined by the control mode (A1-02).
<9> Values shown here are for 200 V class drives. The default is 400 V when using a 400 V class drive.
<11> Parameter is ignored when E1-11 and E1-12 are set to 0.0.
<13> Auto-Tuning will set E1-13 to the same value as E1-05.
<33> Setting range depends on the type of motor being used. CLV allows a setting range of 10.0 to 120.0 Hz, while CLV/PM allows a setting range
of 4.0 to 120.0 Hz.
346 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
<9> Values shown here are for 200 V class drives. The default is 400 V when using a 400 V class drive.
common_ Default: 4
E4-04 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Motor 2 Motor Poles Min: 2 174
(324H)
Sets the number of poles of motor 2. Automatically set during Auto-Tuning. Max: 48
common_ Default: <4>
E4-05 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM
Motor 2 Line-to-Line Resistance TMonly
Min: 0.000 Ω 175
(325H)
Sets the phase-to-phase resistance for motor 2. Automatically set during Auto-Tuning. Max: 65.000 Ω
common_
E4-06
Motor 2 Leakage Inductance
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: <4>
Min: 0.0% 175
B
(326H) Sets the voltage drop for motor 2 due to motor leakage inductance as a percentage of rated
Max: 40.0%
voltage. Automatically set during Auto-Tuning.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 347
B.3 Parameter Table
<10> The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L2A0018 to 0033 and CIMR-L4A0009 to 0018
display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L2A0047 to 0415 and CIMR-L4A0024 to 0260 display values in 0.1 A units.
Default: <4>
E5-03 common_ Min: 10% of drive rated
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
(32BH) Motor Rated Current current 175
<1> Sets the motor rated current. Max: 200% of drive
rated current <10>
<1> Parameter setting value is not reset to the default value when the drive is initialized.
<4> Default setting value is determined by the drive model (o2-04).
<10> The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L2A0018 to 2A0033 and CIMR-L4A0009 to
4A0018 display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L2A0047 to 2A0415 and CIMR-L4A0024 to 4A0260 display values in 0.1 A
units.
◆ F: Option Settings
F parameters are used to program the drive for Encoder and PG feedback from the motor and to function with option
cards.
■ F1: PG Speed Control Card
348 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
common_
All Modes TMonly
0: BCD, 1% units
1: BCD, 0.1% units
2: BCD, 0.01% units
Default: 0
F3-01 3: BCD, 1 Hz units
DI-A3 Option Card Input Selection Min: 0 180
(390H) 4: BCD, 0.1 Hz units
Max: 7
5: BCD, 0.01 Hz units
6: BCD customized setting (5 digit), 0.02 Hz units B
7: Binary input
When the digital operator units are set to be displayed in Hertz or user-set units (o1-03 = 2 or 3),
the units for F3-01 are determined by parameter o1-03.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 349
B.3 Parameter Table
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 103
F4-03
Terminal V2 Function Selection Min: 000 180
(393H) Sets the monitor signal for output from terminal V2. Set this parameter to the last three digits of
Max: 999
the desired U- monitor. Some U parameters are available only in certain control modes.
F4-04
common_ Default: 50.0%
(394H) All Modes TMonly
Terminal V2 Gain Min: -999.9% 180
Sets the gain for voltage output via terminal V2. Max: 999.9%
F4-05
common_ Default: 0.0%
(395H) All Modes TMonly
Terminal V1 Bias Min: -999.9% 180
Sets the amount of bias added to the voltage output via terminal V1. Max: 999.9%
F4-06
common_ Default: 0.0%
(396H) All Modes TMonly
Terminal V2 Bias Min: -999.9% 180
Sets the amount of bias added to the voltage output via terminal V2. Max: 999.9%
Default: 1
F4-07 Terminal V1 Signal Level
common_ Min: 0 181
(397H) Selection All Modes TMonly Max: 1
0: 0 to 10 V Default: 1
F4-08 Terminal V2 Signal Level 1: -10 to 10 V Min: 0 181
(398H) Selection
Max: 1
350 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
0: Auto-detection
1: 10 kbps
2: 20 kbps Default: 6
F6-36
CANopen Communication Speed 3: 50 kbps Min: 0 –
(3D1H)
4: 125 kbps Max: 8
5: 250 kbps
6: 500 kbps
7: 800 kbps
8: 1 Mbps
<1> Parameter setting value is not reset to the default value when the drive is initialized.
Parameter List
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 351
B.3 Parameter Table
◆ H: Multi-Function Terminals
H parameters assign functions to the multi-function input and output terminals.
■ H1: Multi-Function Digital Inputs
6 Jog reference selection Closed: Jog frequency reference (d1-17) selected. 184
The Jog frequency can be used when the speed reference selection is not assigned to input terminals (b1-01 ≠ 1)
and the speed reference priority is set to use the multi-step speed reference (d1-18 = 0 or 3).
common_
All Modes TMonly
7 Accel/decel Ramp Selection 1 Used to switch between accel/decel ramp 1 (set in C1-01, C1-02) and accel/decel ramp 2 (set in C1-03, C1-04). 185
When combined with another input terminal set for "Accel/Decel ramp 2" (H1- = 1A), the drive can also
switch between accel/decel ramp 3 (set in C1-05, C1-06) and accel/decel ramp 4 (set in C1-07, C1-08).
common_
All Modes TMonly
8 Baseblock Command (N.O.) 185
Closed: No drive output
common_
All Modes TMonly
9 Baseblock Command (N.C.) 185
Open: No drive output
common_
All Modes TMonly
F Not Used (Through Mode) 185
Select this setting when using the terminal in a pass-through mode. The terminal does not trigger a drive function
but can be used as digital input for the controller the drive is connected to.
common_
All Modes TMonly
14 Fault Reset 185
Closed: Resets faults if the cause is cleared and the Up/Down command is removed.
common_
All Modes TMonly
15 Fast Stop (N.O.) 185
Closed: Decelerates to stop at the Fast Stop ramp set to C1-09.
common_
All Modes TMonly
16 Motor 2 Selection 186
Open: Motor 1(E1-, E3-)
Closed: Motor 2 (E2-, E4-)
common_
All Modes TMonly
17 Fast Stop (N.C.) 185
Open: Decelerates to stop at the Fast Stop ramp set to C1-09.
352 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 353
B.3 Parameter Table
354 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 355
B.3 Parameter Table
H3-04
common_ Default: 0.0%
(412H) All Modes TMonly
Terminal A1 Bias Setting Min: -999.9% 197
Sets the level of the input value selected in H3-02 when 0 V is input at terminal A1. Max: 999.9%
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
H3-09 Terminal A2 Signal Level
Min: 0 198
(417H) Selection 0: 0 to 10 V
Max: 0
1: –10 to 10 V
common_ Default: 0
H3-10 All Modes TMonly
Terminal A2 Function Selection Min: 0 198
(418H)
Sets the function of terminal A2. Max: 1F
H3-11
common_ Default: 100.0%
(419H) All Modes TMonly
Terminal A2 Gain Setting Min: -999.9% 198
Sets the level of the input value selected in H3-10 when 10 V is input at terminal A2. Max: 999.9%
H3-12
common_ Default: 0.0%
(41AH) All Modes TMonly
Terminal A2 Bias Setting Min: -999.9% 198
Sets the level of the input value selected in H3-10 when 0 V is input at terminal A2. Max: 999.9%
356 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
H4-03
common_ Default: 0.0%
(41FH) All Modes TMonly
Terminal FM Bias Min: -999.9% 200
Sets the bias value added to the terminal FM output signal. Max: 999.9%
common_
All Modes TMonly
Default: 103
H4-04
Terminal AM Monitor Selection Selects the data to be output through multi-function analog output terminal AM. Min: 000 200
(420H)
Set the desired monitor parameter to the digits available in U-. For example, enter “103” Max: 999
for U1-03.
H4-05
common_ Default: 50.0%
(421H) All Modes TMonly
Terminal AM Gain Min: -999.9% 200
Sets the signal level at terminal AM that is equal to 100% of the selected monitor value. Max: 999.9%
H4-06
common_ Default: 0.0%
(422H) All Modes TMonly
Terminal AM Bias Min: -999.9% 200
Sets the bias value added to the terminal AM output signal. Max: 999.9%
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
H4-07 Terminal FM Signal Level
Min: 0 201
(423H) Selection 0: 0 to 10 V
Max: 1
1: –10 to 10 V
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
H4-08 Terminal AM Signal Level
Min: 0 201
(424H) Selection 0: 0 to 10 V
Max: 1
1: –10 to 10 V
Parameter List
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 357
B.3 Parameter Table
0: 1200 bps
1: 2400 bps
2: 4800 bps
Default: 3
H5-02 3: 9600 bps
Communication Speed Selection Min: 0 388
(426H) 4: 19200 bps
Max: 8
5: 38400 bps
6: 57600 bps
7: 76800 bps
8: 115200 bps
Cycle power for the setting to take effect.
common_
All Modes TMonly
Default: 0
H5-03 0: No parity
Communication Parity Selection Min: 0 388
(427H) 1: Even parity
Max: 2
2: Odd parity
Cycle power for the setting to take effect.
common_
All Modes TMonly
Default: 3
H5-04 Stopping Method After 0: Ramp to stop
Min: 0 388
(428H) Communication Error (CE) 1: Coast to stop
Max: 3
2: Fast Stop
3: Alarm only
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 1
H5-05 Communication Fault Detection
Min: 0 389
(429H) Selection 0: Disabled
Max: 1
1: Enabled. If communication is lost for more than two seconds, a CE fault will occur.
common_ Default: 5 ms
H5-06 All Modes TMonly
Drive Transmit Wait Time Min: 5 ms 389
(42AH)
Sets the wait time between receiving and sending data. Max: 65 ms
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 1
H5-07
RTS Control Selection Min: 0 389
(42BH) 0: Disabled. RTS is always on.
Max: 1
1: Enabled. RTS turns on only when sending.
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 2.0 s
H5-09
CE Detection Time Min: 0.0 s 389
(435H) Sets the time required to detect a communications error. Adjustment may be needed when
Max: 10.0 s
networking several drives.
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
H5-10 Unit Selection for MEMOBUS/
Min: 0 389
(436H) Modbus Register 0025H 0: 0.1 V units
Max: 1
1: 1 V units
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
H5-11 Communications ENTER Function
Min: 0 390
(43CH) Selection 0: Drive requires an Enter command before accepting any changes to parameter settings.
Max: 1
1: Parameter changes are activated immediately without the Enter command.
<14> If this parameter is set to 0, the drive will be unable to respond to MEMOBUS/Modbus commands.
◆ L: Protection Functions
L parameters provide protection to the drive and motor, including control during momentary power loss, Stall Prevention,
frequency detection, fault reset, overtorque detection, torque limits, and other types of hardware protection.
■ L1: Motor Protection
358 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
<9> Values shown here are for 200 V class drives. Double the value when using a 400 V class drive.
<15> Default setting value is dependent on the setting for the input voltage (E1-01).
Default: 0.0%
L4-03 Speed Agreement Detection Level
Min: –100.0% 206
(49BH) (+/-) common_
All Modes TMonly
Max: 100.0%
L4-03 sets the speed detection level for digital output functions H2- = 13, 14, 15, 16.
Default: 4.0%
L4-04 Speed Agreement Detection Width L4-04 sets the hysteresis or allowable margin for speed detection.
Min: 0.0% 206
(49CH) (+/-)
Max: 40.0%
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
L4-05 Speed Reference Loss Detection
Min: 0 207
(49DH) Selection 0: Stop. Drive stops when the speed reference is lost.
Max: 1
1: Run. Drive runs at a reduced speed when the speed reference is lost.
common_
All Modes Default: 80%
Parameter List
L4-06 TMonly
Speed Reference at Reference Loss Min: 0.0% 207
(4C2H) Sets the percentage of the speed reference that the drive should run with when the speed
Max: 100.0%
reference is lost.
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0.0%
L4-13
Door Zone Level Min: 0.0% 207
(4F6H) Sets the door zone speed level. The "door zone" multi-function digital output is closed when the
Max: 100.0%
speed falls below this level.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 359
B.3 Parameter Table
0: Disabled
1: oL4 detection only active during speed agree, operation continues after detection
2: oL4 detection always active during run, operation continues after detection Default: 0
L6-04
Torque Detection Selection 2 3: oL4 detection only active during speed agree, output shuts down on an oL4 fault Min: 0 210
(4A4H)
4: oL4 detection always active during run, output shuts down on an oL4 fault Max: 8
5: UL4 detection only active during speed agree, operation continues after detection
6: UL4 detection always active during run, operation continues after detection
7: UL4 detection only active during speed agree, output shuts down on an oL4 fault
8: UL4 detection always active during run, output shuts down on an oL4 fault
common_ Default: 150%
L6-05 All Modes TMonly
Torque Detection Level 2 Min: 0% 210
(4A5H)
Sets the overtorque and undertorque detection level. Max: 300%
common_ Default: 0.1 s
L6-06 All Modes TMonly
Torque Detection Time 2 Min: 0.0 s 210
(4A6H)
Sets the time an overtorque or undertorque condition must exist to trigger torque detection 2. Max: 10.0 s
360 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
L7-03
L7-02 Default: 200%
L7-04 Reverse Regenerative Torque Negative Torque Min: 0% 211
(4AAH) Limit
Max: 300%
L8-06 When ripple is observed in the DC bus, expansion of the input bias is calculated and becomes Default: <4>
(4B2H)
Input Phase Loss Detection Level the input phase if the difference between the max and minimum values of the ripple are greater Min: 0.0% 212
than L8-06. Max: 50.0%
Detection Level = 100% = Voltage class × 2 (determines standards for setting values)
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
L8-07 Output Phase Loss Protection
0: Disabled Min: 0 213
(4B3H) Selection
1: Enabled (triggered by a single phase loss) Max: 2
2: Enabled (triggered when two phases are lost)
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 1
L8-09 Output Ground Fault Detection
Min: 0 213
(4B5H) Selection 0: Disabled
Max: 1
1: Enabled
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
L8-10 Heatsink Cooling Fan Operation
0: During run only. Fan operates only during run and for L8-11 seconds after stop. Min: 0 213
(4B6H) Selection
1: Fan always on. Cooling fan operates whenever the drive is powered up. Max: 2
2: Temperature controlled operation.
common_
All Modes Default: 60 s
TMonly
L8-11 Heatsink Cooling Fan Off Delay
Min: 0 s 213
Parameter List
(4B7H) Time Sets a delay time to shut off the cooling fan after the Up/Down command is removed when L8-
Max: 300 s
10 = 0.
common_ Default: 40°C
L8-12 All Modes TMonly
Ambient Temperature Setting Min: -10°C 214
(4B8H)
Enter the ambient temperature. This value adjusts the oL2 detection level. Max: 50°C
common_
oL2 (drive overload) All Modes TMonly Default: 1
L8-15
(4BBH)
Characteristics Selection at Low
Speeds
0: No oL2 level reduction below 6 Hz.
Min: 0
Max: 1
214
B
1: oL2 level is reduced linearly below 6 Hz. It is halved at 0 Hz.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 300.0%
L8-27
Overcurrent Detection Gain Min: 0.0% 214
(4DDH) Sets the gain for overcurrent detection as a percentage of the motor rated current. Overcurrent is
Max: 300.0%
detected using the drive’s overcurrent level or the value set to L8-27, whichever is lower.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 361
B.3 Parameter Table
Sets stopping method when a Input phase loss fault (PF) occurs. See parameter L8-05. Default: 1
L8-62 Operation Selection at Input Phase
0: Ramp to Stop - Decelerate to stop using the deceleration ramp in C1-02. Min: 0 212
(529H) Loss
1: Coast to Stop Max: 3
2: Fast Stop - Decelerate to stop using the deceleration ramp in C1-09.
3: Alarm only - Drive continues operation.
common_
All Modes TMonly
Default: 0
L8-77
Oscillation Suppression Used to suppress speed oscillations that occur with an unloaded motor and that have the same Min: -100 216
(61EH)
frequency as the output frequency. Max: 100
common_
All Modes TMonly
Default: 1
L8-88
Safe Disable Operation Mode 0: Mode 0 Min: 0 216
(2F5H)
1: Mode 1 Max: 1
<1> Parameter setting value is not reset to the default value when the drive is initialized.
<4> Default setting is determined by the drive model (o2-04).
362 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
Adjust this value when there is too much or too little current as a result of the settings assigned Max: 99.9%
to motor parameters.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 200.0 V <9>
n8-62
Output Voltage Limit Min: 0.0 V 223
(57DH) Prevents output voltage saturation. Should be set just below the voltage provided by the input
Max: 230.0 V <9>
power supply.
common_ Default: 90 Hz
n8-81 High Frequency Injection during V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM
(2D0H) Rescue Operation
Sets the frequency used for Polar Detection Method 1 during Rescue Operation.
TMonly
Min: 25 Hz
Max: 1000 Hz
222 B
common_
High Frequency Injection V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 15.0%
n8-82
Amplitude during Rescue Min: 0.1% 222
(2D1H) Sets the amplitude for High Frequency Injection during Rescue Operation as a percentage of the
Operation Max: 99.9%
voltage (200 V or 400 V).
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 363
B.3 Parameter Table
Sets the units the drive should use to display the frequency reference and motor speed monitors.
0: 0.01 Hz
Default: 1
o1-03 Digital Operator Display Unit 1: 0.01% (100% = E1-04)
Min: 0 224
(502H) Selection 2: r/min (calculated using the number of motor poles setting in E2-04, E4-04, or E5-04)
Max: 6 <21>
3: User-selected units (set by o1-10 and o1-11)
4: Elevator units 1 (speed in m/s, accel/decel rate and jerk in s)
5: Elevator units 2 (speed in m/s, accel/decel rate in m/s2, jerk in m/s3)
6: Elevator units 3 (speed in ft/min, accel/decel rate in ft/s2, jerk in ft/s3)
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: <5>
o1-04
V/f Pattern Setting Units 0: Hz Min: 0 225
(503H)
1: r/min Max: 1
Default: <20>
o1-10 User-Set Display Units Maximum common_
All Modes Min: 1 225
(520H) Value TMonly
Max: 60000
These settings define the display values when o1-03 is set to 3.
o1-10 sets the display value that is equal to the maximum output frequency. Default: <20>
o1-11 User-Set Display Units Decimal
o1-11 sets the position of the decimal position. Min: 0 225
(521H) Display
Max: 3
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 0
o1-12
Length Units Min: 0 225
(739H) 0: Millimeter unit
Max: 1
1: Inch unit
common_ Default: 400 mm <38>
o1-20 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Traction Sheave Diameter Min: 100 mm 225
(575H)
Sets the traction sheave diameter for display unit calculations. Max: 2000 mm <38>
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
364 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
common_ Default: 0 h
o4-01 Cumulative Operation Time All Modes TMonly Min: 0 h 228
(50BH) Setting
Sets the value for the cumulative operation time of the drive in units of 10 h. Max: 9999 h
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0
o4-02 Cumulative Operation Time
Min: 0 228
(50CH) Selection 0: Logs power-on time
Max: 1
1: Logs operation time when the drive output is active (output operation time).
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 365
B.3 Parameter Table
◆ S: Elevator Parameters
This section describes various functions and faults needed to operate an elevator application: braking sequence, slip
compensation for elevators, start/stop optimization, Rescue Operation, and elevator-related faults.
■ S1: Brake Sequence
366 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
S2-03 Slip compensation for leveling speed can be set separately for motoring and regenerative states.
This can help improve the accuracy of leveling. Default: 1.0
(691H) Slip Compensation Gain in
Min: 0.0 233
Regenerative Mode
Max: 5.0
S3-02 Sets gain levels 1 and 2 for the Position Lock function. Position Lock at start attempts to keep
the car position when opening the brake in order to avoid roll back. Default: 0.00
(698H) Position Lock Gain at Start 2
Min: 0.00 233
(Anti Rollback Gain)
Max: 100.00
S3-03 common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 5
(699H)
Position Lock Gain at Stop Min: 0 233
Sets the Position Lock gain at stop. Position Lock at stop keeps the car in position until the
Max: 100
brake has been applied entirely.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 10
S3-04
Position Lock Bandwidth Min: 0 234
(69AH) Determines the bandwidth around the stop position in which a digital output programmed for
Max: 16383
"Within Position Lock Bandwidth" (H2- = 33) is closed.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 500 ms
S3-10 Starting Torque Compensation
Min: 0 ms 234
(69BH) Increase Time Sets a time constant for the torque reference to reach 300%. Enabled by setting an analog input
Max: 5000 ms
terminal for torque compensation (H3- = 14).
Parameter List
common_ Default: 0
S3-12 Starting Torque Compensation V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Min: -40.0% 234
(69DH) Bias in Down Direction
Adds a bias to torque compensation value from the load cell when moving in down direction. Max: 40.0%
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Default: 0.0%
S3-14 Torque Compensation Fade Out
Sets the speed level for torque compensation to fade out during the time determined by S3-15. Min: 0.0% 234
(69FH) Speed
Sets as a percentage of the maximum output frequency (E1-04). A setting of 0.0% essentially Max: 100%
disables this function. B
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 1000 ms
S3-15 Torque Compensation Fade Out
Min: 0 ms 234
(6A0H) Time Sets the time for torque compensation to fade out once motor speed reaches the level set in S3-
Max: 5000 ms
14.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 367
B.3 Parameter Table
Determines the reduction rate used bring the internal torque reference value down to zero after Default: 100 ms
S3-16
Torque Limit Reduction Time Position Lock at Stop has finished. Min: 0 ms 234
(6A1H)
Max: 10000 ms
Rate = Torque 300%
S3-16
common_
All Modes TMonly Default: 0.00 %
S3-20
Dwell 2 Speed Reference Min: 0.00 % 234
(6A2H) Sets the speed reference for the Dwell 2 function.
Max: 100.00 %
Note: A setting of 0.00 essentially disables the Dwell 2 function.
common_
All Modes TMonly
Default: 0.00%
S3-21
Dwell 2 End Speed The Dwell 2 function will end when the drive reaches this speed. Min: 0.00% 235
(6A5H)
Note: A setting of 0.00 will disable the acceleration rate switch that occurs at the end of Dwell Max: 100.00%
2.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 100%
S3-25 DC Injection Gain in Regenerative
(6A3H) Operation Sets the gain level applied to the DC injection current at stop (S1-03) for when the load is 100% Min: 0% 235
Max: 400%
regenerative. The current applied during DC Injection at stop is determined as S1-03 × S3-25.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 20%
S3-26 DC Injection Gain in Motoring
(6A4H) Operation Sets the gain level applied to the DC injection current at stop (S1-03) for when the load is 100% Min: 0% 235
Max: 400%
motoring. The current applied during DC Injection at stop is determined as S1-03 × S3-26.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: –50%
S3-27 Torque Compensation Value with
Min: –100% 235
(6BDH) Load Condition 1 Used for starting torque compensation utilizing a load cell signal. Sets the torque compensation
Max: 100%
value for load condition 1.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 50%
S3-28 Torque Compensation Value with
Min: –100% 235
(6BEH) Load Condition 2 Used for starting torque compensation utilizing a load cell signal. Sets the torque compensation
Max: 100%
value for load condition 2.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 0.0%
S3-29 Analog Input from Load Cell with
Min: –100% 236
(6BFH) Load Condition 1 Used for starting torque compensation utilizing a load cell signal. Sets the analog signal level
Max: 100%
from the load cell for load condition 1.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 100.0%
S3-30 Analog Input from Load Cell with
Min: –100.0% 236
(6C0H) Load Condition 2 Used for starting torque compensation utilizing a load cell signal. Sets the analog signal level
Max: 100%
from the load cell for load condition 2.
common_ Default: 0.0%
S3-34 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Anti-Rollback Torque Bias 1 Min: 0.0% 236
(6C4H)
Sets the Anti-Rollback Bias applied at small position deviations during Position Lock at start. Max: 100.0%
common_ Default: 0.0%
S3-35 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Anti-Rollback Torque Bias 2 Min: 0.0% 236
(6C5H)
Sets the Anti-Rollback Bias applied at large position deviations during Position Lock at start. Max: 100.0%
common_ Default: 0
S3-37 Position Deviation Level to Apply V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Min: 0 236
(6C7H) ARB Torque Bias 1
Sets the position deviation level to active at Anti-Rollback Torque Bias 1 (S3-34). Max: 32767
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 0
S3-38 Position Deviation Level to Apply
Min: 0 236
(6C8H) ARB Torque Bias 2 Determines the position deviation level for when the drive should switch from the torque bias
Max: 32767
set in S3-34 to the torque bias set in S3-35.
common_ Default: 0.00
S3-39 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Anti-Rollback Integral Gain Min: –30.00 236
(6C9H)
Determines the drive’s responsiveness for Anti-Rollback during Position Lock. Max: 30.00
common_ Default: 1 pulse
S3-40 Anti-Rollback Movement V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Min: 0 pulse 237
(6CAH) Detection
Sets the amount of pulses for movement detection during Anti-Rollback. Max: 100 pulses
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly Default: 0.50
S3-41 Position Lock Gain at Start 2
Min: 0.00 237
(6CBH) Reduction Sets a reduction factor for the Position Lock Gain at Start 2 (Anti-Rollback Gain) set in
Max: 1.00
parameter S3-02.
368 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
Determines how a speed limit should be applied to the Rescue Operation speed (d1-25) when Default: 2
S4-08 UPS Operation Speed Limit
operating from a UPS. Min: 0 238
(6CEH) Selection
0: Disabled Max: 2
1: Enabled until Light Load Direction Search is complete
2: Enabled until stop
common_ Default: 0 V
S4-12 DC Bus Voltage during Rescue All Modes TMonly Min: 0 V 238
(6D2H) Operation
Sets the DC bus voltage during Rescue Operation. Max: 800 V
common_ Default: 80%
S4-13 Rescue Operation Power Supply All Modes TMonly Min: 10% 238
(6D3H) Deterioration Detection Level
Determines at which level of backup power supply deterioration a PF5 fault is triggered. Max: 100%
<5> Default setting is determined by the control mode (A1-02).
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 369
B.3 Parameter Table
◆ T: Motor Tuning
Enter data into the following parameters to tune the motor and drive for optimal performance
■ T1: Induction Motor Auto-Tuning
370 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
common_ Default: 6
T2-08 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Number of Motor Poles Min: 2 112
(734H)
Enter the number of motor poles for the motor as indicated on the motor nameplate. Max: 48
common_ Default: 150 r/min
T2-09 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Motor Base Speed Min: 0 r/min 112
(731H)
Enter the base speed for the motor as indicated on the motor nameplate. Max: 24000 r/min
common_ Default: –
T2-10 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Min: 0.000 Ω
(754H)
Single Phase Stator Resistance
Enter the 1-phase resistance of the stator winding. Max: 65.000 Ω
113
B
common_ Default: –
T2-11 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Motor d-Axis Inductance Min: 0.00 mH 113
(735H)
Enter the d-axis inductance for the motor as indicated on the motor nameplate. Max: 600.00 mH
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 371
B.3 Parameter Table
◆ U: Monitors
Monitor parameters allow the user to view drive status, fault information, and other data concerning drive operation.
■ U1: Operation Status Monitors
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Unit Page
Level
common_
U1-01 All Modes TMonly 0.01%
Speed Reference 10 V: Max frequency –
(40H) <31>
Monitors the speed reference.
common_
U1-02 All Modes TMonly 0.01%
Output Speed 10 V: Max frequency –
(41H) <31>
Displays the output speed.
common_
U1-03 All Modes TMonly 10 V: Drive rated
Output Current <10> –
(42H) current
Displays the output current.
common_
All Modes TMonly
372 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Unit Page
Level
common_
All Modes TMonly
Displays the input terminal status.
U1 - 10= 00000000
1 Digital input 1
(terminal S1 enabled)
1 Digital input 2
(terminal S2 enabled)
1 Digital input 3
U1-10 (terminal S3 enabled) No signal output
(49H)
Input Terminal Status YEA_co 1 Digital input 4 available
– –
common_
All Modes TMonly
Displays the output terminal status.
U1 - 11= 00000000
1 Multi-Function
Digital Output
(terminal M1-M2)
1 Multi-Function
Digital Output
YEA_co (terminal M3-M4)
U1-11
(4AH)
Output Terminal Status mmon 1 Multi-Function
Digital Output
No signal output
available
– –
(terminal M5-M6)
1 Multi-Function
Digital Output
(terminal P1-C1)
1 Multi-Function
Digital Output
(terminal P2-C2)
Not Used
1Fault Relay
(terminal MA-MC closed
MA-MC open)
common_
All Modes TMonly
Verifies the drive operation status.
U1 - 12= 00000000
1 During run
1 During zero-speed
U1-12
Drive Status YEAco 1 During down direction No signal output
– –
(4BH) available
mmon 1 During fault reset
signal input
1 During speed agree
1 Drive ready
1 During alarm
detection
Parameter List
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 373
B.3 Parameter Table
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Unit Page
Level
common_
All Modes TMonly
U1-17 DI-A3 Option Card Input No signal output
Displays the reference value input from the DI-A3 option card. – –
(58H) Status available
Display will appear in hexadecimal as determined by the digital card input selection in F3-01.
3FFFF: Set (1 bit) + sign (1 bit) + 16 bit
common_
U1-18 All Modes TMonly No signal output
oPE Fault Parameter – –
(61H) available
Displays the parameter number that caused the oPE or Err (EEPROM write error) error.
common_
All Modes TMonly
Displays the contents of a MEMOBUS/Modbus error.
U1 - 19= 00000000
1 CRC Error
U1-19 MEMOBUS/Modbus Error 1 Data Length Error No signal output
(66H) Code YEAcom 0 Not Used available
– –
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Unit Page
Level
common_
U2-01 All Modes TMonly No signal output
Current Fault – –
(80H) available
Displays the current fault.
common_
U2-02 All Modes TMonly No signal output
Previous Fault – –
(81H) available
Displays the previous fault.
common_
U2-03 Speed Reference at Previous All Modes TMonly No signal output 0.01%
–
(82H) Fault available <31>
Displays the speed reference at the previous fault.
common_
U2-04 All Modes TMonly No signal output 0.01%
Output Speed at Previous Fault –
(83H) available <31>
Displays the output speed at the previous fault.
common_
U2-05 Output Current at Previous All Modes TMonly No signal output
<10> –
(84H) Fault available
Displays the output current at the previous fault.
common_
U2-06 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly No signal output 0.01%
Motor Speed at Previous Fault –
(85H) available <31>
Displays the motor speed at the previous fault.
common_
U2-07 Output Voltage at Previous All Modes TMonly No signal output
0.1 Vac –
(86H) Fault available
Displays the output voltage at the previous fault.
common_
U2-08 DC Bus Voltage at Previous All Modes TMonly No signal output
1 Vdc –
(87H) Fault available
Displays the DC bus voltage at the previous fault.
common_
U2-09 Output Power at Previous All Modes TMonly No signal output
0.1 kW –
(88H) Fault available
Displays the output power at the previous fault.
374 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Unit Page
Level
common_
U2-10 Torque Reference at Previous V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly No signal output
0.1% –
(89H) Fault available
Displays the torque reference at the previous fault.
common_
U2-11 Input Terminal Status at All Modes TMonly No signal output
– –
(8AH) Previous Fault available
Displays the input terminal status at the previous fault. Displayed as in U1-10.
common_
U2-12 Output Terminal Status at All Modes TMonly No signal output
– –
(8BH) Previous Fault available
Displays the output status at the previous fault. Displays the same status displayed in U1-11.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U2-13 Drive Operation Status at No signal output
– –
(8CH) Previous Fault Displays the operation status of the drive at the previous fault. Displays the same status available
displayed in U1-12.
common_
U2-14 Cumulative Operation Time at All Modes TMonly No signal output
1h –
(8DH) Previous Fault available
Displays the cumulative operation time at the previous fault.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U2-15 Soft Starter Output at Previous No signal output 0.01%
–
(7E0H) Fault Displays the speed reference for the soft starter at the previous fault. Displayed in the same way available <31>
as U1-16.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
U2-16 Motor q-Axis Current at No signal output
0.10% –
(7E1H) Previous Fault Displays the q-axis current for the motor at the previous fault. Displayed in the same way as available
U6-01.
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
U2-17 Motor d-Axis Current at No signal output
0.10% –
(7E2H) Previous Fault Displays the d-axis current for the motor at the previous fault. Displayed in the same way as available
U6-02.
common_
U2-20 Heatsink Temperature at All Modes TMonly No signal output
1°C –
(8EH) Previous Fault Displays the temperature of the heatsink when the most recent fault occurred. available
common_
U2-21 Peak Hold Current during All Modes TMonly No signal output
0.01 A –
(7E6H) Fault Displays the peak current that occurred just prior to the previous fault. available
common_
U2-22 Peak Hold Frequency during All Modes TMonly No signal output
0.01 Hz –
(7E7H) Fault available
Displays the output frequency when the peak current displayed in U2-21 occurred.
<10> The display resolution depends on the rated output power of the drive. Models CIMR-L2A0018 to 2A0033 and CIMR-L4A0009 to
4A0018 display values in 0.01 A units, while models CIMR-L2A0047 to 2A0415 and CIMR-L4A0024 to 4A0260 display values in 0.1 A
units.
<31> Setting units are determined by the digital operator display unit selection (o1-03). When o1-03 = 0, the value is set in Hertz. When o1-03 = 4
or 5, the value is displayed in m/s. When o1-03 = 6, the value is displayed in ft/min.
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Unit Page
Level
U3-01 to
U3-04 common_
All Modes TMonly No signal output
(90H to 93H First to 4th Most Recent Fault – –
available
(800H to Displays the first to the fourth most recent faults.
803H))
common_
All Modes TMonly
U3-05 to
U3-10 Displays the fifth to the tenth most recent faults. No signal output
5th to 10th Most Recent Fault – –
(804H to After ten faults have occurred in the drive, data for the oldest fault is deleted. The most recent available
809H) fault appears in U3-01, with the next most recent fault appearing in U3-02. The data is moved to
the next monitor parameter every time a fault occurs.
U3-11 to
U3-14 common_
Cumulative Operation Time at All Modes TMonly No signal output
(94H to 97H 1h –
1st to 4th Most Recent Fault available
Parameter List
(80AH to Displays the cumulative operation time when the first to the fourth most recent faults occurred.
80DH))
U3-15 to
common_
U3-20 Cumulative Operation Time at All Modes TMonly No signal output
1h –
(80EH to 5th to 10th Most Recent Fault available
Displays the cumulative operation time when the fifth to the tenth most recent faults occurred.
813H)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 375
B.3 Parameter Table
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Unit Page
Level
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-01
Displays the cumulative operation time of the drive. The value for the cumulative operation No signal output
(4CH, 98H, Cumulative Operation Time 1h –
time counter can be reset in parameter o4-01. Use parameter o4-02 to determine if the operation available
99H)
time should start as soon as the power is switched on or only while the Up/Down command is
present. The maximum number displayed is 99999, after which the value is reset to 0.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-03
No signal output
(67H, 94H, Cooling Fan Operation Time Displays the cumulative operation time of the cooling fan. The default value for the fan 1h –
available
9BH) operation time is reset in parameter o4-03. This value will reset to 0 and start counting again
after reaching 99999.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-04 No signal output
Cooling Fan Maintenance 1% –
(7EH) Displays main cooling fan usage time in as a percentage of its expected performance life. available
Parameter o4-03 can be used to reset this monitor.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-05 No signal output
Capacitor Maintenance 1% –
(7CH) Displays main circuit capacitor usage time in as a percentage of their expected performance life. available
Parameter o4-05 can be used to reset this monitor.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-06 Soft Charge Bypass Relay No signal output
1% –
(7D6H) Maintenance Displays the soft charge bypass relay maintenance time as a percentage of its estimated available
performance life. Parameter o4-07 can be used to reset this monitor.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-07 No signal output
IGBT Maintenance 1% –
(7D7H) Displays IGBT usage time as a percentage of the expected performance life. Parameter o4-09 available
can be used to reset this monitor.
common_
U4-08 All Modes TMonly
Heatsink Temperature 10 V: 100°C 1°C –
(68H)
Displays the heatsink temperature.
common_
U4-09 All Modes TMonly No signal output
LED Check – –
(5EH) available
Lights all segments of the LED to verify that the display is working properly.
common_
U4-10 All Modes TMonly No signal output
kWh, Lower 4 Digits 1 kWh –
(5CH) available
Monitors the drive output power. The value is shown as a 9 digit number displayed across two
monitor parameters, U4-10 and U4-11.
Example:
12345678.9 kWh is displayed as:
U4-11 No signal output
kWh, Upper 5 Digits U4-10: 678.9 kWh 1 MWh –
(5DH) available
U4-11: 12345 MWh
common_
U4-13 All Modes TMonly No signal output
Peak Hold Current 0.01 A –
(7CFH) available
Displays the highest current value that occurred during a ride.
common_
U4-14 All Modes TMonly No signal output
Peak Hold Output Frequency 0.01 Hz –
(7D0H) available
Displays the output frequency when the current value shown in U4-13 occurred.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-16 Motor Overload Estimate
10 V: 100% 0.1% –
(7D8H) (oL1) Shows the value of the motor overload detection accumulator. 100% is equal to the oL1
detection level.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-17 Drive Overload Calculations
10 V = 100% 0.1% –
(7D9H) (OL2) Displays the level of the drive overload detection (oL2). A value of 100% is equal to the oL2
detection level.
common_
All Modes TMonly
Displays the source for the speed reference as XY-nn.
X: indicates which reference is used:
1 = Reference 1 (b1-01)
U4-18 Speed Reference Selection Y-nn: indicates the reference source No signal output
– –
(7DAH) Results 0-01 = Digital operator available
1-01 = Analog (terminal A1)
1-02 = Analog (terminal A2)
2-02 to 8 = Digital Inputs (d1-02 to 8)
3-01 = MEMOBUS/Modbus communications
4-01 = Communication option card
common_
U4-19 Speed Reference from All Modes TMonly No signal output 0.01%
–
(7DBH) MEMOBUS/Modbus Comm. available <31>
Displays the speed reference provided by MEMOBUS/Modbus (decimal).
common_
U4-20 Speed Reference From Option All Modes TMonly No signal output 0.01%
–
(7DCH) Card available <31>
Displays the speed reference input by an option card (decimal).
376 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.3 Parameter Table
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Unit Page
Level
common_
All Modes TMonly
Displays the source for the Up/Down command as XY-nn.
X: Indicates which Up/Down command source is used:
1 = Reference 1 (b1-02)
Y: Input power supply data
0 = Digital operator
1 = External terminals
3 = MEMOBUS/Modbus communications
U4-21 Up/Down Command Source 4 = Communication option card No signal output
– –
(7DDH) Selection nn: Up/Down command limit status data available
00: No limit status.
01: Up/Down command was left on when stopped in the PRG mode
02: Up/Down command was left on when switching from LOCAL to REMOTE operation
03: Waiting for soft charge bypass contactor after power up (Uv or Uv1 flashes after 10 s)
04: Waiting for "Up/Down Command Prohibited" time period to end
05: Fast Stop (multi-function input, operator)
07: During baseblock while coast to stop with timer
08: Speed reference is below minimal reference during baseblock
09: Waiting for Enter command
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-22 MEMOBUS/Modbus No signal output
– –
(7DEH) Communications Reference Displays the drive control data set by MEMOBUS/Modbus communications register no. 0001H available
as a four-digit hexadecimal number.
common_
U4-23 Communication Option Card All Modes TMonly No signal output
– –
(7DFH) Reference available
Displays drive control data set by an option card as a four-digit hexadecimal number.
common_
U4-24 Number of Travels All Modes TMonly No signal output
1 time –
(7E6H) (Lower 4 digit) available
Displays the lower four digits for the number of trips the drive has made.
common_
U4-25 Number of Travels All Modes TMonly No signal output
1 time –
(7E7H) (Higher 4 digit) available
Displays the upper four digits for the number of trips the drive has made.
common_
U4-26 Max. Current during All Modes TMonly No signal output
0.1 A –
(7E8H) Acceleration available
Shows the maximum current that occurred during acceleration.
common_
U4-27 Max. Current during All Modes TMonly No signal output
0.1 A –
(7E9H) Deceleration available
Shows the maximum current that occurred during deceleration.
common_
U4-28 Max. Current during Constant All Modes TMonly No signal output
0.1 A –
(7EAH) Speed available
Shows the maximum current that occurred during ride at top speed.
common_
U4-29 Max. Current during Leveling All Modes TMonly No signal output
0.1 A –
(7EDH) Speed available
Shows the maximum current that occurred during ride at leveling speed.
common_
U4-30 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly No signal output
Slip Compensation Value 0.01% –
(7EEH) available
Shows the slip compensation value.
common_
U4-31 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly No signal output
Car Acceleration Rate 0.01 m/s2 –
(7EFH) available
Shows the car acceleration rate.
common_
All Modes TMonly
U4-40 Speed Reference Limit at No signal output
1% –
(7FDH) Rescue Operation Displays the speed limit for Rescue Operation based on how much power the backup battery or available
UPS has. Displays 0% when Rescue Operation is not being performed.
U4-42 common_ 10 V:
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
(855H) Remaining Distance S5-10 = 1: S5-11 1 mm –
<35> Displays the remaining distance according to the stopping method selected. S5-10 = 2: S5-12
U4-43 common_
Minimum Deceleration V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly No signal output
(856H) 1 mm –
Distance available
<35> Displays the Minimum Deceleration Distance calculated by E1-04.
U4-44 common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly No signal output
(857H) Minimum Stop Distance 1 mm –
Parameter List
available
<35> Displays the Minimum Stop Distance calculated by d1-26.
<31> Setting units are determined by the digital operator display unit selection (o1-03). When o1-03 = 0, the value is set in Hertz. When o1-03 = 4
or 5, the value is displayed in m/s. When o1-03 = 6, the value is displayed in ft/min.
<35> o1-12 (Length Units) determines the units. When o1-12 is set to 0, the unit is millimeters. When o1-12 is set to 1, the unit is inch.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 377
B.3 Parameter Table
Analog Output
No. (Addr.) Name Description Unit Page
Level
10 V: Motor
common_
U6-01 All Modes TMonly
Motor Secondary Current (Iq) secondary rated 0.1% –
(51H)
Displays the value of the motor secondary current (Iq). Motor rated secondary current is 100%. current
common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly 10 V: Motor
U6-02
Motor Excitation Current (Id) secondary rated 0.1% –
(52H) Displays the value calculated for the motor excitation current (Id). Motor rated secondary
current
current is 100%.
U6-03
Speed Control Loop Input 10 V: Max frequency
(54H) common_
V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
10 V: Motor 0.01% –
U6-04 Displays the input and output values of the speed control loop.
Speed Control Loop Output secondary rated
(55H)
current
common_
U6-05 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Output Voltage Reference (Vq) 10 V: 200 Vrms <9> 0.1 Vac –
(59H)
Output voltage reference (Vq) for the q-axis.
common_
U6-06 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Output Voltage Reference (Vd) 10 V: 200 Vrms <9> 0.1 Vac –
(5AH)
Output voltage reference (Vd) for the d-axis.
common_
U6-07 q-Axis Current Controller V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly 10 V: 200 Vrms <9> 0.1% –
(5FH) Output
Displays the output value for current control relative to motor secondary current (q-axis).
common_
U6-08 d-Axis Current Controller V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
10 V: 200 Vrms <9> 0.1% –
(60H) Output
Displays the output value for current control relative to motor secondary current (d-axis).
common_
U6-13 Flux Position Detection V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly 10 V: 180 deg
0.1 deg
(7CAH) (sensor) –10 V: –180 deg
Monitors the value of the flux position detection (sensor).
common_
U6-18 All Modes TMonly
Speed Detection PG1 Counter 10 V: 65536 1 pulse
(7CDH)
Monitors the number of pulses for speed detection (PG1).
common_
U6-22 Position Lock Deviation V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly 10 V: No. of pulses
1 –
(62H) Counter per revolution
Displays how far the rotor has moved from its last position in PG pulses (multiplied by 4).
common_ 10 V: Motor
U6-25 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Feedback Control Output secondary rated 0.01% –
(6BH)
Output monitor for the speed control loop. current
common_ 10 V: Motor
U6-26 V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly
Inertia Compensation Output secondary rated 0.01% –
(6CH)
Output monitor for Inertia Compensation. current
common_
U6-56 Speed Feedback V/f OLV CLV CLV/PM TMonly 10 V: Max output
0.01% –
(7C3H) Compensation Output frequency
Displays observed speed when n5-07=1 or 2.
U6-80
common_
to U6-99 All Modes TMonly No signal output
Option Monitor 1 to 20 – –
(7B0 to 7B9, available
Monitors reserved to display data from option cards.
7F0 to 7F9H)
<9> Values shown here are for 200 V class drives. Double the value when using a 400 V class drive.
378 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.4 Control Mode Dependent Parameter Default Values
<9> Values shown here are for 200 V class drives. Double the value when using a 400 V class drive.
<32> Default setting value varies by drive model (o2-04).The default setting for models CIMR-L2A0015 to 2A0180, CIMR-L4A0112 to
4A0150 is 1000 ms when using V/f control.
<33> Setting range depends on the type of motor being used. An induction motor has a setting range of 10.0 to 120.0 Hz, while a PM motor has a
setting range of 4.0 to 120.0 Hz.
on page 173
E3-09 Motor 2 Minimum Output Frequency 0.0 to 400.0 0.1 Hz
E3-10 Motor 2 Minimum Output Voltage <18> 0.0 to 255.0 0.1 V
<18> Values shown here are for 200 V class drives. Double the value when using a 400 V class drive.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 379
B.5 Defaults by Drive Model Selection (o2-04)
380 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
B.5 Defaults by Drive Model Selection (o2-04)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 381
B.6 Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit Selection (o1-03)
<1> Automatically calculated according to the values set to o1-20, o1-21, o1-22, and E2-/E5- parameters.
<2> Automatically calculated according to the values set to the E2-/E5- parameters.
382 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Appendix: C
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 383
C.1 MEMOBUS/Modbus Configuration
Slave (Drive)
YEA_common
384 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.2 Communication Specifications
Item Specifications
Interface RS-422, RS-485
Communications Cycle Asynchronous (Start-stop synchronization)
Communication Speeds Available 1.2; 2.4; 4.8; 9.6; 19.2; 38.4; 57.6; 76.8; 115.2 kbps
Data length 8 bit (fixed)
Communication Parameters
Parity Select even, odd, or none
Stop bit 1 bit (fixed)
Protocol MEMOBUS/Modbus (using RTU mode only)
Max Number of Slaves 255 drives
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 385
C.3 Connecting to a Network
YEA_co IG R+ R- S+ S-
mmon
S– Send (–)
S+ Send (+)
P M
R– Receive (–)
R+ Receive (+)
IG Shield Ground
R– S– Drive
R+ S+
PLC S– R– S2
S+ R+
IG IG OFF
S– Drive
S+
R– S2
R+
IG OFF
S– Drive
S+
R–
common_
S2
R+ ON
IG
TMonly
Figure C.3 RS-485 Interface
Note: 1. Turn on the DIP switch on the drive that is located at the end of the network. All other slave devices must have this DIP switch set to
the OFF position.
2. Set H5-07 to 1 when using the RS-485 interface.
386 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.3 Connecting to a Network
■ RS-422 Interface
Figure C.4
R– S– Drive
R+ S+
PLC S– R– S2
S+ R+
IG IG OFF
S– Drive
S+
R– S2
R+
IG OFF
S– Drive
S+
R–
R+
IG
S2
ON common_
TMonly
◆ Network Termination
The two ends of the MEMOBUS/Modbus network line have to be terminated. The drive has a built in termination resistor
that can be enabled or disabled using DIP switch S2. If a drive is located at the end of a network line, enable the
termination resistor by setting DIP switch S2 to the ON position. Disable the termination resistor on all slaves that are not
located at the network line end.
Figure C.5 illustrates the setting of DIP switch S2.
To set the DIP switch on the terminal board, use an appropriate sized tool with a tip of approximately 8 mm (5/16 in.) in
width.
Figure C.5
S-
DIP Switch S2 -
S+
YEA_TM OFF ON RS-422 +
only or
RS-485 R-
DIP
switch
R+ S2
(OFF: default)
Termination resistor (1/2 W110 Ω)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 387
C.4 MEMOBUS/Modbus Setup Parameters
Each slave drive must be assigned a unique slave address for serial communications to work. Setting H5-01 to any value
besides 0 assigns the drive its address in the network. Slave addresses do not need to be assigned in sequential order, but
no two drives may share the same address.
■ H5-02: Communication Speed Selection
Sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus communications speed.
Note: Cycle the power after changing this parameter to enable the new setting.
Setting 0: No parity
Setting 1: Even parity
Setting 2: Odd parity
■ H5-04: Stopping Method after Communication Error
Selects the stopping method after a communications error (CE) has occurred.
388 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.4 MEMOBUS/Modbus Setup Parameters
Setting 0: Disabled
No communication error detection. The drive continues operation.
Setting 1: Enabled
If the drive does not receive data from the master for longer than the time set to H5-09, then a CE fault will be triggered
and the drive will operate as determined by parameter H5-04.
■ H5-06: Drive Transmit Wait Time
Sets the time the drive waits after receiving data from a master until responding data.
No. Name Setting Range Default
H5-06 Drive Transmit Wait Time 5 to 65 ms 5 ms
Figure C.6
common_
TMonly
24 bit length H5-06 setting
Figure C.6 Drive Transmit Wait Time Setting
Sets the unit for the output voltage monitor value in MEMOBUS/Modbus register 0025H.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 389
C.4 MEMOBUS/Modbus Setup Parameters
390 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.5 Drive Operations by MEMOBUS/Modbus
Refer to b1-01: Speed Reference Selection on page 148 and Refer to b1-02: Up/Down Command Selection on page 149
for details on operation mode parameter selections.
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 391
C.6 Communications Timing
common_
24 bit length
Master Send
Wait Time
TMonly
Figure C.7 Minimum Wait Time for Sending Messages
A timer should be set in the master to check how long it takes for the slave drive(s) to respond to the master. If no
response is received within a certain amount of time, the master should try resending the message.
common_
24 bit length H5-06 TMonly
setting
392 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.7 Message Format
SLAVE ADDRESS
FUNCTION CODE
common_
DATA TMonly
ERROR CHECK
◆ Slave Address
The slave address in the message defines the note the message is sent to. Use addresses between 0 and FF (hex). If a
message with slave address 0 is sent (broadcast), the command from the master will be received by all slaves. The slaves
do not provide a response to a broadcast type message.
◆ Function Code
The three types of function codes are shown in the table below.
◆ Data
Configure consecutive data by combining the MEMOBUS/Modbus register address (test code in case of a loopback test)
and the data the register contains. The data length changes depending on the command details.
A drive MEMOBUS/Modbus register always has a data length of two bytes. Therefore data written into drive registers
must also always have a length of two bytes. Register data read out from the drive will always consist of two bytes.
◆ Error Check
The drive uses a CRC-16 (cyclic redundancy check, checksum method) for checking data validity. Use the procedure
described below when calculating the CRC-16 checksum for command data or when verifying response data.
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications
■ Command Data
When the drive receives data, it calculates the CRC-16 checksum from the data and compares it to the CRC-16 value
received within the message. Both must match before a command is processed.
An initial value of FFFFH (i.e., all 16 bits equal 1) must be used for CRC-16 calculations in the MEMOBUS/Modbus
C
protocol.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 393
C.7 Message Format
■ Response Data
Perform a CRC-16 calculation on the response message data as described above as a validation check. The result should
match the CRC-16 checksum received within the response message.
394 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.8 Message Examples
◆ Loopback Test
Function code 08H performs a loopback test. This test returns a response message with exactly the same content as the
command message and can be used to check communications between the master and slave. User-defined test code and
data values can be set.
The following table shows a message example when performing a loopback test with the slave 1 drive.
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 395
C.8 Message Examples
Note: Double the number of the data quantity for the number of bytes in the command message.
396 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
◆ Command Data
It is possible to both read and write command data.
Note: Bits that are not used should be set to 0. Refrain from writing to reserved registers.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 397
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
◆ Monitor Data
Monitor data can be read only.
398 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 399
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
400 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
bit 8 to F Reserved
Communications
Fault contents 7
bit 0 to 4 Reserved
bit 5 Current Offset Fault (CoF)
bit 6 to B Reserved
00C4H
bit C Output Voltage Detection Fault (voF)
bit D Reserved
bit E Braking Transistor Overload Fault (boL) C
bit F Reserved
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 401
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
402 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
bit 8 to F Reserved
Communications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 403
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
404 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
<1> Parameter o1-03, Digital Operator Display Selection, determines the units.
<2> The value will have two decimal places (0.01 A) in the drive models 2A0018 to 0033 and 4A0009 to 0018 (refer to and ), and one decimal
place (0.1 A) in the drive models 2A0047 to 0415 and 4A0024 to 0260.
<3> Communication error contents are saved until the fault is reset.
<4> Set the number of motor poles to parameter E2-04, E4-04, or E5-05 depending on the motor being used.
◆ Broadcast Messages
Data can be written from the master to all slave devices at the same time.
The slave address in a broadcast command message must be set to 00H. All slaves will receive the message, but will not
respond.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 405
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
406 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.9 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 407
C.10 Enter Command
Note: Limit the number of times writing to the EEPROM because the EEPROM can only be written to 100,000 times. The Enter
command registers are write-only and if these registers are read, the register address will be invalid (Error code: 02H). An Enter
command is not required when reference or broadcast data are sent to the drive.
408 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
C.11 Communication Errors
Error Name
Error Code
Cause
Function Code Error
01H
• Attempted to set a function code from a PLC other than 03H, 08H, and 10H.
Register Number Error
02H • A register number specified in the command message does not exist.
• Attempted to send a broadcast message using other register numbers than 0001H or 0002H.
Bit Count Error
03H • Read data or write data is greater than 16 bits. Invalid command message quantity.
• In a write message, the “Number of Data Items” contained within the message does not equal twice the amount of data words (i.e., the total of Data 1+ Data
2, etc.).
Data Setting Error
21H • Control data or parameter write data is outside the allowable setting range.
• Attempted to write a contradictory parameter setting.
Write Mode Error
22H • During run, the user attempted to write a parameter that cannot be written to during run.
• During an EEPROM memory data error (CPF06), the master attempted to write to a parameter other than A1-00 to A1-05, E1-03, or o2-04.
• Attempted to write to read-only data.
DC Bus Undervoltage Write Error
23H
• During an undervoltage situation, the master attempted to write to parameters that cannot be written to during undervoltage.
Write Error During Parameter Process
24H
• Master attempted writing to the drive while the drive was processing parameter data.
MEMOBUS/Modbus
Communications
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 409
C.12 Self-Diagnostics
C.12 Self-Diagnostics
The drive has a built-in self-diagnosing function of the serial communication interface circuits. To perform the self-
diagnosis function, use the following procedure.
DANGER! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not connect or disconnect wiring while the power is on. Failure to comply will result in death or
serious injury. Before servicing, disconnect all power to the equipment. The internal capacitor remains charged even after the power
supply is turned off. The charge indicator LED will extinguish when the DC bus voltage is below 50 Vdc. To prevent electric shock, wait
at least one minute after all indicators are OFF and measure the DC bus voltage level to confirm safe level.
YEA_TMonly
410 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Appendix: D
Standards Compliance
This appendix explains the guidelines and criteria for maintaining CE, UL, and
CSA standards.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 411
D.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not operate equipment with covers removed.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
The diagrams in this section may show drives without covers or safety shields to show details. Be sure to reinstall
covers or shields before operating the drives and run the drives according to the instructions described in this manual.
Always ground the motor-side grounding terminal.
Improper equipment grounding could result in death or serious injury by contacting the motor case.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use the equipment.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Maintenance, inspection, and replacement of parts must be performed only by authorized personnel familiar with
installation, adjustment and maintenance of AC drives.
Do not perform work on the drive while wearing loose clothing, jewelry or without eye protection.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
Remove all metal objects such as watches and rings, secure loose clothing, and wear eye protection before beginning
work on the drive.
Do not remove covers or touch circuit boards while the power is on.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury.
412 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.1 Section Safety
WARNING
Fire Hazard
Tighten all terminal screws to the specified tightening torque.
Loose electrical connections could result in death or serious injury by fire due to overheating of electrical connections.
Do not use an improper voltage source.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire.
Verify that the rated voltage of the drive matches the voltage of the incoming power supply before applying power.
Do not use improper combustible materials in drive installation, repair or maintenance.
Failure to comply could result in death or serious injury by fire. Attach the drive or braking resistors to metal or other
noncombustible material.
NOTICE
Equipment Hazard
Observe proper electrostatic discharge procedures (ESD) when handling the drive and circuit boards.
Failure to comply may result in ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Never connect or disconnect the motor from the drive while the drive is outputting voltage.
Improper equipment sequencing could result in damage to the drive.
Do not use unshielded wire for control wiring.
Failure to comply may cause electrical interference resulting in poor system performance. Use shielded twisted-pair
wires and ground the shield to the ground terminal of the drive.
Do not allow unqualified personnel to use the product.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive or braking circuit.
Carefully review instruction manual TOBPC72060000 when connecting a braking option to the drive.
Do not modify the drive circuitry.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive and will void warranty.
Yaskawa is not responsible for modification of the product made by the user. This product must not be modified.
Check all the wiring to ensure that all connections are correct after installing the drive and connecting other
devices.
Failure to comply could result in damage to the drive.
Standards Compliance
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 413
D.2 European Standards
414 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.2 European Standards
Fuse Type
Model
Manufacturer: Bussmann
CIMR-L
Model Fuse Ampere Rating (A)
4A0031 FWH-200B 200
4A0039 FWH-250A 250
4A0045 FWH-250A 250
4A0060 FWH-250A 250
4A0075 FWH-250A 250
4A0091 FWH-250A 250
4A0112 FWH-350A 350
4A0150 FWH-400A 400
4A0180 FWH-500A 500
4A0216 FWH-600A 600
4A0260 FWH-700A 700
■ Grounding
The drive is designed to be used in T-N (grounded neutral point) networks. If installing the drive in other types of
grounded systems, contact your Yaskawa representative for instructions.
A D C
U/T1 U
V/T2 V
M
W/T3 W
Standards Compliance
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 415
D.2 European Standards
5. Make sure the ground conductor complies with technical standards and local safety rules. When an EMC filter is
installed, the leakage current exceeds 3.5 mA. Therefore according to IEC61800-5-1, at least one of the
conditions below must be satisfied:
a) The cross-section of the protective earthing conductor must be at least 10 mm2 (Cu) or 16 mm2 (Al).
b) The power supply must be disconnected automatically in case of discontinuity of the protective earthing
conductor.
Figure D.3
C B
A – Braided shield cable C – Cable clamp (conductive)
B – Metal panel
Figure D.3 Ground Area
6. Connect an AC reactor or a DC link choke to minimize harmonic distortion.
Three-Phase 200 V / 400 V Class
Figure D.4
L3
L2 Make sure the ground wire is grounded
L1
PE
Enclosure panel
Metal plate
Grounding surface
(remove any paint or sealant)
YEA_common
L3 L2 L1
Drive
Ground plate
(scrape off any visible paint)
Figure D.4 EMC Filter and Drive Installation for CE Compliance (Three-Phase 200 V / 400 V Class)
416 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.2 European Standards
■ EMC Filters
Install the drive with the EMC filters listed below to comply with the EN61800-3/EN12015 requirements.
Note: If the Safe Disable function of the drive is part of the safety concept of a machine or installation and used for a safe stop according
to EN60204-1, stop category 0, use only filters manufactured by Schaffner as listed below. This also applies when using the safe
disable function in one motor contactor installations as described in Safe Disable Input Function on page 427.
Table D.2 EN61800-3 Filters
Filter Data (Manufacturer: Schaffner)
Model Dimensions
CIMR-L Weight
Type Rated Current (A) [W x D x H] YxX Figure
(kg)
(mm)
Three-Phase 200 V Class
2A0018
FS5972-35-07 35 2.1 206 × 50 × 355 175 × 336
2A0025
1
2A0033
FS5972-60-07 60 4.0 236 × 65 × 408 205 × 390
2A0047
2A0060
FS5972-100-35 100 3.4 90 × 150 × 330 65 × 255
2A0075
2A0185
FS5972-170-40 170 6.0 120 × 170 × 451 102 × 365 2
2A0115
2A0145
FS5972-250-37 250 11.7 130 × 240 × 610 90 × 498
2A0180
2A0215
FS5972-410-99 410 10.5 260 × 115 × 386 235 × 120
2A0283
3
2A0346
FS5972-600-99 600 11 260 × 135 × 386 235 × 120
2A0415
Three-Phase 400 V Class
4A0009 FS5972-18-07 18 1.7 141 × 46 × 330 115 × 313
4A0015
4A0018 FS5972-35-07 35 2.1 206 × 50 × 355 175 × 336
4A0024 1
4A0031
4A0039 FS5972-60-07 60 4 236 × 65 × 408 202 × 390
4A0045
4A0060
FS5972-100-35 100 3.4 90 × 150 × 330 65 × 255
4A0075
4A0091
2
4A0112 FS5972-170-35 170 4.7 120 × 170 × 451 102 × 365
4A0150
4A0180 FS5972-250-37 250 11.7 130 × 240 × 610 90 × 498
4A0216
FS5972-410-99 400 10.5 260 × 115× 386 235 × 120 3
4A0260
Standards Compliance
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 417
D.2 European Standards
Figure D.5
PE
Recommended torque: 26 - 30Nm / PE: 15 - 17Nm
L1 L2 L3
LINE
L1 L2 L3
LINE
ZSNFS5972-250-37
ZSN3x480/275V 50/60Hz
250A@45°C 25/100/21
LINE
FS 5972 - 60 - 07
3x480/275VAC 50/60Hz
60A@45°C 25/100/21
MADE IN ........
H
X
X
LOAD
ZSN1234567 / 01 / 0840R
LOAD
L1' L2' L3'
LOAD
L1' L2' L3'
Recommended torque: 26 - 30Nm / PE: 15 - 17Nm
PE
L1
L2
L3
L1
L2
L3 L2 L1
X
LINE
PE
L3 L2 L1
LINE
3x520/300VAC 50/60Hz 600A@45??C 25/100/21
FS 5972 - 600 - 99
HIGH LEAKAGE CURRENT
first connect to earth!
MADE IN SWITZERLAND
R
H
YYWWR
LOAD
X
PE
LOAD
L3' L2' L1'
Y
Drive Side (LOAD)
W
Figure 3
Figure D.5 EMC Filter Dimensions
418 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
M4
–, +1, +2 – 6 (10.6 to 13.3)
2A0033
B1, B2 – 12 to 10
2 to 2.5
8 10 to 8 M5
(17.7 to 22.1)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 419
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
420 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
<1> Drive models CIMR-L 2A0085 to 2A0415 require the use of closed-loop crimp terminals for UL/cUL compliance. Use only the tools
recommended by the terminal manufacturer for crimping.
Note: Use crimp insulated terminals or insulated tubing for wiring these connections. Wires should have a continuous maximum
allowable temperature of 75 °C 600 V UL approved vinyl sheathed insulation. Ambient temperature should not exceed 40 °C.
Table D.4 Wire Gauge and Torque Specifications (Three-Phase 400 V Class)
Model Recommended Gauge Applicable Gauge Screw Tightening Torque
Terminal
CIMR-L AWG, kcmil AWG, kcmil Size Nxm (lb.in.)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 12 14 to 10
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 14 to 10
–, +1, +2 – 14 to 10 1.2 to 1.5
4A0009 M4
(10.6 to 13.3)
B1, B2 – 14 to 10
10 14 to 10
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 10 12 to 6
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 10 12 to 6 1.2 to 1.5
M4
–, +1, +2 – 12 to 6 (10.6 to 13.3)
4A0015
B1, B2 – 12 to 10
2 to 2.5
10 14 to 10 M5
(17.7 to 22.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 10 10 to 6
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 10 10 to 6 1.2 to 1.5
M4
–, +1, +2 – 12 to 6 (10.6 to 13.3)
4A0018
B1, B2 – 12 to 10
2 to 2.5
10 12 to 10 M5
(17.7 to 22.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 8 8 to 6
2 to 2.5
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 8 10 to 6 M5
(17.7 to 22.1)
–, +1, +2 – 10 to 6
4A0024 2 to 2.5
B1, B2 – 10 to 8 M5
(17.7 to 22.1)
4 to 6
8 10 to 8 M6
(35.4 to 53.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 6 8 to 6
2 to 2.5
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 8 8 to 6 M5
(17.7 to 22.1)
–, +1, +2 – 6
4A0031 2 to 2.5
B1, B2 – 10 to 8 M5
(17.7 to 22.1)
4 to 6
6 10 to 6 M6
Standards Compliance
(35.4 to 53.1)
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 6 6 to 4
4 to 6
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 6 6 to 4 M6
(35.4 to 53.1)
–, +1, +2 – 6 to 4
4A0039 2 to 2.5
B1, B2 – 10 to 8 M5
(17.7 to 22.1)
4 to 6
6 8 to 6 M6
(35.4 to 53.1)
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 421
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
4 4 to 2
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 300 2 to 300
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 300 2 to 300
4A0180 18 to 23
–, +1 – 1 to 250 M10
<1> (159 to 204)
+3 – 3 to 3/0
4 4 to 300
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 400 1 to 600
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 400 1/0 to 600
4A0216 18 to 23
–, +1 – 3/0 to 600 M10
<1> (159 to 204)
+3 – 1 to 325
2 2 to 350
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 500 2/0 to 600
32 to 40
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 500 2/0 to 600 M12
(283 to 354)
4A0260 –, +1 – 3/0 to 600
<1> 18 to 23
+3 – 1 to 325 M10
(159 to 204)
32 to 40
2 2 to 350 M12
(283 to 354)
<1> Drive models CIMR-L 4A0045 to 4A0260 require the use of closed-loop crimp terminals for UL/cUL compliance. Use only the tools
recommended by the terminal manufacturer for crimping.
Note: Use crimp insulated terminals or insulated tubing for wiring these connections. Wires should have a continuous maximum
allowable temperature of 75 °C 600 V UL approved vinyl sheathed insulation. Ambient temperature should not exceed 40 °C.
422 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
600 kcmil × 2P
<1> Codes refer to a set of three crimp terminals and three insulation caps. Prepare input and output wiring using two sets for each connection.
Example 1: Models with 300 kcmil for both input and output require one set for input terminals and one set for output terminals, so the user
should order two sets of [100-051-272].
Example 2: Models with 4/0 AWG × 2P for both input and output require two sets for input terminals and two sets for output terminals, so the
user should order four sets of [100-051-560].
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 423
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
CSA B44.1 /
ASME A17.5
Figure D.8 CSA B44.1-04/ASME A17.5-2004 Mark
424 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
When connecting the drive to more than one motor for simultaneous operation, disable the electronic overload protection
(L1-01 = 0) and wire each motor with its own motor thermal overload relay.
Enable the motor overload protection (L1-01 = 1 to 3, 5) when connecting the drive to a single motor, unless another
motor overload preventing device is installed. The drive electronic thermal overload function causes an oL1 fault, which
shuts off the output of the drive and prevents additional overheating of the motor. The motor temperature is continually
calculated while the drive is powered up.
■ L1-02: Motor Overload Protection Time
Setting Range: 0.1 to 5.0 min
Factory Default: 1.0 min
Standards Compliance
Parameter L1-02 determines how long the motor is allowed to operate before the oL1 fault occurs when the drive is
running at 60 Hz and at 150% of the full load amp rating (E2-01/E5-03) of the motor. Adjusting the value of L1-02 can
shift the set of oL1 curves up the y axis of the diagram below, but will not change the shape of the curves.
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 425
D.3 UL and CSA Standards
Figure D.9
Time (min)
10
7
3
Cold Start
1
0.4
Hot Start
426 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.4 Safe Disable Input Function
◆ Specifications
The Safe Disable inputs provide a stop function in compliance with “Safe Torque Off” as defined in the IEC61800-5-2.
Safe Disable inputs have been designed to meet the requirements of the ISO13849-1 Category 3 PLd, and IEC61508,
SIL2.
A Safe Disable Status Monitor for error detection in the safety circuit is also provided.
Inputs / Outputs Two Safe Disable inputs and one EDM output according to ISO13849-1 Cat.3 PLd, IEC61508 SIL2.
Operation Time Time from input open to drive output stop is less than 1 ms.
Demand Rate Low PFD = 5.15E-5
Failure Probability Demand Rate High or
PFH = 1.2E-9
Continuous
The Safe Disable inputs satisfy all requirements of Performance Level (PL) d according to ISO13849-1 (DC from
Performance Level
EDM considered).
Note: Model CIMR-L4A0260 is not compliant with Safety Standard. For more information, contact your nearest Yaskawa
representative or our sales office.
◆ Precautions
DANGER! Sudden Movement Hazard. Improper use of the Safe Disable function will result in serious injury or death. Make sure the
whole system or machinery that the Safe Disable function is used in complies with safety requirements. When implementing the Safe
Disable function into the safety system of a machine, a thorough risk assessment for the whole system has to be carried out to assure
it complies with relevant safety norms (e.g., EN954/ISO13849, IEC61508, EN/IEC62061).
DANGER! Sudden Movement Hazard. When using a PM motor, even if the drive output is shut off by the Safe Disable function, a
break down of two output transistors can cause current to flow through the motor winding, resulting in a rotor movement for a maximum
angle of 180 degrees (electrically). Make sure such a situation would have no effect on the safety of the application when using the
Safe Disable function. Failure to comply will result in death or serious injury.
DANGER! Electrical Shock Hazard.The Safe Disable function can switch off the drive output, but does not cut the drive power supply
and cannot electrically isolate the drive output from the input. Always shut off the drive power supply when performing maintenance or
installations on the drive input side as well as the drive output side. Failure to comply will result in death or serious injury.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. When using the Safe Disable inputs, make sure to remove the wire links between terminals
H1, H2, and HC that were installed prior to shipment. Failing to do so will keep the Safe Disable circuit from operating properly and can
cause injury or even death.
NOTICE: All safety features (including Safe Disable) should be inspected daily and periodically. If the system is not operating normally,
there is a risk of serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Only a qualified technician with a thorough understanding of the drive, the instruction manual, and safety standards should be
permitted to wire, inspect, and maintain the Safe Disable input.
NOTICE: From the moment terminal inputs H1 and H2 have opened, it takes up to 1 ms for drive output to shut off completely. The
sequence set up to trigger terminals H1 and H2 should make sure that both terminals remain open for at least 1 ms in order to properly
interrupt drive output.
NOTICE: The Safe Disable Monitor (output terminals DM+ and DM–) should not be used for any other purpose than to monitor the
Safe Disable status or to discover a malfunction in the Safe Disable inputs. The monitor output is not considered a safe output.
NOTICE: When utilizing the Safe Disable function, use only the EMC filters recommended in EMC Filter Installation on page 415.
Standards Compliance
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 427
D.4 Safe Disable Input Function
Main Power
24 Vdc Control
Safety Relay or PLC HC Circuit
with safety functionality
Safety Jumper S3
Outputs Setting:
Feedback
SOURCE
H1 Gate Block 1
N Power Module P
H2 Gate Block 2
DM+
>=1
DM-
Drive
Motor coasts
Output to stop
Frequency
428 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
D.4 Safe Disable Input Function
Safe Disable Input Status Safe Disable Status Safe Disable Status
Monitor, Monitor, Drive Output Status Digital Operator Display
Input 1, H1-HC Input 2, H2-HC DM+ - DM– H2- = 58
Off Off Off On Safely disabled, “Safe Torque Off” Hbb (flashes)
On Off On On Safely disabled, “Safe Torque Off” HbbF (flashes)
Off On On On Safely disabled, “Safe Torque Off” HbbF (flashes)
On On On Off Baseblock, ready for operation Normal display
Standards Compliance
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 429
D.5 EN81-1 Conform Circuit with one Motor Contactor
Safety Chain
Circuit
Elevator Controller
K01
24 Vdc
K1
Drive H1 H2 HC Up/Down;
Speed selection; ...
K2
M
Note: 1. The drive output will immediately shut off when either of the inputs H1 or H2 is opened. In this case the brake should apply
immediately in order to prevent uncontrolled movement of the elevator.
2. The drive output can only be activated when neither an Up nor a Down command is active, i.e., terminals H1 and H2 must be closed
prior to setting the Up/Down command.
430 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Appendix: E
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 431
E.1 Drive and Motor Specifications
Items Description
Model CIMR-L
Serial Number
Date of Usage
◆ Motor
■ Induction Motor
Manufacturer Resolution
Interface
432 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
E.2 Multi-Function I/O Terminal Settings Record
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 433 E
E.3 User Setting Table
User User
No. Name No. Name
Setting Setting
A1-00 Language Selection C3-22 Motor 2 Slip Compensation Primary Delay Time
A1-01 Access Level Selection C3-23 Motor 2 Slip Compensation Limit
A1-02 Control Method Selection C3-24 Motor 2 Slip Compensation Selection during Regeneration
A1-03 Initialize Parameters C4-01 Torque Compensation Gain
A1-04 Password C4-02 Torque Compensation Primary Delay Time
A1-05 Password Setting C4-03 Torque Compensation at Forward Start
A2-01 to C4-04 Torque Compensation at Reverse Start
User Parameters, 1 to 32
A2-32 C4-05 Torque Compensation Time Constant
A2-33 User Parameter Automatic Selection C4-07 Motor 2 Torque Compensation Gain
b1-01 Speed Reference Selection C5-01 Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain 1
b1-02 Up/Down Command Selection C5-02 Speed Control Loop Integral Time 1
b1-03 Stopping Method Selection C5-03 Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain 2
b1-06 Digital Input Reading C5-04 Speed Control Loop Integral Time 2
b1-08 Up/Down Command Selection while in Programming Mode C5-06 Speed Control Loop Primary Delay Time Constant
b1-14 Phase Order Selection C5-07 Speed Control Loop Settings Switching Speed
b2-08 Magnetic Flux Compensation Value C5-08 Speed Control Loop Integral Limit
b4-01 Timer Function On-Delay Time C5-13 Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain 3
b4-02 Timer Function Off-Delay Time C5-14 Speed Control Loop Integral Time 3
b6-01 Dwell Speed at Start C5-16 Speed Control Loop Delay Time during Position Lock
b6-02 Dwell Time at Start C5-17 Motor Inertia
b6-03 Dwell Speed at Stop C5-18 Load Inertia Ratio
b6-04 Dwell Time at Stop Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain Time during Position
C5-19
b7-01 Droop Control Gain Lock
b7-02 Droop Control Delay Time. C5-20 Speed Control Loop Integral Time during Position Lock
b8-01 Energy Saving Control Selection C5-21 Motor 2 ASR Proportional Gain 1
b8-16 Energy Saving Control Constant (Ki) C5-22 Motor 2 ASR Integral Time 1
b8-17 Energy Saving Control Constant (Kt) C5-23 Motor 2 ASR Proportional Gain 2
C1-01 Acceleration Ramp 1 C5-24 Motor 2 ASR Integral Time 2
C1-02 Deceleration Ramp 1 C5-25 Motor 2 ASR Limit
C1-03 Acceleration Ramp 2 C5-26 Motor 2 ASR Primary Delay Time Constant
C1-04 Deceleration Ramp 2 C5-27 Motor 2 ASR Gain Switching Frequency
C1-05 Acceleration Ramp 3 (Motor 2 Accel Time 1) C5-28 Motor 2 ASR Integral Limit
C1-06 Deceleration Ramp 3 (Motor 2 Decel Time 1) C5-32 Integral Operation during Accel/Decel for Motor 2
C1-07 Acceleration Ramp 4 (Motor 2 Accel Time 2) C5-37 Motor 2 Inertia
C1-08 Deceleration Ramp 4 (Motor 2 Decel Time 2) C5-38 Motor 2 Load Inertia Ratio
C1-09 Emergency Stop Ramp C6-03 Carrier Frequency
C1-10 Accel/Decel Setting Resolution C6-06 PWM Method
C1-11 Accel/Decel Switching Speed C6-09 Carrier Frequency during Rotational Auto-Tuning
C1-12 Motor 2 Acceleration Time C6-21 Inspection Operation Carrier Frequency
C1-13 Motor 2 Deceleration Time C6-23 Carrier Frequency during Initial Motor Pole Search
C1-15 Inspection Deceleration Ramp d1-01 Speed Reference 1
C2-01 Jerk at Accel Start d1-02 Speed Reference 2
C2-02 Jerk at Accel End d1-03 Speed Reference 3
C2-03 Jerk at Decel Start d1-04 Speed Reference 4
C2-04 Jerk at Decel End d1-05 Speed Reference 5
C2-05 Jerk below Leveling Speed d1-06 Speed Reference 6
C3-01 Slip Compensation Gain d1-07 Speed Reference 7
C3-02 Slip Compensation Primary Delay Time d1-08 Speed Reference 8
C3-03 Slip Compensation Limit d1-18 Speed Reference Selection Mode
C3-04 Slip Compensation Selection during Regeneration d1-19 Nominal Speed
C3-05 Output Voltage Limit Operation Selection d1-20 Intermediate Speed 1
C3-21 Motor 2 Slip Compensation Gain d1-21 Intermediate Speed 2
434 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
E.3 User Setting Table
User User
No. Name No. Name
Setting Setting
d1-22 Intermediate Speed 3 F1-05 Encoder 1 Rotation Direction Selection
d1-23 Releveling Speed F1-06 PG 1 Pulse Monitor Output Division Ratio
d1-24 Inspection Operation Speed F1-08 Overspeed Detection Level
d1-25 Rescue Operation Speed F1-09 Overspeed Detection Delay Time
d1-26 Leveling Speed F1-10 Excessive Speed Deviation Detection Level
d1-27 Motor 2 Speed Reference F1-11 Excessive Speed Deviation Detection Delay Time
d1-28 Leveling Speed Detection Level F1-14 PG Open-Circuit Detection Time
d1-29 Inspection Speed Detection Level F1-18 dv3 Detection Selection
d6-03 Field Forcing Selection F1-19 dv4 Detection Selection
d6-06 Field Forcing Limit F1-20 PG Option Card Disconnect Detection 1
E1-01 Input Voltage Setting F1-29 dEv Detection Condition Selection
E1-03 V/f Pattern Selection F1-51 PGoH Detection Level
E1-04 Maximum output speed F1-63 PG-E3 R Track Selection
E1-05 Maximum Voltage F3-01 DI-A3 Option Card Input Selection
E1-06 Base Frequency F3-03 DI-A3 Option Data Length Selection
E1-07 Middle Output Frequency F4-01 Terminal V1 Function Selection
E1-08 Middle Output Frequency Voltage F4-02 Terminal V1 Gain
E1-09 Minimum Output Frequency F4-03 Terminal V2 Function Selection
E1-10 Minimum Output Frequency Voltage F4-04 Terminal V2 Gain
E1-11 Middle Output Frequency 2 F4-05 Terminal V1 Bias
E1-12 Middle Output Frequency Voltage 2 F4-06 Terminal V2 Bias
E1-13 Base Voltage F4-07 Terminal V1 Signal Level Selection
E2-01 Motor Rated Current F4-08 Terminal V2 Signal Level Selection
E2-02 Motor Rated Slip F5-01 Terminal P1-PC Output Selection
E2-03 Motor No-Load Current F5-02 Terminal P2-PC Output Selection
E2-04 Number of Motor Poles F5-03 Terminal P3-PC Output Selection
E2-05 Motor Line-to-Line Resistance F5-04 Terminal P4-PC Output Selection
E2-06 Motor Leakage Inductance F5-05 Terminal P5-PC Output Selection
E2-07 Motor Iron-Core Saturation Coefficient 1 F5-06 Terminal P6-PC Output Selection
E2-08 Motor Iron-Core Saturation Coefficient 2 F5-07 Terminal M1-M2 Output Selection
E2-09 Motor Mechanical Loss F5-08 Terminal M3-M4 Output Selection
E2-10 Motor Iron Loss for Torque Compensation F5-09 DO-A3 Output Mode Selection
E2-11 Motor Rated Power F6-01 Operation Selection after Communications Error
E3-01 Motor 2 Control Mode Selection F6-02 External Fault from Comm. Option Detection Selection
E3-04 Motor 2 Maximum Output Frequency External Fault from Communication Option Operation
F6-03
E3-05 Motor 2 Maximum Voltage Selection
E3-07 Motor 2 Mid Output Frequency F6-06 Torque Limit Selection from Comm. Option
E3-08 Motor 2 Mid Output Frequency Voltage F6-08 Reset Communication Parameter
E3-10 Motor 2 Minimum Output Frequency Voltage F6-36 CANopen Communication Speed
E5-05 Motor Stator Resistance (Single Phase) H2-04 Terminal P1-C1 Function Selection (photocoupler)
E5-06 Motor d-Axis Inductance H2-05 Terminal P2-C2 Function Selection (photocoupler)
F1-02 Operation Selection at PG Open Circuit (PGo) H3-10 Terminal A2 Function Selection
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 435 E
E.3 User Setting Table
User User
No. Name No. Name
Setting Setting
H3-13 Analog Input Filter Time Constant L8-29 Current Unbalance Detection (LF2)
H3-16 Offset for Terminal A1 L8-35 Installation Selection
H3-17 Offset for Terminal A2 L8-38 Automatic Torque Boost Selection
H4-01 Terminal FM Monitor Selection L8-39 Reduced Carrier Frequency
H4-02 Terminal FM Gain L8-55 Internal Braking Transistor Protection
H4-03 Terminal FM Bias L8-62 Operation Selection at Input Phase Loss
H4-04 Terminal AM Monitor Selection L8-77 Oscillation Suppression
H4-05 Terminal AM Gain L8-88 Safe Disable Operation Mode
H4-06 Terminal AM Bias n2-01 Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Gain
H4-07 Terminal FM Signal Level Selection n2-02 Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Time Constant 1
H4-08 Terminal AM Signal Level Selection n2-03 Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Time Constant 2
H5-01 Drive Node Address n5-01 Inertia Compensation Selection
H5-02 Communication Speed Selection n5-02 Motor Acceleration Time
H5-03 Communication Parity Selection n5-03 Inertia Compensation Gain
H5-04 Stopping Method After Communication Error (CE) n5-07 Speed Feedback Compensation Selection
H5-05 Communication Fault Detection Selection n5-08 Speed Feedback Compensation Gain (P)
H5-06 Drive Transmit Wait Time n6-01 Online Tuning Selection
H5-07 RTS Control Selection n6-05 Online Tuning Gain
H5-09 CE Detection Time n8-01 Initial Polarity Estimation Current
H5-10 Unit Selection for MEMOBUS/Modbus Register 0025H n8-02 Pole Attraction Current
H5-11 Communications ENTER Function Selection n8-29 q-Axis Current Control Gain during Normal Operation
L1-01 Motor Overload Protection Selection q-Axis Current Control Integral Time during Normal
n8-30
L1-02 Motor Overload Protection Time Operation
L1-13 Continuous Electrothermal Operation Selection n8-32 d-Axis Current Control Gain during Normal Operation
L2-05 Undervoltage Detection Level (Uv) d-Axis Current Control Integral Time during Normal
n8-33
Operation
L3-01 Stall Prevention Selection during Acceleration
n8-35 Initial Rotor Position Detection Selection
L3-02 Stall Prevention Level during Acceleration
n8-36 High Frequency Injection Level
L3-05 Stall Prevention Selection during Run
n8-37 High Frequency Injection Amplitude
L3-06 Stall Prevention Level during Run
n8-62 Output Voltage Limit
L4-01 Speed Agreement Detection Level
n8-81 High Frequency Injection during Rescue Operation
L4-02 Speed Agreement Detection Width
High Frequency Injection Amplitude during Rescue
L4-03 Speed Agreement Detection Level (+/-) n8-82
Operation
L4-04 Speed Agreement Detection Width (+/-) n8-84 Polarity Detection Current
L4-05 Speed Reference Loss Detection Selection n8-86 Magnet Pole Search Error Detection Selection
L4-06 Speed Reference at Reference Loss n9-60 A/D Conversion Start Delay
L4-13 Door Zone Level o1-01 Drive Mode Unit Monitor Selection
L5-02 Fault Output Operation during Auto Reset o1-02 User Monitor Selection After Power Up
L5-04 Fault Reset Interval Time o1-03 Digital Operator Display Unit Selection
L5-06 Undervoltage Fault Reset Selection o1-04 V/f Pattern Setting Units
L6-01 Torque Detection Selection 1 o1-10 User-Set Display Units Maximum Value
L6-02 Torque Detection Level 1 o1-11 User-Set Display Units Decimal Display
L6-03 Torque Detection Time 1 o1-12 Length Units
L6-04 Torque Detection Selection 2 o1-20 Traction Sheave Diameter
L6-05 Torque Detection Level 2 o1-21 Roping Ratio
L6-06 Torque Detection Time 2 o1-22 Mechanical Gear Ratio
L7-01 Forward Torque Limit o2-01 LO/RE Key Function Selection
L7-02 Reverse Torque Limit o2-02 STOP Key Function Selection
L7-03 Forward Regenerative Torque Limit o2-03 User Parameter Default Value
L7-04 Reverse Regenerative Torque Limit o2-04 Drive Model Selection
L8-02 Overheat Alarm Level o2-05 Speed Reference Setting Method Selection
L8-03 Overheat Pre-Alarm Operation Selection o2-06 Operation Selection when Digital Operator is Disconnected
L8-05 Input Phase Loss Protection Selection o3-01 Copy Function Selection
L8-06 Input Phase Loss Detection Level o3-02 Copy Allowed Selection
L8-07 Output Phase Loss Protection Selection o4-01 Cumulative Operation Time Setting
L8-09 Output Ground Fault Detection Selection o4-02 Cumulative Operation Time Selection
L8-10 Heatsink Cooling Fan Operation Selection o4-03 Cooling Fan Operation Time Setting
L8-11 Heatsink Cooling Fan Off Delay Time o4-05 Capacitor Maintenance Setting
L8-12 Ambient Temperature Setting o4-07 DC Bus Pre-charge Relay Maintenance Setting
L8-15 oL2 Characteristics Selection at Low Speeds o4-09 IGBT Maintenance Setting
L8-27 Overcurrent Detection Gain o4-11 U2, U3 Initialization
436 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
E.3 User Setting Table
User User
No. Name No. Name
Setting Setting
o4-12 kWh Monitor Initialization S5-11 Deceleration Distance
o4-13 Number of Travels Counter Reset S5-12 Stop Distance
o4-15 Maintenance Alarm Snooze Period S5-13 Direct Landing Minimum Speed Level
o4-16 Maintenance Monitoring Selection Motor Contactor Response Error (SE1) Detection/Reset
S6-01
S1-01 Zero Speed Level at Stop Selection
S1-02 DC Injection Current at Start S6-02 Starting Current Error (SE2) Detection Delay Time
S1-03 DC Injection Current at Stop S6-04 Output Current Error (SE3) Detection Delay Time
S1-04 DC Injection Position Lock Time at Start S6-05 Brake Response Error (SE4) Detection Time
S1-05 DC Injection Position Lock Time at Stop S6-10 Overacceleration Detection Level
S1-10 Run Command Delay Time S6-15 Speed Reference Loss Detection
S1-11 Output Contactor Open Delay Time S6-16 Restart after Baseblock Selection
S2-02 Slip Compensation Gain in Motoring Mode T1-01 Auto-Tuning Mode Selection
S2-03 Slip Compensation Gain in Regenerative Mode T1-02 Motor Rated Power
S2-05 Slip Compensation Torque Detection Delay Time T1-03 Motor Rated Voltage
S2-06 Slip Compensation Torque Detection Filter Time Constant T1-04 Motor Rated Current
S3-02 Position Lock Gain at Start 2 (Anti-Rollback Gain) T1-06 Number of Motor Poles
S3-04 Position Lock Bandwidth T1-08 Encoder Resolution (pulses per revolution)
S3-10 Starting Torque Compensation Increase Time T1-09 Motor No-Load Current (Stationary Auto-Tuning 1 and 2)
S3-12 Starting Torque Compensation Bias in Down Direction T1-10 Motor Rated Slip (Stationary Auto-Tuning 2)
S3-14 Torque Compensation Fade Out Speed T2-01 Auto-Tuning Mode Selection
S3-15 Torque Compensation Fade Out Time T2-04 Motor Rated Power
S3-26 DC Injection Gain in Motoring Operation T2-10 Single Phase Stator Resistance
S3-27 Torque Compensation Value with Load Condition 1 T2-11 Motor d-Axis Inductance
S3-28 Torque Compensation Value with Load Condition 2 T2-12 Motor q-Axis Inductance
S3-29 Analog Input from Load Cell with Load Condition 1 T2-13 Induced Voltage Constant Unit Selection
S3-30 Analog Input from Load Cell with Load Condition 2 T2-14 Motor Induced Voltage Constant
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 437 E
Anti-Rollback Integral Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236
Anti-Rollback Movement Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
Anti-Rollback Torque Bias 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236
438 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Capacitor Maintenance Setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229 Control Mode Dependent Parameter Default Values. . . . . . . . .379
Capacitor Maintenance Time (LT-2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 Control Mode Mismatch (CPEr) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
Car Acceleration Rate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377 Control Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28, 98
Carrier Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163, 328, 329 Control Mode Selection Error (oPE06) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Carrier Frequency Derating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332 Control Modes and their Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
Carrier Frequency during Initial Motor Pole Search . . . . . . . . 164 Control Monitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247, 378
Carrier Frequency during Rotational Auto-Tuning . . . . . . . . . 164 Control Power Supply Voltage Fault (Uv2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
CE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257, 270, 389 Control Terminal Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .305
CE Detection Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389 Cooling Fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32, 33, 34
CE Low Voltage Directive Compliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414 Cooling fan. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
CE Mark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414 Cooling Fan Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
CF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257 Cooling Fan Maintenance Time (LT-1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
Changing Parameter Settings or Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 Cooling Fan Operation Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
Checksum Error (ECS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 Cooling Fan Operation Time Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229
Circulation fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Cooling Fan Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
Closed Loop Vector control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Cooling Fan Status (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . . . .196
Closed Loop Vector control for PM motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 CoPy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
CN5-A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35, 316 Copy Allowed Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
CN5-B. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35, 316 Copy Error (ECE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
CN5-C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35, 316 Copy Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
Coast to Stop. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 Copy Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140
Cold Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 Copy Function Errors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
Command Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 Copy Unit Error (CSEr) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
Command Messages from Master to Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392 CopyUnitManager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140
Communication Error (iFEr) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 CPEr . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
Communication Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409 CPF00, CPF01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
Communication Fault Detection Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389 CPF02. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
Communication Option Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 CPF03. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Communication Option Node ID Setting Error CPF06. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
(CANopen) (AEr). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 CPF07. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Communication Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 CPF08. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Communication Parity Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388 CPF20, CPF21 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Communication Speed Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388 CPF22. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Communications Enter Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390 CPF23. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Communications Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392 CPF24. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Comparing Parameter Settings (flashing) (vrFy) . . . . . . . . . . . 282 CPF26 to CPF34 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Complementary PG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 CPyE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
Component Names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 CRC-16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .393
Connecting a DC Link Choke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 CRC-16 Checksum Calculation Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
Connecting a Noise Filter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 CrST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Connecting a Suppression Diode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 CSEr . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
Connecting a Surge Absorber. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 Cumulative Fan Operation Time as a Percentage
Connecting an AC Reactor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321 of the Specified Maintenance Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
Connecting Braking Units in Parallel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319 Cumulative Operation Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
Connecting Peripheral Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315 Cumulative Operation Time of the Fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
Connecting the Drive and Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 Cumulative Operation Time Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
Connecting to a Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386 Cumulative Time the Capacitors are Used as
Connecting to a PC (USB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 a Percentage of the Specified Maintenance Period . . . . . . . . . .291
Continuous Electrothermal Operation Selection . . . . . . . . . . . 204 Current Detection Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Control Board Connection Error (CPF03) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 Current Detection Error (Er-12). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
Control Board Connection Error (CPF23) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 Current Unbalance Detection (LF2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Control Circuit Error (CPF00, CPF01) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257 Cyclic Redundancy Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .393
Control Circuit Error (CPF20, CPF21) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 D
Control Circuit Error (CPF26 to CPF34) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
d-Axis Current Control Gain during Normal
Control Circuit Input Terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Control Circuit Output Terminals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
d-Axis Current Control Integral Time
Control Circuit Terminal Arrangement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
during Normal Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Control Circuit Terminal Block Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Daily Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
Control Circuit Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Daily Inspection Checklist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
Control Dial for Frequency Setting Potentiometer. . . . . . . . . . 313
Data Error (ErE). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Control Fault (CF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
DC Bus Overvoltage (ov) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265, 272
Control Method Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 439
DC Bus Pre-charge Relay Maintenance Setting. . . . . . . . . . . . 229 Drive Short-Circuit Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .424
DC Bus Undervoltage (Uv1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191, 267 Drive Slave Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .388
DC Bus Voltage during Rescue Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 Drive Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
DC Injection Current at Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 Drive Standard Connection Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
DC Injection Current at Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 Drive Transmit Wait Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
DC Injection Gain in Motoring Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Drive Unit Signal Fault (CPF24) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
DC Injection Gain in Regenerative Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Drive Watt Loss Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
DC Injection Time at Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 DriveWizard Plus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140, 314
DC Injection Time at Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Droop Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
DC Link Choke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313 During Baseblock (N.C.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194
Deceleration Ramps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 During Baseblock (N.O.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .191
Defaults and Setting Ranges by Display Unit Selection During Down Direction (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . .194
(o1-03) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382 During Frequency Output (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . .195
Defaults by Drive Model Selection (o2-04). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380 During Regeneration (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . .194
dEv . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259, 270 During Run . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
dEv Detection Condition Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 During Torque Limit (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . .195
dFPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 dv1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
DI-A3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 dv2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
DI-A3 Option Card Data Length Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 dv3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
DI-A3 Option Card Input Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 dv3 Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
DI-A3 Option Card Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 dv4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
Diagnosing and Resetting Faults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 dv4 Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
Digital Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69, 314 dv6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
Digital Input Card Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 dv7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Digital Input Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 dv8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Digital Input Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 Dwell Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
Digital Input Sink / Source / External Power Supply Dwell Speed, Dwell Time at Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Dynamic Braking Transistor Fault (rr) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Digital Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31, 34, 85 E
Digital operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 33
E (G) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Digital Operator Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
E-Type Insulation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
Digital Operator Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429
E3-01 (Motor 2 Control Mode) Dependent Parameters . . . . . .379
Digital Operator Installation Methods and Required Tools . . . . 42
ECE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
Digital Operator Menu and Screen Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
ECS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
Digital Operator Remote Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
EdE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
Digital Operator Remote Usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
EEPROM Memory Data Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Digital Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
EEPROM Write Error (Err) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Digital Output Card Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
EF. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Dimensions for IP20/NEMA Type 1 Enclosure
EF0. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260, 270
200 V Class . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44, 45
EF3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260, 270
DIP Switch S2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35, 74, 78, 387
EF4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260, 270
Disabling and Enabling the Drive Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 428
EF5. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260, 270
DM+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
EF6. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260, 270
DM- . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
EF7. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260, 270
DO-A3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
EF8. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260, 270
DO-A3 Option Card Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
EiF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Door Zone Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Electric Leakage Circuit Breaker (ELCB). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
Door Zone Reached . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Electrical Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
Drive Capacity Setting Fault (oPE01) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Elevator Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
Drive Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
Elevator units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
Drive Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 33, 34
EMC Filter and Drive Installation for CE Compliance . . . . . . .416
Drive Derating Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
EMC Filter Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .415
Drive Does Not Allow Selection of Rotational
EMC Filters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .417
Auto-Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
EMC Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .414
Drive Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90, 91
EMC Guidelines Compliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .415
Drive Model Mismatch (dFPS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
Emergency Stop (N.O., N.C.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
Drive Model Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Emergency Stop Ramp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Drive Motor Overload Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425
Emergency Stop Sequence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
Drive Overload (oL2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264
EN61800-3 C2 Filters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .417
Drive Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
EN81-1 Conform Circuit with one Motor Contactor. . . . . . . . .430
Drive Ready . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Encoder 1 Resolution. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Drive Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
440 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Encoder 1 Rotation Derection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 Excessive Speed Deviation Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
Encoder Communication Data Error (oFC53) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 Excessive V/f Setting (End1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .276
Encoder Communication Timeout (oFC52) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 Exterior and Mounting Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Encoder Disconnected (PGo) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266, 272 External 24 Vdc Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Encoder Disconnected (PGoH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266, 273 External Digital Operator Connection Fault (oPr). . . . . . . . . . .265
Encoder Error (oFC54). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 External fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186
Encoder Feedback Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 External Fault (input terminal S3) (EF3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260, 270
Encoder Offset Auto-Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103, 106 External Fault (input terminal S4) (EF4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260, 270
Encoder Offset for PM motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 External Fault (input terminal S5) (EF5) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260, 270
Encoder Option AD Conversion Error (oFC50) . . . . . . . . . . . 263 External Fault (input terminal S6) (EF6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260, 270
Encoder Option Analog Circuit Error (oFC51) . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 External Fault (input terminal S7) (EF7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260, 270
Encoder Resolution Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 External Fault (input terminal S8) (EF8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260, 270
Encoder Rotation Direction Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 External Fault from Communication Option Detection
Encoder Setup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
Encoder Z Pulse Fault (dv1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 F
Encoder Z-Pulse Offset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
F-Type Insulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
End . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
Fan Connector Cable (CN6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .301
End1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Fan Cover. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
End10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Fan finger guard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31, 32, 33, 34, 302
End2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Fan Relay Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .301
End3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Fan Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .301
End4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Fan unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
End5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Fan Unit Case. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
End6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Fault (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
End7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Fault Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253
End8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Fault History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247, 375
End9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Fault Output Operation during Auto Restart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208
Energy Saving Control Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Fault Relay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Energy Savings Constants Error (oPE16) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
Fault Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
Enter Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
Fault Reset Command Active (Multi-Function Digital
Enter Command Necessary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390
Outputs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
Enter Command not Necessary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390
Fault Reset Methods. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
Enter Command Settings when Upgrading the Drive . . . . . . . 408
fault restart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
Enter Command Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
Fault Trace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247, 374
Enter Data from the Motor Nameplate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Fault Trace / History Register Contents. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .406
Entering the "Safe Torque Off" State . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 428
Fault Trace Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .406
EPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
Faults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252, 253
Er-01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Ferrule Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Er-02 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Ferrule Terminal Types and Sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Er-03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Ferrule-Type Wire Terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Er-04 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Field Forcing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
Er-05 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Flux Position Detection (sensor) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .378
Er-08 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
FM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Er-09 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Formula to Calculate the Amount of Voltage Drop . . . . . . . . . . .62
Er-10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Forward Regenerative Torque Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
Er-11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Forward Torque Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
Er-12 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Frequency Accuracy (Temperature Fluctuation) . . . . . . . . . . . .330
Er-13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Frequency Control Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
Er-18 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Frequency Meter / Ammeter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
Er-19 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Frequency Meter Potentiometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
Er-20 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Frequency Reference Selection 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Er-21 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Frequency Setting Potentiometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
Er-22 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Frequency Setting Resolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
Er-23 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Frequency Setting Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
ErE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
FrL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261
Err . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Front Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32, 33, 34
Error Reading Data (rdEr) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
Front cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Error Writing Data (CPyE). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
Front Cover Screw . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Errors and Displays When Using the Copy Function . . . . . . . 256
Front cover screw. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32, 33
European Standards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414
Function Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .393
EvE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
Function Key (F1, F2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Excessive Speed Deviation Detection Delay Time . . . . . . . . . 178
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 441
Function Key 1 (F1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Input Noise Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
Function Key 2 (F2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Input Phase Loss (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . . . . .196
Functions for Terminals S3 to S8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Input Phase Loss (PF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Fuse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313, 324 Input Phase Loss Protection Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
Fuse Holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324 Input Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .328, 329
G Input Voltage Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Input-Side Noise Filter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .322
General Precautions when Using Thermal Overload Relays . . 325
Inspection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289, 290
General Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Inspection Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
GF. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Inspection Operation Carrier Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Ground Fault (GF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Inspection Operation Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Ground Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Inspection Operation Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
Ground Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Inspection Speed Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
H Installation Environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
H1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Installation Method Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
H1/H2 Sink/Source Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Installation Orientation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
H2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Installation Orientation and Spacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Hbb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 Installation Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
HbbF. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 Installation Spacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
HC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Installing a Braking Unit: CDBR Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
HCA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 Installing a Magnetic Contactor at the Power Supply Side . . . .320
Heatsink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31, 32, 33, 34 Installing a Molded Case Circuit Breaker (MCCB) . . . . . . . . .320
Heatsink Cooling Fan Operation Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Installing a Motor Thermal Overload (oL) Relay . . . . . . . . . . .325
Heatsink Overheat (oH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264, 272 Installing Peripheral Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
Heatsink Overheat (oH1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 Installing the Cooling Fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296, 298, 304
Heatsink Temperature. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376 Intermediate Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
High Current Alarm (HCA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 Internal Braking Transistor Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
High Frequency Injection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Inversion Detection (dv3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
High Frequency Injection Amplitude. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 Inversion Prevention Detection (dv4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
High Frequency Injection Amplitude IP00 enclosure with top protective cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
during Rescue Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 IP20 Enclosure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
High Frequency Injection during Rescue Operation . . . . . . . . 222 Isolator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
High Frequency Injection Level. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
J
High Speed Limit Down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Jerk at Accel End . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156
High Speed Limit Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Jerk at Accel Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156
High Speed Reference Has Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Jerk at Decel End . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156
Hot Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Jerk at Decel Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156
Humidity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Jerk below Leveling Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156
Hybrid IC Failure (CPF22) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
Jerk Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156
I Jumper S3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35, 74, 76
ID Mismatch (EPE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 Jumper S5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
iFEr. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
K
IG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Keys and Displays on the Digital Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
IGBT Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376
kWh . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
IGBT Maintenance Setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
kWh Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
IGBT Maintenance Time (90%) (LT-4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
kWh Monitor Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
IGBT Maintenance Time (90%) (TrPC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Induced Noise. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323 L
Induced Voltage Constant Unit Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Language Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Inductance Error (Er-19) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 LCD Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86
Induction Voltage Error (Er-18) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 LCD Operator
Inertia Compensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122, 217 Display Unit Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Inertia Compensation Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 Monitor Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Inertia Compensation Gain. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Leakage Inductance Alarm (End6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .276
Initial Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Leakage Inductance Error (Er-13) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
Initial Polarity Estimation Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 LED Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
Initial Rotor Pole Search Error (Er-22) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 LED Operator
Initial Rotor Position Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Display Unit Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Monitor Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Initialize Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139, 143, 227 Leveling Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
Input Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328, 329 Leveling Speed Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
Input Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324, 414 Leveling Speed Reference Has Priority. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
442 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
LF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261 MEMOBUS/Modbus Data Table. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
LF2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261 MEMOBUS/Modbus Error Codes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .409
Light Load Direction (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . 196 MEMOBUS/Modbus Self Test Failed (SE). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Light Load Direction Search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 MEMOBUS/Modbus Setup Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .388
Light Load Direction Search Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 MEMOBUS/Modbus Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .385
Line Driver PG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 MEMOBUS/Modbus Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
Line-to-Line Resistance Error (Er-04) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 MEMOBUS/Modbus Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
LO/RE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88, 95 Menu Structure for Digital Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
LO/RE (LOCAL/REMOTE) Key Function Selection . . . . . . . 226 Message Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .393
LO/RE LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 Meter Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
LO/RE Light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 Minimum Wait Time for Sending Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392
Load Inertia Ratio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Minor Fault (Multi-Function Digital Outputs). . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
LOCAL. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Minor Fault and Alarm Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
Locations of Jumpers and Switches on the Terminal Board . . . 74 Minor Faults and Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252, 254
Loopback Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395 Model Number and Nameplate Check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29
Low Voltage Directive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414 Model, Voltage Class, Capacity Mismatch (ndAT) . . . . . . . . . .281
Low Voltage Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424 Modes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
Low Voltage Wiring for Control Circuit Terminals . . . . . . . . . 424 Molded Case Circuit Breaker. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
LT-1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271, 292 Monitor Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398
LT-2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271, 292 Monitor Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
LT-3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271, 292 Monitor Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
LT-4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271, 292 Motor 2 Base Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
M Motor 2 Leakage Inductance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
Motor 2 Line-to-Line Resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
M1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Motor 2 Max Output Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
M2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Motor 2 Max Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
M3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Motor 2 Mid Output Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
M4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Motor 2 Mid Output Frequency Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
M5. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Motor 2 Minimum Output Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
M6. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Motor 2 Minimum Output Frequency Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
MA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Motor 2 Motor Poles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Magnet Pole Search Error Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
Motor 2 Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Magnetic Contactor (Input) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
Motor 2 Rated Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Magnetic Flux Compensation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Motor 2 Rated No-Load Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Magnetic Flux Compensation Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Motor 2 Rated Slip. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
Main Circuit Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55, 68
Motor 2 Slip Compensation Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
Main Circuit Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Motor 2 Slip Compensation Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
Main Circuit Terminal and Motor Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Motor 2 Slip Compensation Primary Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . .159
Main Circuit Terminal Block Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Motor 2 Speed Reference. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
Main Circuit Terminal Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Motor 2 Torque Compensation Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Main Circuit Terminal Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Motor Acceleration Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
Main Circuit Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Motor Base Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291, 292
Motor Base Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Maintenance Alarms. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Motor Contactor Feedback. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
Maintenance Monitor Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
Motor Contactor Responce Error (SE1) Detection/Reset
Maintenance Monitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247, 376
Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
Maintenance Period (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . . 195
Motor Contactor Response Error (SE1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Maintenance Period Reached by the IGBTs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
Motor d-Axis Inductance for PM motors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
Max. Current during Leveling Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377
Motor Data Error (Er-01) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277
Max. Motor Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Motor Direction Error (Er-10) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
Maximum Applicable Motor Capacity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328, 329
Motor Does Not Rotate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Maximum Output Speed. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328, 329
Motor Induction Voltage Constant 1 for PM motors . . . . . . . . .176
Maximum Output Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328, 329
Motor Induction Voltage Constant 2 for PM motors . . . . . . . . .176
MB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Motor Inertia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
MC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Motor Iron Loss for Torque Compensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
Measuring Acceleration Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Motor Iron-Core Saturation Coefficient (End2) . . . . . . . . . . . .276
Mechanical Gear Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Motor Iron-Core Saturation Coefficient 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
Mechanical Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Motor Iron-Core Saturation Coefficient 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
MEMOBUS/Modbus Comm. Test Mode Complete (PASS) . . 272
Motor is Too Hot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communication. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Motor Leakage Inductance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communication Error (CE). . . . . . 257, 270
Motor Line-to-Line Resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383
Motor Mechanical Loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 443
Motor No-Load Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111, 171 oFA12 to oFA17. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
Motor Overload (oL1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 oFA30 to oFA43. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
Motor Overload Protection Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202, 425 oFb00 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
Motor Overload Protection Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203, 425 oFb01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
Motor Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 oFb02 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Motor Pole Search Status (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . 196 oFb03 to oFb11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Motor Poles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 oFb12 to oFb17 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Motor Poles for Induction Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 oFC00. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Motor Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 oFC01. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Motor q-Axis Inductance for PM motors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 oFC02. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Motor Rated Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110, 170, 425 oFC03 to oFC11. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Motor Rated Current for PM motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 oFC12 to oFC17. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Motor Rated Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110, 172 oFC50. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Motor Rated Power for PM motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 oFC51. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Motor Rated Slip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111, 170 oFC52. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Motor Rated Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 oFC53. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264
Motor Rotation Direction Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 oFC54. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264
Motor Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 oH. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264, 272
Motor Speed Fault (Er-11) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 oH1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264
Motor Stator Resistance for PM motors (Single Phase). . . . . . 175 oL1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264
Motor Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 oL1 Curves. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .426
Mounting Hole . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 34 oL2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264
Mounting hole . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31, 33 oL2 Characteristics Selection at Low Speeds . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Multi-function Analog Input Selection Error (oPE07) . . . . . . 274 oL3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265, 272
Multi-Function Analog Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 oL4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265, 272
Multi-Function Analog Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Online Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
Multi-function Digital Input Selection Error (oPE03) . . . . . . . 274 Online Tuning Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
Multi-Function Digital Input Terminal Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . 184 oPE01. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Multi-Function Digital Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 oPE02. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Multi-Function Digital Output Terminal Settings . . . . . . . . . . 188 oPE03. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Multi-Function Digital Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 oPE04. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Multi-Function Photocoupler Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 oPE04 Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Multi-Function Relay Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 oPE05. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Multi-Function Terminal Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 oPE06. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Multi-Speed Inputs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 oPE07. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Multi-Speed References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 oPE08. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Multiple Connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386 oPE10. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Multiple Drive Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 oPE16. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
N oPE18. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
oPE20. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Nameplate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Open Loop Vector Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
Navigating the Drive and Programming Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Operation Error Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
ndAT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
Operation Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252, 255
Network Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
Operation Selection after Communications Error . . . . . . . . . . .182
No-Load Current Alarm (End7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Operation Selection at Deviation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
No-Load Current Error (Er-05) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Operation Selection at Overspeed (oS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Noise From the Drive or Output Lines When the Drive
Operation Selection at PG Open Circuit (PGo) . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
is Powered On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Operation Selection when Digital Operator is Disconnected . .227
Nominal Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Operation Status Monitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247, 372
Non-rotating Encoder Offset Tuning Warning (Er-23) . . . . . . 279
Operator Function Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Not Zero Speed (Multi-Function Digital Outputs). . . . . . . . . . 196
Operator Programming Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Notes on Motor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
oPr . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
Number of Auto Reset Attempts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
Number of Motor Poles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Option Card Connection Error at Option Connector CN5-A (oFA00)262
Number of PM Motor Poles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Option Card Connection Error at Option Port
Number of Travels Counter Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
CN5-C (oFC00) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
O Option Card Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
oC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261 Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port CN5-A
oFA00 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 (oFA05, oFA06, oFA10, oFA11, oFA12 to oFA17,
oFA01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 oFA30 to oFA43) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
oFA05, oFA06 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port CN5-B
oFA10, oFA11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 (oFb03 to oFb11, oFb12 to oFb17) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
444 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port CN5-C PASS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
(oFC03 to oFC11, oFC12 to oFC17) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140
Option Card External Fault (EF0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260, 270 Password Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144
Option Card Fault at Option Connector CN5-A (oFA01) . . . . 262 Password Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140
Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-B (oFb00). . . . . . . . . . 262 Performance Life Monitors Maintenance Monitors. . . . . . . . . .291
Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-B (oFb01). . . . . . . . . . 262 Performance Life of the Inrush Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-B (oFb02). . . . . . . . . . 263 Periodic Inspection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290
Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-C (oFC01) . . . . . . . . . 263 Periodic Inspection Checklist. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290
Option Card Fault at Option Port CN5-C (oFC02) . . . . . . . . . 263 Periodic Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
Option Card Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316 Peripheral Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .309, 313
Option Communication Error (bUS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257, 269 PF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Option Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 PF5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Optional 24 V DC power supply connector cover . . 31, 32, 33, 34 PG Feedback Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 PG Number of Pulses Per Revolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
oS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265, 272 PG Number of Pulses Per Revolution for PM Motor
Output Contactor Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Output Contactor Open Delay Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 PG Open-Circuit Detection Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Output Current Error (SE3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 PG Option Card Disconnect Detection 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179
Output Current Error (SE3) Detection Delay Time . . . . . . . . . 245 PG-B3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
Output Current Imbalance (LF2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261 PG-E3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
Output Ground Fault Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 PG-F3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
Output Noise Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313 PG-X3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
Output Phase Loss (LF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261 PG1 Pulse Monitor Output Division Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .178
Output Phase Loss Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 PGo. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266, 272
Output Speed Resolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 PGoH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266, 273
Output Terminal FM Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 PGoH Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179
Output Voltage Detection Error (voF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268, 273 Phase Order Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Output Voltage Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 PM Motor Auto-Tuning Mode Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Output Voltage Limit Operation Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 PM Motor Base Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Output Voltage Meter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313 PM Motor Control Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
Output-Side Noise Filter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323 PM Motor d-Axis Inductance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
ov . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265, 272 PM Motor Induced Voltage Constant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Overacceleration Detection (dv6). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 PM Motor q-Axis Inductance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Overacceleration Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 PM Motor Rated Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Overacceleration Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 PM Motor Rated Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Overacceleration Detection Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 PM Motor Rated Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Overcurrent (oC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261 PM Motor Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
Overcurrent Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 PM Motor Stator Resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Overheat Alarm Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 PM Rotor Position Estimation Error (dv8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Overheat Pre-Alarm Operation Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Polarity Detection Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222
Overload Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330, 425 Port CN19 cover. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31, 32, 33, 34
Overload Tolerance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328, 329 Position Deviation Level to Apply Torque Bias 1 . . . . . . . . . . .236
Overload Tolerance for Internal Braking Transistor . . . . . . . . 215 Position Deviation Level to Apply Torque Bias 2 . . . . . . . . . . .236
Overspeed (oS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265, 272 Position Lock Completion Width. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
Overspeed Detection Delay Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 Position Lock Deviation Counter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .378
Overspeed Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 Position Lock Error (SvE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Overtorque Detection 1 (oL3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265, 272 Position Lock Gain at Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Overtorque Detection 2 (oL4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265, 272 Position Lock Gain at Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Overvoltage Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 Position Lock Time at Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
P Position Lock Time at Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
Power On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
P1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Power Ratings (Three-Phase 200 V Class) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .328
P2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Power Ratings (Three-Phase 400 V Class) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
Parameter Access Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Preface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
Parameter List. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335
Preparing the Ends of Shielded Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Parameter Range Setting Error (oPE02). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Preventing Induced Noise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
Parameter Selection Error (oPE08) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
Programming Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90, 91
Parameter Setting Error, Online Tuning Parameter Setting Error (oPE18)
Protection Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
275
PWM Method. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Parameter Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Parameter Settings in the Drive and Those Saved to Q
the Copy Function are not the Same (vFyE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 q-Axis Current Control Integral Time during Normal
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 445
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 Rotational Auto-Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
R rr. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
RS-422 Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .387
R+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
RS-422/485 Termination Resistor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
R- . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
RS-485 Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386
R/L1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
RTS Control Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .389
Radiated Noise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
Rubber bushing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Ramp to Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Run Command Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
Rated Current Setting Alarm (End3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
RUN LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
Rated Frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328, 329
RUN LED and Drive Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
Rated Output Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328, 329
RUN LED Status and Meaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
Rated Output Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328, 329
RUN Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Rated Slip Error (Er-08) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Rated Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328, 329 S
rdEr. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 S+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
rEAd . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 S- . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
Reading Drive MEMOBUS/Modbus Register Contents . . . . . 395 S/L2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Reading Parameter Settings (flashing) (rEAd). . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 S1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Reattaching the Digital Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 S2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Reattaching the Front Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 S3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Reattaching the Terminal Cover. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 S4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Reattaching the Terminal Cover on a NEMA Type 1 S5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Enclosure Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 S6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Reattaching the Terminal Cover on an IP00 Enclosure Drive . . 58 S7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Reattaching the Top Protective Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 S8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Reduced Carrier Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 Safe Disable Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
Reducing Radiated and Radio Frequency Noise . . . . . . . . . . . 324 Safe Disable Circuit Fault Signal Input (HbbF) . . . . . . . . . . . .271
Reference Source Selection Error (oPE05) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 Safe Disable Function Wiring Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
Releveling Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Safe Disable Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
REMOTE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Safe Disable Input Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .427
Remote Operator Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Safe Disable Input Sink / Source / External Power Supply
Removing the Digital Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Removing the Fan Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 Safe Disable Monitor Output Function and Digital
Removing the Front Cover. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Operator Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .429
Removing the Terminal Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Safe Disable Signal Input (Hbb) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
Removing the Terminal Cover on a NEMA Type 1 Safe Disable Status (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . . .196
Enclosure Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Safe Disable Status Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .429
Removing the Terminal Cover on an IP00 Enclosure Safe Torque Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
Drive. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Safety Hazard Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
Removing the Top Protective Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 Safety Monitor Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Replacing the Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 Safety Standard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
Rescue Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123, 237 SC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Rescue Operation Power Supply Deterioration SE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 SE1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Rescue Operation Power Supply Deterioration Error (PF5) . . 266 SE1 Detection/Reset Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
Rescue Operation Power Supply Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 SE2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Rescue Operation Rotor Polarity Detection Warning (End10) 277 SE2 Detection Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
Rescue Operation Rotor Pole Position Search Warning (End9) 277 SE3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Rescue Operation Speed. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 SE3 Detection Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
Rescue Operation Speed Warning (End8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 SE4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Rescue Operation Torque Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133, 238 SE4 Detection Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
Reset Communication Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Self-Diagnosing Function of the Serial Communication
Resistance Tuning Error (End5). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276 Interface Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .410
Response Messages from Drive to Master. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392 Self-Diagnostics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .410
Restart after Baseblock Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 Separate Speed Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Restart Enabled (Multi-Function Digital Outputs). . . . . . . . . . 194 Serial Communication Stand By (CALL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Returning to Normal Operation after Safe Disable . . . . . . . . . 429 Serial Communication Terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
Reverse Regenerative Torque Limit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Serial Communications Cable Connection Terminals
Reverse Torque Limit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 (TB5) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386
rollback. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Serial Communications Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .387
Roping Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Serial Communications Terminal and DIP Switch S2. . . . . . . .387
446 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Setting Motor Parameters Manually. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Speed Reference Bias. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199
Setting Sink/Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Speed Reference Loss Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246
Setup Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Speed Reference Loss Detection Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
Setup Group Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Speed Reference Missing (FrL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246, 261
Setup Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Speed Reference Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114, 148
Setup Procedure for Elevator Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Speed Reference Selection Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Setup Troubleshooting and Possible Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Speed Reference Setting Method Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .227
Shielded Twisted-Pair Cables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Speed Reference Unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Short Floor Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 Speed Response . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28, 330
SI-S3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Speed Selection Using Digital Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
Simplified Setup Using the Setup Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Stall Prevention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
Sinking Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Stall Prevention During Acceleration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
Sinking Mode (NPN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Stall Prevention Selection during Acceleration . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
Sinking/Sourcing Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Stall Prevention Selection during Run . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
Slave Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393 Standard Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
Slip Compensation for Elevators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Start-Up Flowcharts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
Slip Compensation Gain. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Starting Current Error (SE2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Slip Compensation Gain in Motoring Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Starting Current Error (SE2) Detection Delay Time . . . . . . . . .245
Slip Compensation Gain in Regenerative Mode . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Starting Torque. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28, 330
Slip Compensation Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Starting Torque Compensation Increase Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
Slip Compensation Primary Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Stationary Auto-Tuning 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Slip Compensation Selection during Regeneration . . . . . . . . . 158 Stationary Auto-Tuning 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Slip Compensation Torque Detection Delay Time. . . . . . . . . . 233 Stationary Auto-Tuning for Line-to-Line Resistance . . . . . . . .104
Slip Compensation Torque Detection Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Stator Resistance Error (Er-20) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
Slip Compensation Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377 Status Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
SN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69, 75 STOP Button Input (Er-03) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277
Soft Charge Bypass Relay Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376 STOP Key Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
Soft Charge Bypass Relay Maintenance Time (LT-3) . . . . . . . 271 Stopping Method after Communication Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . .388
Soft-Charge Bypass Circuit Fault (Uv3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 Stopping Method Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149
Software version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Storage Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Sourcing Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Surge Protector. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
Sourcing Mode (PNP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 SvE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
SP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69, 75 Switched Phase Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327 Switches and Jumpers on the Terminal Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Speed Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Switching Between LOCAL and REMOTE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95
Speed agree 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 T
Speed Agree 1 Time Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
T/L3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Speed agree 2 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Task Complete (End) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Speed Agreement Detection Level. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Temperature Derating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
Speed Control Accuracy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330
Terminal A1 Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .197
Speed Control Loop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Terminal A1 Gain. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .197
Speed Control Loop Delay Time during Position Lock . . . . . . 163
Terminal A1 Signal Level Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .197
Speed Control Loop Integral Time during Position Lock . . . . 163
Terminal A2 Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Terminal A2 Gain. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
Speed Control Loop Proportional Gain Time
Terminal A2 Signal Level Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
during Position Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Terminal AM Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200
Speed Control Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28, 330
Terminal AM Monitor Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200
Speed Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Terminal AM Signal Level Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201
Speed Detection 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Terminal Block Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Speed Detection 1 Time Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Terminal Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32, 33, 34, 35
Speed Detection 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Terminal board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Speed Detection 2 Time Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Terminal Board Connection Error (CPF07, CPF08) . . . . . . . . .258
Speed Detection 3 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs). . . . . . . . 193
Terminal Board Connector. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Speed Detection 4 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs). . . . . . . . 193
Terminal Board Mismatch Error (oPE04) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
Speed Detection PG1 Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378
Terminal Board Wiring Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Speed Deviation (dEv) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259, 270
Terminal Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Gain . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Terminal Connections for Communication
Speed Feedback Detection Control (AFR) Time
Self-Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .410
Constant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Terminal Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32, 33, 34, 57
Speed Loop Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Terminal cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Speed Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90, 165
Terminal cover screw . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Speed Reference at Reference Loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 447
Terminal FM Monitor Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Jerk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382
Terminal FM Signal Level Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 Speed Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382
Terminal Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Unit Selection for MEMOBUS/Modbus Register 0025H . . . . .389
Terminal M1-M2 Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 Up/Down Command Error (EF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Terminal M3-M4 Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 Up/Down Command Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149
Terminal M5-M6 Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 Up/Down Command Selection while in Programming Mode. .150
Terminal P1-C1 Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 Up/Down Command Source Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Terminal P1-C2 Function Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 UPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
Test Run . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106, 107, 108, 109 UPS Operation Speed Limit Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
Through mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185, 192, 200 UPS Power. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
Tightening Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62, 71 USB Copy Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140, 314
Timer Function On-Delay Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 USB Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Timer Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 USB port (type-B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31, 32, 33, 34
Top Protective Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 User Monitor Selection after Power Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Top protective cover. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31, 32, 33 User Parameter Automatic Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139, 147
Top Protective Cover to Prevent Miswiring. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 User Parameter Default Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139, 227
Torque Compensation (Multi-Function Analog Inputs). . . . . . 199 User Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139, 147
Torque Compensation at Forward Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 User Parameters 1 to 32 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139
Torque Compensation at Reverse Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 User Set Speed Agree 1 Time Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
Torque Compensation Fade Out Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 User-Set Display Units Decimal Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
Torque Compensation Fade Out Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 User-Set Display Units Maximum Value. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
Torque Compensation Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 User-Set Speed Agree 1 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . .190
Torque Compensation Time Constant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 User-Set Speed Agree 2 (Multi-Function Digital Outputs) . . . .193
Torque Compensation Value with Load Condition 1 . . . . . . . . 235 Using a PM Motor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Torque Compensation Value with Load Condition 2 . . . . . . . . 235 Using Braking Units in Parallel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
Torque Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 Using the Safe Disable Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .428
Torque Detection 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 Uv. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Torque Detection 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 Uv1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Torque Detection Selection 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 Uv2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Torque Detection Selection 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 Uv3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .268
Torque Limit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211, 330 V
Torque Limit Reduction Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
V/f Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
Torque Limit Selection from
V/f Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
Communications Option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
V/f Pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
V/f Pattern for Motor 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Torque Specifications, Three Phase 200 V Class. . . . . . . . 63, 419
V/f Pattern Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Torque Specifications, Three Phase 400 V Class. . . . . . . . 64, 421
V/f Pattern Setting Error (oPE10) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Traction Sheave Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
V/T2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Travel Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
vAEr. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Travel Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Verify Error (EvE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
TrPC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273, 292
Verify Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
Tuning Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Verifying Parameter Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
Types of Alarms, Faults, and Errors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
vFyE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Types of Auto-Tuning for Induction Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Vibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Types of Auto-Tuning for Permanent Magnet Motors. . . 105, 106
Viewing Fault Trace Data After Fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
U voF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .268, 273
U/T1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Voltage Class, Capacity Mismatch (vAEr) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
U2, U3 Initialization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229 vrFy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282
UL and CSA Standards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419 W
UL/cUL Mark. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419
W/T3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
UL3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267, 273
Warranty Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
UL4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267, 273
Watt Loss 200 V Class Three Phase Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
Undertorque Detection 1 (UL3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267, 273
Watt Loss 400 V Class Three Phase Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
Undertorque Detection 2 (UL4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267, 273
Wire Gauge, Three Phase 200 V Class . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63, 419
Undervoltage (Uv) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Wire Gauge, Three Phase 400 V Class . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64, 421
Undervoltage Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Wire Gauges. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62, 71
Undervoltage Detection Level (Uv). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Wire Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
Undervoltage Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330
Wiring Checklist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
Unit Selection
Wiring the Control Circuit Terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Accel/Decel Ramps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382
Within Position Lock Bandwidth (Multi-Function Digital
Elevator Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382
Outputs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195
448 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
Write Data Error (EiF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
Write Impossible (EdE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
Writing Parameter Settings (CoPy) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
Writing to Multiple Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396
Z
Z Pulse Correction Error (Er-21) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Z Pulse Noise Fault Detection (dv2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Zero Phase Reactor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
Zero Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Zero Speed Level at Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Zero-Speed Time Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 449
Revision History
The revision dates and the numbers of the revised manuals appear on the bottom of the back cover.
450 YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual
YASKAWA ELECTRIC SIEP C710616 38A YASKAWA AC Drive L1000A Technical Manual 451
YASKAWA AC Drive-L1000A
AC Drive for Elevator Applications
Technical Manual
YASKAWA
In the event that the end user of this product is to be the military and said product is to be employed in any weapons systems or the manufacture
thereof, the export will fall under the relevant regulations as stipulated in the Foreign Exchange and Foreign Trade Regulations. Therefore, be sure
to follow all procedures and submit all relevant documentation according to any and all rules, regulations and laws that may apply.
Specifications are subject to change without notice for ongoing product modifications and improvements.
© 2010 YASKAWA ELECTRIC CORPORATION. All rights reserved.